Microchip DSPIC30F3013BT-20I/P High-performance, 16-bit digital signal controller Datasheet

dsPIC30F4011/4012
Data Sheet
High-Performance, 16-Bit
Digital Signal Controllers
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E
Note the following details of the code protection feature on Microchip devices:
•
Microchip products meet the specification contained in their particular Microchip Data Sheet.
•
Microchip believes that its family of products is one of the most secure families of its kind on the market today, when used in the
intended manner and under normal conditions.
•
There are dishonest and possibly illegal methods used to breach the code protection feature. All of these methods, to our
knowledge, require using the Microchip products in a manner outside the operating specifications contained in Microchip’s Data
Sheets. Most likely, the person doing so is engaged in theft of intellectual property.
•
Microchip is willing to work with the customer who is concerned about the integrity of their code.
•
Neither Microchip nor any other semiconductor manufacturer can guarantee the security of their code. Code protection does not
mean that we are guaranteeing the product as “unbreakable.”
Code protection is constantly evolving. We at Microchip are committed to continuously improving the code protection features of our
products. Attempts to break Microchip’s code protection feature may be a violation of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act. If such acts
allow unauthorized access to your software or other copyrighted work, you may have a right to sue for relief under that Act.
Information contained in this publication regarding device
applications and the like is provided only for your convenience
and may be superseded by updates. It is your responsibility to
ensure that your application meets with your specifications.
MICROCHIP MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS OR
WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND WHETHER EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, WRITTEN OR ORAL, STATUTORY OR
OTHERWISE, RELATED TO THE INFORMATION,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ITS CONDITION,
QUALITY, PERFORMANCE, MERCHANTABILITY OR
FITNESS FOR PURPOSE. Microchip disclaims all liability
arising from this information and its use. Use of Microchip
devices in life support and/or safety applications is entirely at
the buyer’s risk, and the buyer agrees to defend, indemnify and
hold harmless Microchip from any and all damages, claims,
suits, or expenses resulting from such use. No licenses are
conveyed, implicitly or otherwise, under any Microchip
intellectual property rights.
Trademarks
The Microchip name and logo, the Microchip logo, Accuron,
dsPIC, KEELOQ, microID, MPLAB, PIC, PICmicro, PICSTART,
PRO MATE, PowerSmart, rfPIC and SmartShunt are
registered trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated
in the U.S.A. and other countries.
AmpLab, FilterLab, Migratable Memory, MXDEV, MXLAB,
SEEVAL, SmartSensor and The Embedded Control Solutions
Company are registered trademarks of Microchip Technology
Incorporated in the U.S.A.
Analog-for-the-Digital Age, Application Maestro, CodeGuard,
dsPICDEM, dsPICDEM.net, dsPICworks, ECAN,
ECONOMONITOR, FanSense, FlexROM, fuzzyLAB,
In-Circuit Serial Programming, ICSP, ICEPIC, Linear Active
Thermistor, Mindi, MiWi, MPASM, MPLIB, MPLINK, PICkit,
PICDEM, PICDEM.net, PICLAB, PICtail, PowerCal,
PowerInfo, PowerMate, PowerTool, REAL ICE, rfLAB,
rfPICDEM, Select Mode, Smart Serial, SmartTel, Total
Endurance, UNI/O, WiperLock and ZENA are trademarks of
Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. and other
countries.
SQTP is a service mark of Microchip Technology Incorporated
in the U.S.A.
All other trademarks mentioned herein are property of their
respective companies.
© 2007, Microchip Technology Incorporated, Printed in the
U.S.A., All Rights Reserved.
Printed on recycled paper.
Microchip received ISO/TS-16949:2002 certification for its worldwide
headquarters, design and wafer fabrication facilities in Chandler and
Tempe, Arizona, Gresham, Oregon and Mountain View, California. The
Company’s quality system processes and procedures are for its PIC®
MCUs and dsPIC DSCs, KEELOQ® code hopping devices, Serial
EEPROMs, microperipherals, nonvolatile memory and analog
products. In addition, Microchip’s quality system for the design and
manufacture of development systems is ISO 9001:2000 certified.
DS70135E-page ii
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
dsPIC30F4011/4012 Enhanced Flash
16-Bit Digital Signal Controller
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
High-Performance, Modified RISC CPU:
• Modified Harvard architecture
• C compiler optimized instruction set architecture
with flexible addressing modes
• 83 base instructions
• 24-bit wide instructions, 16-bit wide data path
• 48 Kbytes on-chip Flash program space
(16K instruction words)
• 2 Kbytes of on-chip data RAM
• 1 Kbyte of nonvolatile data EEPROM
• Up to 30 MIPS operation:
- DC to 40 MHz external clock input
- 4 MHz-10 MHz oscillator input with
PLL active (4x, 8x, 16x)
• 30 interrupt sources:
- 3 external interrupt sources
- 8 user-selectable priority levels for each
interrupt source
- 4 processor trap sources
• 16 x 16-bit working register array
DSP Engine Features:
•
•
•
•
Dual data fetch
Accumulator write-back for DSP operations
Modulo and Bit-Reversed Addressing modes
Two, 40-bit wide accumulators with optional
saturation logic
• 17-bit x 17-bit single-cycle hardware
fractional/integer multiplier
• All DSP instructions are single cycle
• ±16-bit, single-cycle shift
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Peripheral Features:
• High-current sink/source I/O pins: 25 mA/25 mA
• Timer module with programmable prescaler:
- Five 16-bit timers/counters; optionally pair
16-bit timers into 32-bit timer modules
• 16-bit Capture input functions
• 16-bit Compare/PWM output functions
• 3-wire SPI modules (supports 4 Frame modes)
• I2C™ module supports Multi-Master/Slave mode
and 7-bit/10-bit addressing
• 2 UART modules with FIFO Buffers
• 1 CAN module, 2.0B compliant
Motor Control PWM Module Features:
• 6 PWM output channels:
- Complementary or Independent Output
modes
- Edge and Center-Aligned modes
• 3 duty cycle generators
• Dedicated time base
• Programmable output polarity
• Dead-time control for Complementary mode
• Manual output control
• Trigger for A/D conversions
Quadrature Encoder Interface Module
Features:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Phase A, Phase B and Index Pulse input
16-bit up/down position counter
Count direction status
Position Measurement (x2 and x4) mode
Programmable digital noise filters on inputs
Alternate 16-Bit Timer/Counter mode
Interrupt on position counter rollover/underflow
DS70135E-page 1
dsPIC30F4011/4012
Analog Features:
Special Digital Signal Controller
Features (Cont.):
• 10-Bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (A/D) with
4 S/H inputs:
- 1 Msps conversion rate
- 9 input channels
- Conversion available during Sleep and Idle
• Programmable Brown-out Reset
• Flexible Watchdog Timer (WDT) with on-chip,
low-power RC oscillator for reliable operation
• Fail-Safe Clock Monitor operation detects clock
failure and switches to on-chip, low-power
RC oscillator
• Programmable code protection
• In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™)
• Selectable Power Management modes:
- Sleep, Idle and Alternate Clock modes
Special Digital Signal Controller
Features:
• Enhanced Flash program memory:
- 10,000 erase/write cycle (min.) for
industrial temperature range, 100K (typical)
• Data EEPROM memory:
- 100,000 erase/write cycle (min.) for
industrial temperature range, 1M (typical)
• Self-reprogrammable under software control
• Power-on Reset (POR), Power-up Timer (PWRT)
and Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)
CMOS Technology:
•
•
•
•
Low-power, high-speed Flash technology
Wide operating voltage range (2.5V to 5.5V)
Industrial and Extended temperature ranges
Low-power consumption
28
dsPIC30F3010
dsPIC30F4012
1024
3
4
2
Yes
™
1
CAN
dsPIC30F2010
SPI
Program
Output
Motor
SRAM EEPROM Timer Input
10-Bit A/D Quad
Pins Mem. Bytes/
Comp/Std Control
Bytes
Bytes
16-bit Cap
1 Msps
Enc
Instructions
PWM
PWM
I2C
Device
UART
dsPIC30F Motor Control and Power Conversion Family*
1
1
-
12K/4K
512
6 ch
6 ch
28
24K/8K
1024
1024
5
4
28
48K/16K
2048
1024
5
4
2
6 ch
6 ch
Yes
1
1
1
-
2
6 ch
6 ch
Yes
1
1
1
1
dsPIC30F3011 40/44
24K/8K
1024
1024
5
4
4
6 ch
9 ch
Yes
2
1
1
-
dsPIC30F4011 40/44
48K/16K
2048
1024
5
4
4
6 ch
9 ch
Yes
2
1
1
1
dsPIC30F5015
64
66K/22K
2048
1024
5
4
4
8 ch
16 ch
Yes
1
2
1
1
dsPIC30F6010
80
144K/48K
8192
4096
5
8
8
8 ch
16 ch
Yes
2
2
1
2
* This table provides a summary of the dsPIC30F6010 peripheral features. Other available devices in the dsPIC30F Motor Control
and Power Conversion Family are shown for feature comparison.
DS70135E-page 2
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
Pin Diagrams
40-Pin PDIP
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
dsPIC30F4011
MCLR
EMUD3/AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
EMUC3/AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/CN4/RB2
AN3/INDX/CN5/RB3
AN4/QEA/IC7/CN6/RB4
AN5/QEB/IC8/CN7/RB5
AN6/OCFA/RB6
AN7/RB7
AN8/RB8
VDD
VSS
OSC1/CLKI
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
FLTA/INT0/RE8
EMUD2/OC2/IC2/INT2/RD1
OC4/RD3
VSS
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
AVDD
AVSS
PWM1L/RE0
PWM1H/RE1
PWM2L/RE2
PWM2H/RE3
PWM3L/RE4
PWM3H/RE5
VDD
VSS
C1RX/RF0
C1TX/RF1
U2RX/CN17/RF4
U2TX/CN18/RF5
PGC/EMUC/U1RX/SDI1/SDA/RF2
PGD/EMUD/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/RF3
SCK1/RF6
EMUC2/OC1/IC1/INT1/RD0
OC3/RD2
VDD
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
PGD/EMUD/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/RF3
SCK1/RF6
EMUC2/OC1/IC1/INT1/RD0
OC3/RD2
VDD
VSS
OC4/RD3
EMUD2/OC2/IC2/INT2/RD1
FLTA/INT0/RE8
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
NC
44-Pin TQFP
dsPIC30F4011
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
NC
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
OSC1/CLKI
VSS
VDD
AN8/RB8
AN7/RB7
AN6/OCFA/RB6
AN5/QEB/IC8/CN7/RB5
AN4/QEA/IC7/CN6/RB4
NC
NC
PWM1H/RE1
PWM1L/RE0
AVSS
AVDD
MCLR
EMUD3/AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
EMUC3/AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/CN4/RB2
AN3/INDX/CN5/RB3
PGC/EMUC/U1RX/SDI1/SDA/RF2
U2TX/CN18/RF5
U2RX/CN17/RF4
C1TX/RF1
C1RX/RF0
VSS
VDD
PWM3H/RE5
PWM3L/RE4
PWM2H/RE3
PWM2L/RE2
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 3
dsPIC30F4011/4012
Pin Diagrams (Continued)
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
PGD/EMUD/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/RF3
SCK1/RF6
EMUC2/OC1/IC1/INT1/RD0
OC3/RD2
VDD
VSS
OC4/RD3
EMUD2/OC2/IC2/INT2/RD1
FLTA/INT0/RE8
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
44-Pin QFN
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
dsPIC30F4011
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
OSC1/CLKI
VSS
VSS
VDD
VDD
AN8/RB8
AN7/RB7
AN6/OCFA/RB6
AN5/QEB/IC8/CN7/RB5
AN4/QEA/IC7/CN6/RB4
PWM2L/RE2
NC
PWM1H/RE1
PWM1L/RE0
AVSS
AVDD
MCLR
EMUD3/AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
EMUC3/AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/CN4/RB2
AN3/INDX/CN5/RB3
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
PGC/EMUC/U1RX/SDI1/SDA/RF2
U2TX/CN18/RF5
U2RX/CN17/RF4
C1TX/RF1
C1RX/RF0
VSS
VDD
VDD
PWM3H/RE5
PWM3L/RE4
PWM2H/RE3
DS70135E-page 4
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
Pin Diagrams (Continued)
28-Pin SPDIP and SOIC
dsPIC30F4012
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
MCLR
EMUD3/AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
EMUC3/AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/CN4/RB2
AN3/INDX/CN5/RB3
AN4/QEA/IC7/CN6/RB4
AN5/QEB/IC8/CN7/RB5
VSS
OSC1/CLKI
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
VDD
EMUD2/OC2/IC2/INT2/RD1
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
AVDD
AVSS
PWM1L/RE0
PWM1H/RE1
PWM2L/RE2
PWM2H/RE3
PWM3L/RE4
PWM3H/RE5
VDD
VSS
PGC/EMUC/U1RX/SDI1/SDA/C1RX/RF2
PGD/EMUD/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/C1TX/RF3
FLTA/INT0/SCK1/OCFA/RE8
EMUC2/OC1/IC1/INT1/RD0
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
PGD/EMUD/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/C1TX/RF3
FLTA/INT0/SCK1/OCFA/RE8
EMUC2/OC1/IC1/INT1/RD0
NC
VDD
VSS
NC
EMUD2/OC2/IC2/INT2/RD1
VDD
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
44-Pin QFN
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
dsPIC30F4012
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
OSC1/CLKI
VSS
VSS
VDD
VDD
NC
NC
NC
AN5/QEB/IC8/CN7/RB5
AN4/QEA/IC7/CN6/RB4
PWM2L/RE2
NC
PWM1H/RE1
PWM1L/RE0
AVSS
AVDD
MCLR
EMUD3/AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
EMUC3/AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/CN4/RB2
AN3/INDX/CN5/RB3
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
PGC/EMUC/U1RX/SDI1/SDA/C1RX/RF2
NC
NC
NC
NC
VSS
VDD
VDD
PWM3H/RE5
PWM3L/RE4
PWM2H/RE3
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 5
dsPIC30F4011/4012
Table of Contents
1.0 Device Overview .......................................................................................................................................................................... 7
2.0 CPU Architecture Overview........................................................................................................................................................ 13
3.0 Memory Organization ................................................................................................................................................................. 21
4.0 Address Generator Units ............................................................................................................................................................ 33
5.0 Interrupts .................................................................................................................................................................................... 39
6.0 Flash Program Memory .............................................................................................................................................................. 45
7.0 Data EEPROM Memory ............................................................................................................................................................. 51
8.0 I/O Ports ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 57
9.0 Timer1 Module ........................................................................................................................................................................... 63
10.0 Timer2/3 Module ........................................................................................................................................................................ 67
11.0 Timer4/5 Module ....................................................................................................................................................................... 73
12.0 Input Capture Module ................................................................................................................................................................. 77
13.0 Output Compare Module ............................................................................................................................................................ 81
14.0 Quadrature Encoder Interface (QEI) Module ............................................................................................................................. 85
15.0 Motor Control PWM Module ....................................................................................................................................................... 91
16.0 SPI Module ............................................................................................................................................................................... 103
17.0 I2C™ Module ........................................................................................................................................................................... 107
18.0 Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (UART) Module .............................................................................................. 115
19.0 CAN Module ............................................................................................................................................................................. 123
20.0 10-bit, High-Speed Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Module ............................................................................................... 133
21.0 System Integration ................................................................................................................................................................... 145
22.0 Instruction Set Summary .......................................................................................................................................................... 159
23.0 Development Support............................................................................................................................................................... 167
24.0 Electrical Characteristics .......................................................................................................................................................... 171
25.0 Packaging Information.............................................................................................................................................................. 213
Appendix A: Revision History............................................................................................................................................................. 221
Index .................................................................................................................................................................................................. 223
The Microchip Web Site ..................................................................................................................................................................... 229
Customer Change Notification Service .............................................................................................................................................. 229
Customer Support .............................................................................................................................................................................. 229
Reader Response .............................................................................................................................................................................. 230
Product Identification System............................................................................................................................................................. 231
TO OUR VALUED CUSTOMERS
It is our intention to provide our valued customers with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip
products. To this end, we will continue to improve our publications to better suit your needs. Our publications will be refined and
enhanced as new volumes and updates are introduced.
If you have any questions or comments regarding this publication, please contact the Marketing Communications Department via
E-mail at [email protected] or fax the Reader Response Form in the back of this data sheet to (480) 792-4150. We
welcome your feedback.
Most Current Data Sheet
To obtain the most up-to-date version of this data sheet, please register at our Worldwide Web site at:
http://www.microchip.com
You can determine the version of a data sheet by examining its literature number found on the bottom outside corner of any page.
The last character of the literature number is the version number, (e.g., DS30000A is version A of document DS30000).
Errata
An errata sheet, describing minor operational differences from the data sheet and recommended workarounds, may exist for current
devices. As device/documentation issues become known to us, we will publish an errata sheet. The errata will specify the revision
of silicon and revision of document to which it applies.
To determine if an errata sheet exists for a particular device, please check with one of the following:
• Microchip’s Worldwide Web site; http://www.microchip.com
• Your local Microchip sales office (see last page)
When contacting a sales office, please specify which device, revision of silicon and data sheet (include literature number) you are
using.
Customer Notification System
Register on our web site at www.microchip.com to receive the most current information on all of our products.
DS70135E-page 6
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
1.0
DEVICE OVERVIEW
This document contains device-specific information for
the dsPIC30F4011/4012 devices. The dsPIC30F
devices contain extensive Digital Signal Processor
(DSP) functionality within a high-performance, 16-bit
microcontroller (MCU) architecture. Figure 1-1 and
Figure 1-2 show device block diagrams for the
dsPIC30F4011 and dsPIC30F4012 devices.
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
FIGURE 1-1:
dsPIC30F4011 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Y Data Bus
X Data Bus
16
Interrupt
Controller
PSV & Table
Data Access
24 Control Block
8
16
16
Data Latch
Y Data
RAM
(1 Kbyte)
Address
Latch
16
24
Y AGU
PCU PCH PCL
Program Counter
Loop
Stack
Control
Control
Logic
Logic
Address Latch
Program Memory
(48 Kbytes)
Data EEPROM
(1 Kbyte)
16
Data Latch
X Data
RAM
(1 Kbyte)
Address
Latch
16
16
X RAGU
X WAGU
16
24
16
EMUD3/AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
EMUC3/AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/CN4/RB2
AN3/INDX/CN5/RB3
AN4/QEA/IC7/CN6/RB4
AN5/QEB/IC8/CN7/RB5
AN6/OCFA/RB6
AN7/RB7
AN8/RB8
Effective Address
16
Data Latch
PORTB
ROM Latch
16
24
IR
16 x 16
W Reg Array
Decode
Instruction
Decode and
Control
Power-up
Timer
Timing
Generation
PORTC
16 16
Control Signals
to Various Blocks
OSC1/CLKI
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
16
16
DSP
Engine
Divide
Unit
EMUC2/OC1/IC1/INT1/RD0
EMUD2/OC2/IC2/INT2/RD1
OC3/RD2
OC4/RD3
Oscillator
Start-up Timer
ALU<16>
POR/BOR
Reset
MCLR
PORTD
16
VDD, VSS
AVDD, AVSS
16
Watchdog
Timer
CAN
10-Bit ADC
Input
Capture
Module
Output
Compare
Module
I2C™
SPI1
Timers
QEI
Motor Control
PWM
UART1,
UART2
PWM1L/RE0
PWM1H/RE1
PWM2L/RE2
PWM2H/RE3
PWM3L/RE4
PWM3H/RE5
FLTA/INT0/RE8
PORTE
C1RX/RF0
C1TX/RF1
PGC/EMUC/U1RX/SDI1/SDA/RF2
PGD/EMUD/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/RF3
U2RX/CN17/RF4
U2TX/CN18/RF5
SCK1/RF6
PORTF
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 7
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 1-2:
dsPIC30F4012 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Y Data Bus
X Data Bus
PSV & Table
Data Access
24 Control Block
8
16
16
16
Interrupt
Controller
Data Latch
Y Data
RAM
(1 Kbyte)
Address
Latch
16
24
Y AGU
PCU PCH PCL
Program Counter
Loop
Stack
Control
Control
Logic
Logic
Address Latch
Program Memory
(48 Kbytes)
Data EEPROM
(1 Kbyte)
16
16
16
X RAGU
X WAGU
16
24
16
Data Latch
X Data
RAM
(1 Kbyte)
Address
Latch
EMUD3/AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
EMUC3/AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/CN4/RB2
AN3/INDX/CN5/RB3
AN4/QEA/IC7/CN6/RB4
AN5/QEB/IC8/CN7/RB5
PORTB
Effective Address
16
Data Latch
ROM Latch
16
24
IR
16 x 16
W Reg Array
Decode
Instruction
Decode and
Control
Power-up
Timer
Timing
Generation
PORTC
16 16
Control Signals
to Various Blocks
OSC1/CLKI
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
16
16
DSP
Engine
Divide
Unit
EMUC2/OC1/IC1/INT1RD0
EMUD2/OC2/IC2/INT2/RD1
Oscillator
Start-up Timer
ALU<16>
POR/BOR
Reset
MCLR
VDD, VSS
AVDD, AVSS
16
PORTD
16
Watchdog
Timer
CAN
10-Bit ADC
Input
Capture
Module
Output
Compare
Module
I2C™
SPI1,
SPI2
Timers
QEI
Motor Control
PWM
UART1,
UART2
PWM1L/RE0
PWM1H/RE1
PWM2L/RE2
PWM2H/RE3
PWM3L/RE4
PWM3H/RE5
FLTA/INT0/SCK1/OCFA/RE8
PORTE
PGC/EMUC/U1RX/SDI1/SDA/C1RX/RF2
PGD/EMUD/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/C1TX/RF3
PORTF
DS70135E-page 8
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
Table 1-1 provides a brief description of the device I/O
pinout and the functions that are multiplexed to a port
pin. Multiple functions may exist on one port pin. When
multiplexing occurs, the peripheral module’s functional
requirements may force an override of the data
direction of the port pin.
TABLE 1-1:
dsPIC30F4011 I/O PIN DESCRIPTIONS
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
AN0-AN8
I
Analog
AVDD
P
P
Positive supply for analog module.
AVSS
P
P
Ground reference for analog module.
CLKI
CLKO
I
O
CN0-CN7
CN17-CN18
I
ST
Input change notification inputs. Can be software programmed for internal
weak pull-ups on all inputs.
C1RX
C1TX
I
O
ST
—
CAN1 bus receive pin.
CAN1 bus transmit pin.
EMUD
EMUC
EMUD1
EMUC1
EMUD2
EMUC2
EMUD3
EMUC3
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ICD Primary Communication Channel data input/output pin.
ICD Primary Communication Channel clock input/output pin.
ICD Secondary Communication Channel data input/output pin.
ICD Secondary Communication Channel clock input/output pin.
ICD Tertiary Communication Channel data input/output pin.
ICD Tertiary Communication Channel clock input/output pin.
ICD Quaternary Communication Channel data input/output pin.
ICD Quaternary Communication Channel clock input/output pin.
IC1, IC2, IC7,
IC8
I
ST
Capture inputs 1, 2, 7 and 8.
INDX
QEA
I
I
ST
ST
QEB
I
ST
Quadrature Encoder Index Pulse input.
Quadrature Encoder Phase A input in QEI mode.
Auxiliary Timer External Clock/Gate input in Timer mode.
Quadrature Encoder Phase A input in QEI mode.
Auxiliary Timer External Clock/Gate input in Timer mode.
INT0
INT1
INT2
I
I
I
ST
ST
ST
External interrupt 0.
External interrupt 1.
External interrupt 2.
FLTA
PWM1L
PWM1H
PWM2L
PWM2H
PWM3L
PWM3H
I
O
O
O
O
O
O
ST
—
—
—
—
—
—
PWM Fault A input.
PWM1 low output.
PWM1 high output.
PWM2 low output.
PWM2 high output.
PWM3 low output.
PWM3 high output.
MCLR
I/P
ST
Master Clear (Reset) input or programming voltage input. This pin is an
active-low Reset to the device.
OCFA
OC1-OC4
I
O
ST
—
Compare Fault A input (for Compare channels 1, 2, 3 and 4).
Compare outputs 1 through 4.
Pin Name
Legend: CMOS =
ST
=
I
=
Description
Analog input channels. AN0 and AN1 are also used for device programming
data and clock inputs, respectively.
ST/CMOS External clock source input. Always associated with OSC1 pin function.
—
Oscillator crystal output. Connects to crystal or resonator in Crystal
Oscillator mode. Optionally functions as CLKO in RC and EC modes.
Always associated with OSC2 pin function.
CMOS compatible input or output
Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Input
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Analog =
O
=
P
=
Analog input
Output
Power
DS70135E-page 9
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 1-1:
Pin Name
dsPIC30F4011 I/O PIN DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Description
OSC1
I
ST/CMOS Oscillator crystal input. ST buffer when configured in RC mode; CMOS
otherwise.
—
Oscillator crystal output. Connects to crystal or resonator in Crystal Oscillator
mode. Optionally functions as CLKO in RC and EC modes.
OSC2
I/O
PGD
PGC
I/O
I
ST
ST
In-Circuit Serial Programming™ data input/output pin.
In-Circuit Serial Programming clock input pin.
RB0-RB8
I/O
ST
PORTB is a bidirectional I/O port.
8RC13-RC15
8I/O
8ST
PORTC is a bidirectional I/O port.
RD0-RD3
I/O
ST
PORTD is a bidirectional I/O port.
RE0-RE5,
RE8
I/O
ST
PORTE is a bidirectional I/O port.
RF0-RF6
I/O
ST
PORTF is a bidirectional I/O port.
SCK1
SDI1
SDO1
SS1
I/O
I
O
I
ST
ST
—
ST
Synchronous serial clock input/output for SPI1.
SPI1 data in.
SPI1 data out.
SPI1 slave synchronization.
SCL
SDA
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
Synchronous serial clock input/output for I2C™.
Synchronous serial data input/output for I2C.
SOSCO
SOSCI
O
I
T1CK
T2CK
I
I
ST
ST
Timer1 external clock input.
Timer2 external clock input.
U1RX
U1TX
U1ARX
U1ATX
U2RX
U2TX
I
O
I
O
I
O
ST
—
ST
—
ST
—
UART1 receive.
UART1 transmit.
UART1 alternate receive.
UART1 alternate transmit.
UART2 receive.
UART2 transmit.
VDD
P
—
Positive supply for logic and I/O pins.
VSS
P
—
Ground reference for logic and I/O pins.
—
32 kHz low-power oscillator crystal output.
ST/CMOS 32 kHz low-power oscillator crystal input. ST buffer when configured in RC
mode; CMOS otherwise.
VREF+
I
Analog
Analog voltage reference (high) input.
VREF-
I
Analog
Analog voltage reference (low) input.
Legend: CMOS =
ST
=
I
=
DS70135E-page 10
CMOS compatible input or output
Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Input
Analog =
O
=
P
=
Analog input
Output
Power
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
Table 1-2 provides a brief description of the device I/O
pinout and the functions that are multiplexed to a port
pin. Multiple functions may exist on one port pin. When
multiplexing occurs, the peripheral module’s functional
requirements may force an override of the data
direction of the port pin.
TABLE 1-2:
dsPIC30F4012 I/O PIN DESCRIPTIONS
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
AN0-AN5
I
Analog
AVDD
P
P
Positive supply for analog module.
AVSS
P
P
Ground reference for analog module.
CLKI
CLKO
I
O
CN0-CN7
I
ST
Input change notification inputs. Can be software programmed for internal
weak pull-ups on all inputs.
C1RX
C1TX
I
O
ST
—
CAN1 bus receive pin.
CAN1 bus transmit pin.
EMUD
EMUC
EMUD1
EMUC1
EMUD2
EMUC2
EMUD3
EMUC3
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ICD Primary Communication Channel data input/output pin.
ICD Primary Communication Channel clock input/output pin.
ICD Secondary Communication Channel data input/output pin.
ICD Secondary Communication Channel clock input/output pin.
ICD Tertiary Communication Channel data input/output pin.
ICD Tertiary Communication Channel clock input/output pin.
ICD Quaternary Communication Channel data input/output pin.
ICD Quaternary Communication Channel clock input/output pin.
IC1, IC2, IC7,
IC8
I
ST
Capture inputs 1, 2, 7 and 8.
INDX
QEA
I
I
ST
ST
QEB
I
ST
Quadrature Encoder Index Pulse input.
Quadrature Encoder Phase A input in QEI mode.
Auxiliary Timer External Clock/Gate input in Timer mode.
Quadrature Encoder Phase A input in QEI mode.
Auxiliary Timer External Clock/Gate input in Timer mode.
INT0
INT1
INT2
I
I
I
ST
ST
ST
External interrupt 0.
External interrupt 1.
External interrupt 2.
FLTA
PWM1L
PWM1H
PWM2L
PWM2H
PWM3L
PWM3H
I
O
O
O
O
O
O
ST
—
—
—
—
—
—
PWM Fault A input.
PWM1 low output.
PWM1 high output.
PWM2 low output.
PWM2 high output.
PWM3 low output.
PWM3 high output.
MCLR
I/P
ST
Master Clear (Reset) input or programming voltage input. This pin is an
active-low Reset to the device.
OCFA
OC1, OC2
I
O
ST
—
Compare Fault A input (for Compare channels 1, 2, 3 and 4).
Compare outputs 1 and 2.
Pin Name
Legend: CMOS =
ST
=
I
=
Description
Analog input channels. AN0 and AN1 are also used for device programming
data and clock inputs, respectively.
ST/CMOS External clock source input. Always associated with OSC1 pin function.
—
Oscillator crystal output. Connects to crystal or resonator in Crystal
Oscillator mode. Optionally functions as CLKO in RC and EC modes.
Always associated with OSC2 pin function.
CMOS compatible input or output
Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Input
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Analog =
O
=
P
=
Analog input
Output
Power
DS70135E-page 11
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 1-2:
Pin Name
dsPIC30F4012 I/O PIN DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Description
OSC1
I
ST/CMOS Oscillator crystal input. ST buffer when configured in RC mode; CMOS
otherwise.
—
Oscillator crystal output. Connects to crystal or resonator in Crystal Oscillator
mode. Optionally functions as CLKO in RC and EC modes.
OSC2
I/O
PGD
PGC
I/O
I
ST
ST
In-Circuit Serial Programming™ data input/output pin.
In-Circuit Serial Programming clock input pin.
RB0-RB5
I/O
ST
PORTB is a bidirectional I/O port.
RC13-RC15
8I/O
8ST
PORTC is a bidirectional I/O port.
RD0-RD1
I/O
ST
PORTD is a bidirectional I/O port.
RE0-RE5,
RE8
I/O
ST
PORTE is a bidirectional I/O port.
RF2-RF3
I/O
ST
PORTF is a bidirectional I/O port.
SCK1
SDI1
SDO1
SS1
I/O
I
O
I/O
ST
ST
—
ST
Synchronous serial clock input/output for SPI1.
SPI1 Data In.
SPI1 Data Out.
SPI1 Slave Synchronization
SCL
SDA
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
Synchronous serial clock input/output for I2C™.
Synchronous serial data input/output for I2C.
SOSCO
SOSCI
O
I
T1CK
T2CK
I
I
ST
ST
Timer1 external clock input.
Timer2 external clock input.
U1RX
U1TX
U1ARX
U1ATX
I
O
I
O
ST
—
ST
—
UART1 receive.
UART1 transmit.
UART1 alternate receive.
UART1 alternate transmit.
VDD
P
—
Positive supply for logic and I/O pins.
VSS
P
—
Ground reference for logic and I/O pins.
VREF+
I
Analog
Analog voltage reference (high) input.
VREF-
I
Analog
Analog voltage reference (low) input.
Legend: CMOS =
ST
=
I
=
DS70135E-page 12
—
32 kHz low-power oscillator crystal output.
ST/CMOS 32 kHz low-power oscillator crystal input. ST buffer when configured in RC
mode; CMOS otherwise.
CMOS compatible input or output
Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Input
Analog =
O
=
P
=
Analog input
Output
Power
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
2.0
CPU ARCHITECTURE
OVERVIEW
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
This document provides a summary of the
dsPIC30F4011/4012 CPU and peripheral functions.
For a complete description of this functionality, please
refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual”
(DS70046).
2.1
Core Overview
The core has a 24-bit instruction word. The Program
Counter (PC) is 23 bits wide with the Least Significant
bit (LSb) always clear (see Section 3.1 “Program
Address Space”), and the Most Significant bit (MSb)
is ignored during normal program execution, except for
certain specialized instructions. Thus, the PC can
address up to 4M instruction words of user program
space. An instruction prefetch mechanism is used to
help maintain throughput. Program loop constructs,
free from loop count management overhead, are
supported using the DO and REPEAT instructions, both
of which are interruptible at any point.
The working register array consists of 16x16-bit
registers, each of which can act as data, address or offset registers. One working register (W15) operates as
a software Stack Pointer for interrupts and calls.
The data space is 64 Kbytes (32K words) and is split into
two blocks, referred to as X and Y data memory. Each
block has its own independent Address Generation Unit
(AGU). Most instructions operate solely through the X
memory, AGU, which provides the appearance of a single, unified data space. The Multiply-Accumulate (MAC)
class of dual source DSP instructions operate through
both the X and Y AGUs, splitting the data address space
into two parts (see Section 3.2 “Data Address
Space”). The X and Y data space boundary is devicespecific and cannot be altered by the user. Each data
word consists of 2 bytes, and most instructions can
address data either as words or bytes.
There are two methods of accessing data stored in
program memory:
• The upper 32 Kbytes of data space memory can be
mapped into the lower half (user space) of program
space at any 16K program word boundary, defined
by the 8-bit Program Space Visibility Page
(PSVPAG) register. This lets any instruction access
program space as if it were data space, with a limitation that the access requires an additional cycle.
Moreover, only the lower 16 bits of each instruction
word can be accessed using this method.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
• SWWLinear indirect access of 32K word pages
within program space is also possible, using any
working register via table read and write instructions. Table read and write instructions can be
used to access all 24 bits of an instruction word.
Overhead-free circular buffers (Modulo Addressing)
are supported in both X and Y address spaces. This is
primarily intended to remove the loop overhead for
DSP algorithms.
The X AGU also supports Bit-Reversed Addressing on
destination effective addresses, to greatly simplify input
or output data reordering for radix-2 FFT algorithms.
Refer to Section 4.0 “Address Generator Units” for
details on Modulo and Bit-Reversed Addressing.
The core supports Inherent (no operand), Relative, Literal, Memory Direct, Register Direct, Register Indirect,
Register Offset and Literal Offset Addressing modes.
Instructions are associated with predefined addressing
modes, depending upon their functional requirements.
For most instructions, the core is capable of executing
a data (or program data) memory read, a working register (data) read, a data memory write and a program
(instruction) memory read per instruction cycle. As a
result, 3-operand instructions are supported, allowing
C = A + B operations to be executed in a single cycle.
A DSP engine has been included to significantly
enhance the core arithmetic capability and throughput.
It features a high-speed, 17-bit by 17-bit multiplier, a
40-bit ALU, two 40-bit saturating accumulators and a
40-bit bidirectional barrel shifter. Data in the accumulator, or any working register, can be shifted up to 16 bits
right or 16 bits left in a single cycle. The DSP instructions operate seamlessly with all other instructions and
have been designed for optimal real-time performance.
The MAC class of instructions can concurrently fetch
two data operands from memory, while multiplying two
W registers. To enable this concurrent fetching of data
operands, the data space has been split for these
instructions and is linear for all others. This has been
achieved in a transparent and flexible manner by
dedicating certain working registers to each address
space for the MAC class of instructions.
The core does not support a multi-stage instruction
pipeline. However, a single-stage instruction prefetch
mechanism is used, which accesses and partially
decodes instructions a cycle ahead of execution in order
to maximize available execution time. Most instructions
execute in a single cycle with certain exceptions.
The core features a vectored exception processing
structure for traps and interrupts, with 62 independent
vectors. The exceptions consist of up to 8 traps (of
which 4 are reserved) and 54 interrupts. Each interrupt
is prioritized based on a user-assigned priority between
1 and 7 (1 being the lowest priority and 7 being the
highest) in conjunction with a predetermined ‘natural
order’. Traps have fixed priorities, ranging from 8 to 15.
DS70135E-page 13
dsPIC30F4011/4012
2.2
Programmer’s Model
The programmer’s model is shown in Figure 2-1 and
consists of 16x16-bit working registers (W0 through
W15), 2x40-bit accumulators (ACCA and ACCB),
STATUS register (SR), Data Table Page register
(TBLPAG), Program Space Visibility Page register
(PSVPAG), DO and REPEAT registers (DOSTART,
DOEND, DCOUNT and RCOUNT) and Program
Counter (PC). The working registers can act as data,
address or offset registers. All registers are memory
mapped. W0 acts as the W register for file register
addressing.
Some of these registers have a shadow register associated with each of them, as shown in Figure 2-1. The
shadow register is used as a temporary holding register
and can transfer its contents to or from its host register
upon the occurrence of an event. None of the shadow
registers are accessible directly. The following rules
apply for transfer of registers into and out of shadows.
• PUSH.S and POP.S
W0, W1, W2, W3, SR (DC, N, OV, Z and C bits
only) are transferred.
• DO instruction
DOSTART, DOEND, DCOUNT shadows are
pushed on loop start and popped on loop end.
When a byte operation is performed on a working
register, only the Least Significant Byte of the target
register is affected. However, a benefit of memory
mapped working registers is that both the Least and
Most Significant Bytes can be manipulated through
byte wide data memory space accesses.
2.2.1
SOFTWARE STACK POINTER/
FRAME POINTER
The dsPIC® Digital Signal Controllers contain a software stack. W15 is the dedicated software Stack
Pointer (SP) and is automatically modified by exception
processing and subroutine calls and returns. However,
W15 can be referenced by any instruction in the same
manner as all other W registers. This simplifies the
reading, writing and manipulation of the Stack Pointer
(e.g., creating stack frames).
Note:
In order to protect against misaligned
stack accesses, W15<0> is always clear.
W15 is initialized to 0x0800 during a Reset. The user
may reprogram the SP during initialization to any
location within data space.
W14 has been dedicated as a Stack Frame Pointer as
defined by the LNK and ULNK instructions. However,
W14 can be referenced by any instruction in the same
manner as all other W registers.
2.2.2
STATUS REGISTER
The dsPIC DSC core has a 16-bit STATUS register (SR),
the Least Significant Byte of which is referred to as the
SR Low Byte (SRL) and the Most Significant Byte as the
SR High Byte (SRH). See Figure 2-1 for SR layout.
SRL contains all the DSP ALU operation Status flags
(including the Z bit), as well as the CPU Interrupt Priority Level Status bits, IPL<2:0>, and the Repeat Active
Status bit, RA. During exception processing, SRL is
concatenated with the MSB of the PC to form a
complete word value which is then stacked.
The upper byte of the SR register contains the DSP
Adder/Subtracter Status bits, the DO Loop Active bit
(DA) and the Digit Carry (DC) Status bit.
2.2.3
PROGRAM COUNTER
The Program Counter is 23 bits wide. Bit 0 is always
clear; therefore, the PC can address up to 4M
instruction words.
DS70135E-page 14
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 2-1:
dsPIC30F4011/4012 PROGRAMMER’S MODEL
D15
D0
W0/WREG
PUSH.S Shadow
W1
DO Shadow
W2
W3
Legend
W4
DSP Operand
Registers
W5
W6
W7
Working Registers
W8
W9
DSP Address
Registers
W10
W11
W12/DSP Offset
W13/DSP Write-Back
W14/Frame Pointer
W15/Stack Pointer
SPLIM
AD39
Stack Pointer Limit Register
AD15
AD31
AD0
ACCA
DSP
Accumulators
ACCB
PC22
PC0
Program Counter
0
0
7
TABPAG
TBLPAG
7
Data Table Page Address
0
PSVPAG
Program Space Visibility Page Address
15
0
RCOUNT
REPEAT Loop Counter
15
0
DCOUNT
DO Loop Counter
22
0
DOSTART
DO Loop Start Address
DOEND
DO Loop End Address
22
15
0
Core Configuration Register
CORCON
OA
OB
SA
SB OAB SAB DA
SRH
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DC IPL2 IPL1 IPL0 RA
N
OV
Z
C
STATUS Register
SRL
DS70135E-page 15
dsPIC30F4011/4012
2.3
Divide Support
The dsPIC DSCs feature a 16/16-bit signed fractional
divide operation, as well as 32/16-bit and 16/16-bit
signed and unsigned integer divide operations, in the
form of single instruction iterative divides. The following
instructions and data sizes are supported:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
DIVF – 16/16 signed fractional divide
DIV.sd – 32/16 signed divide
DIV.ud – 32/16 unsigned divide
DIV.s – 16/16 signed divide
DIV.u – 16/16 unsigned divide
TABLE 2-1:
The divide instructions must be executed within a
REPEAT loop. Any other form of execution (e.g. a series
of discrete divide instructions) will not function correctly
because the instruction flow depends on RCOUNT. The
divide instruction does not automatically set up the
RCOUNT value and it must, therefore, be explicitly and
correctly specified in the REPEAT instruction, as shown in
Table 2-1 (REPEAT executes the target instruction
{operand value + 1} times). The REPEAT loop count must
be set up for 18 iterations of the DIV/DIVF instruction.
Thus, a complete divide operation requires 19 cycles.
Note:
The divide flow is interruptible. However,
the user needs to save the context as
appropriate.
DIVIDE INSTRUCTIONS
Instruction
Function
DIVF
Signed fractional divide: Wm/Wn → W0; Rem → W1
DIV.sd
Signed divide: (Wm + 1:Wm)/Wn → W0; Rem → W1
DIV.s
Signed divide: Wm/Wn → W0; Rem → W1
DIV.ud
Unsigned divide: (Wm + 1:Wm)/Wn → W0; Rem → W1
DIV.u
Unsigned divide: Wm/Wn → W0; Rem → W1
2.4
DSP Engine
The DSP engine consists of a high-speed, 17-bit x
17-bit multiplier, a barrel shifter and a 40-bit adder/
subtracter (with two target accumulators, round and
saturation logic).
The dsPIC30F devices have a single instruction flow
which can execute either DSP or MCU instructions.
Many of the hardware resources are shared between
the DSP and MCU instructions. For example, the
instruction set has both DSP and MCU multiply
instructions which use the same hardware multiplier.
The DSP engine also has the capability to perform
inherent accumulator-to-accumulator operations which
require no additional data. These instructions are ADD,
SUB and NEG.
A block diagram of the DSP engine is shown in
Figure 2-2.
TABLE 2-2:
Instruction
DSP INSTRUCTION
SUMMARY
Algebraic Operation
CLR
A=0
ED
A = (x – y)2
EDAC
MAC
MOVSAC
MPY
MPY.N
MSC
A = A + (x – y)2
A = A + (x * y)
No change in A
A=x*y
A=–x*y
A=A–x*y
The DS0 engine has various options selected through
various bits in the CPU Core Configuration register
(CORCON), as listed below:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Fractional or integer DSP multiply (IF).
Signed or unsigned DSP multiply (US).
Conventional or convergent rounding (RND).
Automatic saturation on/off for ACCA (SATA).
Automatic saturation on/off for ACCB (SATB).
Automatic saturation on/off for writes to data
memory (SATDW).
Accumulator Saturation mode selection
(ACCSAT).
Note:
For CORCON layout, see Table 3-3.
DS70135E-page 16
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 2-2:
DSP ENGINE BLOCK DIAGRAM
40
S
a
40 Round t 16
u
Logic r
a
t
e
40-bit Accumulator A
40-bit Accumulator B
Carry/Borrow Out
Carry/Borrow In
Saturate
Adder
Negate
40
40
40
16
X Data Bus
Barrel
Shifter
40
Y Data Bus
Sign-Extend
32
16
Zero Backfill
32
33
17-bit
Multiplier/Scaler
16
16
To/From W Array
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 17
dsPIC30F4011/4012
2.4.1
MULTIPLIER
The 17x17-bit multiplier is capable of signed or
unsigned operation and can multiplex its output using a
scaler to support either 1.31 fractional (Q31) or 32-bit
integer results. Unsigned operands are zero-extended
into the 17th bit of the multiplier input value. Signed
operands are sign-extended into the 17th bit of the multiplier input value. The output of the 17x17-bit multiplier/
scaler is a 33-bit value, which is sign-extended to
40 bits. Integer data is inherently represented as a
signed two’s complement value, where the MSB is
defined as a sign bit. Generally speaking, the range of
an N-bit two’s complement integer is -2N-1 to 2N-1 – 1.
For a 16-bit integer, the data range is -32768 (0x8000)
to 32767 (0x7FFF), including 0. For a 32-bit integer, the
data range is -2,147,483,648 (0x8000 0000) to
2,147,483,645 (0x7FFF FFFF).
When the multiplier is configured for fractional multiplication, the data is represented as a two’s complement
fraction, where the MSB is defined as a sign bit and the
radix point is implied to lie just after the sign bit
(QX format). The range of an N-bit two’s complement
fraction with this implied radix point is -1.0 to (1-21-N).
For a 16-bit fraction, the Q15 data range is -1.0
(0x8000) to 0.999969482 (0x7FFF), including 0, and
has a precision of 3.01518x10-5. In Fractional mode, a
16x16 multiply operation generates a 1.31 product,
which has a precision of 4.65661x10-10.
The same multiplier is used to support the DSC multiply
instructions, which include integer 16-bit signed,
unsigned and mixed sign multiplies.
2.4.2.1
The adder/subtracter is a 40-bit adder with an optional
zero input into one side and either true or complement
data into the other input. In the case of addition, the
carry/borrow input is active-high and the other input is
true data (not complemented), whereas in the case of
subtraction, the carry/borrow input is active-low and the
other input is complemented. The adder/subtracter
generates Overflow Status bits, SA/SB and OA/OB,
which are latched and reflected in the STATUS register.
• Overflow from bit 39: this is a catastrophic
overflow in which the sign of the accumulator is
destroyed.
• Overflow into guard bits 32 through 39: this is a
recoverable overflow. This bit is set whenever all
the guard bits are not identical to each other.
The adder has an additional saturation block which
controls accumulator data saturation, if selected. It
uses the result of the adder, the Overflow Status bits
described above, and the SATA/B (CORCON<7:6>)
and ACCSAT (CORCON<4>) mode control bits to
determine when and to what value to saturate.
Six STATUS register bits have been provided to
support saturation and overflow; they are:
1.
2.
3.
The MUL instruction may be directed to use byte or
word-sized operands. Byte operands direct a 16-bit
result, and word operands direct a 32-bit result to the
specified register(s) in the W array.
2.4.2
DATA ACCUMULATORS AND
ADDER/SUBTRACTER
The data accumulator consists of a 40-bit adder/
subtracter with automatic sign extension logic. It
can select one of two accumulators (A or B) as its
pre-accumulation source and post-accumulation destination. For the ADD and LAC instructions, the data to be
accumulated or loaded can be optionally scaled via the
barrel shifter, prior to accumulation.
DS70135E-page 18
Adder/Subtracter, Overflow and
Saturation
4.
5.
6.
OA:
ACCA overflowed into guard bits
OB:
ACCB overflowed into guard bits
SA:
ACCA saturated (bit 31 overflow and saturation)
or
ACCA overflowed into guard bits and saturated
(bit 39 overflow and saturation)
SB:
ACCB saturated (bit 31 overflow and saturation)
or
ACCB overflowed into guard bits and saturated
(bit 39 overflow and saturation)
OAB:
Logical OR of OA and OB
SAB:
Logical OR of SA and SB
The OA and OB bits are modified each time data
passes through the adder/subtracter. When set, they
indicate that the most recent operation has overflowed
into the accumulator guard bits (bits 32 through 39).
Also, the OA and OB bits can optionally generate an
arithmetic warning trap when set and the corresponding Overflow Trap Flag Enable bit (OVATE, OVBTE) in
the INTCON1 register (refer to Section 5.0 “Interrupts”) is set. This allows the user to take immediate
action, for example, to correct system gain.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
The SA and SB bits are modified each time data passes
through the adder/subtracter but can only be cleared by
the user. When set, they indicate that the accumulator
has overflowed its maximum range (bit 31 for 32-bit
saturation or bit 39 for 40-bit saturation) and is saturated
(if saturation is enabled). When saturation is not
enabled, SA and SB default to bit 39 overflow and thus
indicate that a catastrophic overflow has occurred. If the
COVTE bit in the INTCON1 register is set, SA and SB
bits generate an arithmetic warning trap when saturation
is disabled.
The overflow and saturation Status bits can optionally
be viewed in the STATUS register (SR) as the logical
OR of OA and OB (in bit OAB) and the logical OR of SA
and SB (in bit SAB). This allows programmers to check
one bit in the STATUS register to determine if either
accumulator has overflowed, or one bit to determine if
either accumulator has saturated. This would be useful
for complex number arithmetic which typically uses
both the accumulators.
The device supports three Saturation and Overflow
modes:
1.
2.
3.
Bit 39 Overflow and Saturation:
When bit 39 overflow and saturation occurs, the
saturation logic loads the maximally positive 9.31
(0x7FFFFFFFFF) or maximally negative 9.31
value (0x8000000000) into the target accumulator. The SA or SB bit is set and remains set until
cleared by the user. This is referred to as ‘super
saturation’ and provides protection against erroneous data or unexpected algorithm problems
(e.g., gain calculations).
Bit 31 Overflow and Saturation:
When bit 31 overflow and saturation occurs, the
saturation logic then loads the maximally positive 1.31 value (0x007FFFFFFF) or maximally
negative 1.31 value (0x0080000000) into the
target accumulator. The SA or SB bit is set and
remains set until cleared by the user. When this
Saturation mode is in effect, the guard bits are not
used (so the OA, OB or OAB bits are never set).
Bit 39 Catastrophic Overflow
The bit 39 overflow Status bit from the adder is
used to set the SA or SB bit, which remain set
until cleared by the user. No saturation operation
is performed and the accumulator is allowed to
overflow (destroying its sign). If the COVTE bit in
the INTCON1 register is set, a catastrophic
overflow can initiate a trap exception.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
2.4.2.2
Accumulator ‘Write-Back’
The MAC class of instructions (with the exception of
MPY, MPY.N, ED and EDAC) can optionally write a
rounded version of the high word (bits 31 through 16)
of the accumulator that is not targeted by the instruction
into data space memory. The write is performed across
the X bus into combined X and Y address space. The
following addressing modes are supported:
1.
2.
W13, Register Direct:
The rounded contents of the non-target
accumulator are written into W13 as a
1.15 fraction.
[W13]+ = 2, Register Indirect with Post-Increment:
The rounded contents of the non-target accumulator are written into the address pointed to by
W13 as a 1.15 fraction. W13 is then
incremented by 2 (for a word write).
2.4.2.3
Round Logic
The round logic is a combinational block, which performs a conventional (biased) or convergent (unbiased)
round function during an accumulator write (store). The
Round mode is determined by the state of the RND bit
in the CORCON register. It generates a 16-bit, 1.15 data
value which is passed to the data space write saturation
logic. If rounding is not indicated by the instruction, a
truncated 1.15 data value is stored and the least
significant word is simply discarded.
Conventional rounding takes bit 15 of the accumulator,
zero-extends it and adds it to the ACCxH word (bits 16
through 31 of the accumulator). If the ACCxL word (bits
0 through 15 of the accumulator) is between 0x8000
and 0xFFFF (0x8000 included), ACCxH is incremented. If ACCxL is between 0x0000 and 0x7FFF,
ACCxH is left unchanged. A consequence of this algorithm is that over a succession of random rounding
operations, the value tends to be biased slightly
positive.
Convergent (or unbiased) rounding operates in the
same manner as conventional rounding, except when
ACCxL equals 0x8000. If this is the case, the LSb
(bit 16 of the accumulator) of ACCxH is examined. If it
is ‘1’, ACCxH is incremented. If it is ‘0’, ACCxH is not
modified. Assuming that bit 16 is effectively random in
nature, this scheme removes any rounding bias that
may accumulate.
The SAC and SAC.R instructions store either a truncated (SAC) or rounded (SAC.R) version of the contents
of the target accumulator to data memory, via the X bus
(subject to data saturation, see Section 2.4.2.4 “Data
Space Write Saturation”). Note that for the MAC class
of instructions, the accumulator write-back operation
functions in the same manner, addressing combined
DSC (X and Y) data space though the X bus. For this
class of instructions, the data is always subject to
rounding.
DS70135E-page 19
dsPIC30F4011/4012
2.4.2.4
Data Space Write Saturation
In addition to adder/subtracter saturation, writes to data
space may also be saturated, but without affecting the
contents of the source accumulator. The data space write
saturation logic block accepts a 16-bit, 1.15 fractional
value from the round logic block as its input, together with
overflow status from the original source (accumulator)
and the 16-bit round adder. These are combined and
used to select the appropriate 1.15 fractional value as
output to write to data space memory.
If the SATDW bit in the CORCON register is set, data
(after rounding or truncation) is tested for overflow and
adjusted accordingly. For input data greater than
0x007FFF, data written to memory is forced to the maximum positive 1.15 value, 0x7FFF. For input data less
than 0xFF8000, data written to memory is forced to the
maximum negative 1.15 value, 0x8000. The MSb of the
source (bit 39) is used to determine the sign of the
operand being tested.
2.4.3
BARREL SHIFTER
The barrel shifter is capable of performing up to 16-bit
arithmetic or logic right shifts, or up to 16-bit left shifts
in a single cycle. The source can be either of the two
DSP accumulators or the X bus (to support multi-bit
shifts of register or memory data).
The shifter requires a signed binary value to determine
both the magnitude (number of bits) and direction of the
shift operation. A positive value shifts the operand right.
A negative value shifts the operand left. A value of ‘0’
does not modify the operand.
The barrel shifter is 40 bits wide, thereby obtaining a
40-bit result for DSP shift operations and a 16-bit result
for MCU shift operations. Data from the X bus is presented to the barrel shifter between bit positions 16 to
31 for right shifts, and bit positions 0 to 15 for left shifts.
If the SATDW bit in the CORCON register is not set, the
input data is always passed through unmodified under
all conditions.
DS70135E-page 20
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
3.0
MEMORY ORGANIZATION
FIGURE 3-1:
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
PROGRAM SPACE
MEMORY MAP FOR
dsPIC30F4011/4012
Reset – GOTO Instruction
Reset – Target Address
000000
000002
000004
Vector Tables
Interrupt Vector Table
Program Address Space
The program address space is 4M instruction words. It
is addressable by the 23-bit PC, table instruction
Effective Address (EA) or data space EA, when
program space is mapped into data space as defined
by Table 3-1. Note that the program space address is
incremented by two between successive program
words in order to provide compatibility with data space
addressing.
User Memory
Space
3.1
User program space access is restricted to the lower
4M instruction word address range (0x000000 to
0x7FFFFE) for all accesses other than TBLRD/TBLWT,
which use TBLPAG<7> to determine user or configuration space access. In Table 3-1, read/write instructions,
bit 23 allows access to the Device ID, the User ID and
the Configuration bits; otherwise, bit 23 is always clear.
Reserved
Alternate Vector Table
User Flash
Program Memory
(16K instructions)
Reserved
(Read ‘0’s)
00007E
000080
000084
0000FE
000100
007FFE
008000
7FFBFE
7FFC00
Data EEPROM
(1 Kbyte)
7FFFFE
800000
Configuration Memory
Space
Reserved
UNITID (32 instr.)
8005BE
8005C0
8005FE
800600
Reserved
Device Configuration
Registers
F7FFFE
F80000
F8000E
F80010
Reserved
DEVID (2)
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
FEFFFE
FF0000
FFFFFE
DS70135E-page 21
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 3-1:
PROGRAM SPACE ADDRESS CONSTRUCTION
Program Space Address
Access
Space
Access Type
<23>
<22:16>
<14:1>
Instruction Access
User
TBLRD/TBLWT
User
(TBLPAG<7> = 0)
TBLPAG<7:0>
Data EA<15:0>
TBLRD/TBLWT
Configuration
(TBLPAG<7> = 1)
TBLPAG<7:0>
Data EA<15:0>
Program Space Visibility
User
FIGURE 3-2:
0
<15>
<0>
PC<22:1>
0
0
PSVPAG<7:0>
Data EA<14:0>
DATA ACCESS FROM PROGRAM SPACE ADDRESS GENERATION
23 bits
Using
Program
Counter
Program Counter
0
Select
Using
Program
Space
Visibility
0
1
0
EA
PSVPAG Reg
8 bits
15 bits
EA
Using
Table
Instruction
1/0
TBLPAG Reg
8 bits
User/
Configuration
Space
Select
16 bits
24-bit EA
Byte
Select
Note: Program Space Visibility cannot be used to access bits <23:16> of a word in program memory.
DS70135E-page 22
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
3.1.1
DATA ACCESS FROM PROGRAM
MEMORY USING TABLE
INSTRUCTIONS
This architecture fetches 24-bit wide program memory.
Consequently, instructions are always aligned. However, as the architecture is modified Harvard, data can
also be present in program space.
There are two methods by which program space can
be accessed; via special table instructions, or through
the remapping of a 16K word program space page into
the upper half of data space (see Section 3.1.2 “Data
Access From Program Memory Using Program
Space Visibility”). The TBLRDL and TBLWTL instructions offer a direct method of reading or writing the least
significant word (lsw) of any address within program
space, without going through data space. The TBLRDH
and TBLWTH instructions are the only method whereby
the upper 8 bits of a program space word can be
accessed as data.
The PC is incremented by two for each successive
24-bit program word. This allows program memory
addresses to directly map to data space addresses.
Program memory can thus be regarded as two, 16-bit
word-wide address spaces, residing side by side, each
with the same address range. TBLRDL and TBLWTL
access the space which contains the least significant
data word, and TBLRDH and TBLWTH access the space
which contains the Most Significant Byte of data.
A set of table instructions is provided to move byte or
word-sized data to and from program space (see
Figure 3-3 and Figure 3-4).
1.
2.
3.
4.
TBLRDL: Table Read Low
Word: Read the lsw of the program address;
P<15:0> maps to D<15:0>.
Byte: Read one of the LSBs of the program
address;
P<7:0> maps to the destination byte when byte
select = 0;
P<15:8> maps to the destination byte when byte
select = 1.
TBLWTL: Table Write Low (refer to Section 6.0
“Flash Program Memory” for details on Flash
programming).
TBLRDH: Table Read High
Word: Read the msw of the program address;
P<23:16> maps to D<7:0>; D<15:8> will always
be = 0.
Byte: Read one of the MSBs of the program
address;
P<23:16> maps to the destination byte when
byte select = 0;
The destination byte will always be ‘0’ when byte
select = 1.
TBLWTH: Table Write High (refer to Section 6.0
“Flash Program Memory” for details on Flash
programming).
Figure 3-2 shows how the EA is created for table operations and data space accesses (PSV = 1). Here,
P<23:0> refers to a program space word, whereas
D<15:0> refers to a data space word.
FIGURE 3-3:
PROGRAM DATA TABLE ACCESS (LEAST SIGNIFICANT WORD)
PC Address
0x000000
0x000002
0x000004
0x000006
Program Memory
‘Phantom’ Byte
(read as ‘0’).
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
23
16
8
0
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
TBLRDL.W
TBLRDL.B (Wn<0> = 0)
TBLRDL.B (Wn<0> = 1)
DS70135E-page 23
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 3-4:
PROGRAM DATA TABLE ACCESS (MOST SIGNIFICANT BYTE)
TBLRDH.W
PC Address
0x000000
0x000002
0x000004
0x000006
23
16
8
0
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
TBLRDH.B (Wn<0> = 0)
Program Memory
‘Phantom’ Byte
(read as ‘0’)
3.1.2
TBLRDH.B (Wn<0> = 1)
DATA ACCESS FROM PROGRAM
MEMORY USING PROGRAM
SPACE VISIBILITY
The upper 32 Kbytes of data space may optionally be
mapped into any 16K word program space page. This
provides transparent access of stored constant data
from X data space without the need to use special
instructions (i.e., TBLRDL/H, TBLWTL/H instructions).
Program space access through the data space occurs
if the MSb of the data space EA is set and program
space visibility is enabled by setting the PSV bit in the
Core Control register (CORCON). The functions of
CORCON are discussed in Section 2.4 “DSP
Engine”.
Data accesses to this area add an additional cycle to
the instruction being executed, since two program
memory fetches are required.
Note that the upper half of addressable data space is
always part of the X data space. Therefore, when a
DSP operation uses program space mapping to access
this memory region, Y data space should typically contain state (variable) data for DSP operations, whereas
X data space should typically contain coefficient
(constant) data.
Although each data space address, 0x8000 and higher,
maps directly into a corresponding program memory
address (see Figure 3-5), only the lower 16 bits of the
24-bit program word are used to contain the data. The
upper 8 bits should be programmed to force an illegal
instruction to maintain machine robustness. Refer
to the “dsPIC30F Programmer’s Reference Manual”
(DS70030) for details on instruction encoding.
DS70135E-page 24
Note that by incrementing the PC by 2 for each
program memory word, the Least Significant 15 bits of
data space addresses directly map to the Least Significant 15 bits in the corresponding program space
addresses. The remaining bits are provided by the
Program
Space
Visibility
Page
register,
PSVPAG<7:0>, as shown in Figure 3-5.
Note:
PSV access is temporarily disabled during
table reads/writes.
For instructions that use PSV which are executed
outside a REPEAT loop:
• The following instructions require one instruction
cycle in addition to the specified execution time:
- MAC class of instructions with data operand
prefetch
- MOV instructions
- MOV.D instructions
• All other instructions require two instruction cycles
in addition to the specified execution time of the
instruction.
For instructions that use PSV which are executed
inside a REPEAT loop:
• The following instances require two instruction
cycles in addition to the specified execution time
of the instruction:
- Execution in the first iteration
- Execution in the last iteration
- Execution prior to exiting the loop due to an
interrupt
- Execution upon re-entering the loop after an
interrupt is serviced
• Any other iteration of the REPEAT loop allows the
instruction, accessing data using PSV, to execute
in a single cycle.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 3-5:
DATA SPACE WINDOW INTO PROGRAM SPACE OPERATION
Data Space
Program Space
0x000100
0x0000
EA<15> = 0
Data
Space
EA
PSVPAG(1)
0x00
8
15
16
0x8000
15
EA<15> = 1
15
Address
Concatenation 23
23
15
0
0x001200
Upper Half of Data
Space is Mapped
into Program Space
0x007FFE
0xFFFF
BSET
MOV
MOV
MOV
CORCON,#2
#0x00, W0
W0, PSVPAG
0x9200, W0
; PSV bit set
; Set PSVPAG register
; Access program memory location
; using a data space access
Data Read
Note: PSVPAG is an 8-bit register containing bits <22:15> of the program space address
(i.e., it defines the page in program space to which the upper half of data space is being mapped).
3.2
Data Address Space
The core has two data spaces. The data spaces can be
considered either separate (for some DSP instructions), or as one unified linear address range (for MCU
instructions). The data spaces are accessed using two
Address Generation Units (AGUs) and separate data
paths.
3.2.1
DATA SPACE MEMORY MAP
The data space memory is split into two blocks, X and
Y data space. A key element of this architecture is that
Y space is a subset of X space, and is fully contained
within X space. In order to provide an apparent linear
addressing space, X and Y spaces have contiguous
addresses.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
When executing any instruction other than one of the
MAC class of instructions, the X block consists of the
64-Kbyte data address space (including all Y
addresses). When executing one of the MAC class of
instructions, the X block consists of the 64-Kbyte data
address space excluding the Y address block (for data
reads only). In other words, all other instructions regard
the entire data memory as one composite address
space. The MAC class instructions extract the Y address
space from data space and address it using EAs
sourced from W10 and W11. The remaining X data
space is addressed using W8 and W9. Both address
spaces are concurrently accessed only with the MAC
class instructions.
A data space memory map is shown in Figure 3-6.
Figure 3-7 shows a graphical summary of how X and Y
data spaces are accessed for MCU and DSP
instructions.
DS70135E-page 25
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 3-6:
dsPIC30F4011/4012 DATA SPACE MEMORY MAP
MSB
Address
MSB
2-Kbyte
SFR Space
0x0001
LSB
Address
16 bits
LSB
0x0000
SFR Space
0x07FE
0x0800
0x07FF
0x0801
X Data RAM (X)
2-Kbyte
SRAM Space
0x0BFF
0x0C01
0x0BFE
0x0C00
4096 Bytes
Near Data
Space
Y Data RAM (Y)
0x0FFF
0x0FFE
0x1001
0x1000
0x8001
0x8000
X Data
Unimplemented (X)
Optionally
Mapped
into Program
Memory
0xFFFF
DS70135E-page 26
0xFFFE
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DATA SPACE FOR MCU AND DSP (MAC CLASS) INSTRUCTIONS EXAMPLE
SFR SPACE
SFR SPACE
X SPACE
FIGURE 3-7:
Y SPACE
UNUSED
X SPACE
(Y SPACE)
X SPACE
UNUSED
UNUSED
Non-MAC Class Ops (Read/Write)
MAC Class Ops (Write)
Indirect EA using any W
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
MAC Class Ops Read-Only
Indirect EA using W8, W9
Indirect EA using W10, W11
DS70135E-page 27
dsPIC30F4011/4012
3.2.2
DATA SPACES
3.2.3
The X data space is used by all instructions and supports all addressing modes. There are separate read
and write data buses. The X read data bus is the return
data path for all instructions that view data space as
combined X and Y address space. It is also the X
address space data path for the dual operand read
instructions (MAC class). The X write data bus is the
only write path to data space for all instructions.
The X data space also supports Modulo Addressing for
all instructions, subject to addressing mode restrictions. Bit-Reversed Addressing is only supported for
writes to X data space.
The Y data space is used in concert with the X data
space by the MAC class of instructions (CLR, ED,
EDAC, MAC, MOVSAC, MPY, MPY.N and MSC) to provide two concurrent data read paths. No writes occur
across the Y bus. This class of instructions dedicates
two W register pointers, W10 and W11, to always
address Y data space, independent of X data space,
whereas W8 and W9 always address X data space.
Note that during accumulator write-back, the data
address space is considered a combination of X and Y
data spaces, so the write occurs across the X bus.
Consequently, the write can be to any address in the
entire data space.
The Y data space can only be used for the data
prefetch operation associated with the MAC class of
instructions. It also supports Modulo Addressing for
automated circular buffers. Of course, all other instructions can access the Y data address space through the
X data path, as part of the composite linear space.
The boundary between the X and Y data spaces is
defined as shown in Figure 3-6 and is not userprogrammable. Should an EA point to data outside its
own assigned address space, or to a location outside
physical memory, an all-zero word/byte is returned. For
example, although Y address space is visible by all
non-MAC instructions using any addressing mode, an
attempt by a MAC instruction to fetch data from that
space, using W8 or W9 (X Space Pointers), returns
0x0000.
TABLE 3-2:
EFFECT OF INVALID
MEMORY ACCESSES
Attempted Operation
Data Returned
EA = an unimplemented address
0x0000
W8 or W9 used to access Y data
space in a MAC instruction
0x0000
W10 or W11 used to access X
data space in a MAC instruction
0x0000
DATA SPACE WIDTH
The core data width is 16-bits. All internal registers are
organized as 16-bit wide words. Data space memory is
organized in byte addressable, 16-bit wide blocks.
3.2.4
DATA ALIGNMENT
To help maintain backward compatibility with PIC®
devices and improve data space memory usage efficiency, the dsPIC30F instruction set supports both
word and byte operations. Data is aligned in data memory and registers as words, but all data space EAs
resolve to bytes. Data byte reads read the complete
word, which contains the byte, using the LSb of any EA
to determine which byte to select. The selected byte is
placed onto the LSB of the X data path (no byte
accesses are possible from the Y data path as the MAC
class of instructions can only fetch words). That is, data
memory and registers are organized as two parallel
byte-wide entities, with shared (word) address decode,
but separate write lines. Data byte writes only write to
the corresponding side of the array or register which
matches the byte address.
As a consequence of this byte accessibility, all Effective
Address calculations (including those generated by the
DSP operations, which are restricted to word-sized
data) are internally scaled to step through word-aligned
memory. For example, the core would recognize that
Post-Modified Register Indirect Addressing mode,
[Ws++], will result in a value of Ws + 1 for byte
operations and Ws + 2 for word operations.
All word accesses must be aligned to an even address.
Misaligned word data fetches are not supported, so
care must be taken when mixing byte and word operations, or translating from 8-bit MCU code. Should a
misaligned read or write be attempted, an address
error trap is generated. If the error occurred on a read,
the instruction underway is completed, whereas if it
occurred on a write, the instruction will be executed but
the write does not occur. In either case, a trap is then
executed, allowing the system and/or user to examine
the machine state prior to execution of the address
Fault.
FIGURE 3-8:
15
DATA ALIGNMENT
MSB
87
LSB
0
0001
Byte 1
Byte 0
0000
0003
Byte 3
Byte 2
0002
0005
Byte 5
Byte 4
0004
All Effective Addresses (EA) are 16 bits wide and point
to bytes within the data space. Therefore, the data
space address range is 64 Kbytes or 32K words.
DS70135E-page 28
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
All byte loads into any W register are loaded into the
LSB; the MSB is not modified.
A sign-extend (SE) instruction is provided to allow
users to translate 8-bit signed data to 16-bit signed
values. Alternatively, for 16-bit unsigned data, users
can clear the MSB of any W register by executing a
zero-extend (ZE) instruction on the appropriate
address.
Although most instructions are capable of operating on
word or byte data sizes, it should be noted that some
instructions, including the DSP instructions, operate
only on words.
3.2.5
NEAR DATA SPACE
An 8-Kbyte ‘near’ data space is reserved in X address
memory space between 0x0000 and 0x1FFF, which is
directly addressable via a 13-bit absolute address field
within all memory direct instructions. The remaining X
address space and all of the Y address space is
addressable indirectly. Additionally, the whole of X data
space is addressable using MOV instructions, which
support Memory Direct Addressing with a 16-bit
address field.
There is a Stack Pointer Limit register (SPLIM) associated with the Stack Pointer. SPLIM is uninitialized at
Reset. As is the case for the Stack Pointer, SPLIM<0>
is forced to ‘0’, because all stack operations must be
word-aligned. Whenever an Effective Address (EA) is
generated, using W15 as a source or destination
pointer, the address thus generated is compared with
the value in SPLIM. If the contents of the Stack Pointer
(W15) and the SPLIM register are equal, and a push
operation is performed, a stack error trap will not occur.
The stack error trap will occur on a subsequent push
operation. Thus, for example, if it is desirable to cause
a stack error trap when the stack grows beyond
address 0x2000 in RAM, initialize the SPLIM with the
value, 0x1FFE.
Similarly, a Stack Pointer underflow (stack error) trap is
generated when the Stack Pointer address is found to
be less than 0x0800, thus preventing the stack from
interfering with the Special Function Register (SFR)
space.
A write to the SPLIM register should not be immediately
followed by an indirect read operation using W15.
FIGURE 3-9:
The dsPIC DSC contains a software stack. W15 is used
as the Stack Pointer.
The Stack Pointer always points to the first available
free word and grows from lower addresses towards
higher addresses. It pre-decrements for stack pops and
post-increments for stack pushes, as shown in
Figure 3-9. Note that for a PC push during any CALL
instruction, the MSB of the PC is zero-extended before
the push, ensuring that the MSB is always clear.
Note:
CALL STACK FRAME
SOFTWARE STACK
A PC push during exception processing
concatenates the SRL register to the MSB
of the PC prior to the push.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
0x0000 15
Stack Grows Towards
Higher Address
3.2.6
0
PC<15:0>
000000000 PC<22:16>
<Free Word>
W15 (before CALL)
W15 (after CALL)
POP: [--W15]
PUSH: [W15++]
DS70135E-page 29
SFR Name
CORE REGISTER MAP
Address
(Home)
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
W0
0000
W0/WREG
0000 0000 0000 0000
W1
0002
W1
0000 0000 0000 0000
W2
0004
W2
0000 0000 0000 0000
W3
0006
W3
0000 0000 0000 0000
W4
0008
W4
0000 0000 0000 0000
W5
000A
W5
0000 0000 0000 0000
W6
000C
W6
0000 0000 0000 0000
W7
000E
W7
0000 0000 0000 0000
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
W8
0010
W8
0000 0000 0000 0000
W9
0012
W9
0000 0000 0000 0000
W10
0014
W10
0000 0000 0000 0000
W11
0016
W11
0000 0000 0000 0000
W12
0018
W12
0000 0000 0000 0000
W13
001A
W13
0000 0000 0000 0000
W14
001C
W14
0000 0000 0000 0000
W15
001E
W15
0000 1000 0000 0000
SPLIM
0020
SPLIM
0000 0000 0000 0000
ACCAL
0022
ACCAL
0000 0000 0000 0000
ACCAH
0024
ACCAH
0000 0000 0000 0000
ACCAU
0026
ACCBL
0028
ACCBL
ACCBH
002A
ACCBH
ACCBU
002C
PCL
002E
PCH
0030
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TBLPAG
0032
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TBLPAG
0000 0000 0000 0000
PSVPAG
0034
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PSVPAG
0000 0000 0000 0000
RCOUNT
0036
RCOUNT
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
DCOUNT
0038
DCOUNT
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
DOSTARTL
003A
DOSTARTH
003C
DOENDL
003E
DOENDH
Sign Extension (ACCA<39>)
ACCAU
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
Sign Extension (ACCB<39>)
ACCBU
0000 0000 0000 0000
PCL
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
PCH
0000 0000 0000 0000
DOSTARTL
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0040
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
SR
0042
OA
OB
SA
SB
OAB
SAB
CORCON
0044
—
—
—
US
EDT
DL2
MODCON
0046
XMODEN
YMODEN
—
—
XMODSRT
0048
—
0
—
DOSTARTH
—
—
DOENDH
DA
DC
IPL2
IPL1
DL1
DL0
SATA
SATB
DOENDL
BWM<3:0>
0
IPL0
SATDW ACCSAT
YWM<3:0>
XS<15:1>
Legend:
u = uninitialized bit
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
RA
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuu0
0000 0000 0uuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuu0
0000 0000 0uuu uuuu
N
OV
Z
C
0000 0000 0000 0000
IPL3
PSV
RND
IF
0000 0000 0010 0000
0
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuu0
XWM<3:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 30
TABLE 3-3:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 3-3:
SFR Name
CORE REGISTER MAP (CONTINUED)
Address
(Home)
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
XMODEND
004A
XE<15:1>
1
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuu1
YMODSRT
004C
YS<15:1>
0
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuu0
1
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuu1
YMODEND
004E
XBREV
0050
BREN
YE<15:1>
DISICNT
0052
—
XB<14:0>
—
Legend:
u = uninitialized bit
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
DISICNT<13:0>
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 31
dsPIC30F4011/4012
NOTES:
DS70135E-page 32
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
4.0
ADDRESS GENERATOR UNITS
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
The dsPIC DSC core contains two independent
address generator units: the X AGU and Y AGU. The Y
AGU supports word-sized data reads for the DSP MAC
class of instructions only. The dsPIC Digital Signal
Controller AGUs support three types of data
addressing:
• Linear Addressing
• Modulo (Circular) Addressing
• Bit-Reversed Addressing
FILE REGISTER INSTRUCTIONS
Most file register instructions use a 13-bit address field
(f) to directly address data present in the first
8192 bytes of data memory (near data space). Most file
register instructions employ a working register, W0,
which is denoted as WREG in these instructions. The
destination is typically either the same file register, or
WREG (with the exception of the MUL instruction),
which writes the result to a register or register pair. The
MOV instruction allows additional flexibility and can
access the entire data space during file register
operation.
4.1.2
MCU INSTRUCTIONS
The three-operand MCU instructions are of the form:
Operand 3 = Operand 1 <function> Operand 2
Linear and Modulo Data Addressing modes can be
applied to data space or program space. Bit-Reversed
Addressing is only applicable to data space addresses.
4.1
4.1.1
Instruction Addressing Modes
The addressing modes in Table 4-1 form the basis of
the addressing modes optimized to support the specific
features of individual instructions. The addressing
modes provided in the MAC class of instructions are
somewhat different from those in the other instruction
types.
where Operand 1 is always a working register (i.e., the
addressing mode can only be Register Direct), which is
referred to as Wb. Operand 2 can be a W register,
fetched from data memory or a 5-bit literal. The result
location can either be a W register or an address
location. The following addressing modes are
supported by MCU instructions:
•
•
•
•
•
Register Direct
Register Indirect
Register Indirect Post-Modified
Register Indirect Pre-Modified
5-bit or 10-bit Literal
Note:
TABLE 4-1:
Not all instructions support all the addressing modes given above. Individual
instructions may support different subsets
of these addressing modes.
FUNDAMENTAL ADDRESSING MODES SUPPORTED
Addressing Mode
Description
File Register Direct
The address of the file register is specified explicitly.
Register Direct
The contents of a register are accessed directly.
Register Indirect
The contents of Wn forms the EA.
Register Indirect Post-Modified
The contents of Wn forms the EA. Wn is post-modified (incremented or
decremented) by a constant value.
Register Indirect Pre-Modified
Wn is pre-modified (incremented or decremented) by a signed constant value
to form the EA.
Register Indirect with Register Offset The sum of Wn and Wb forms the EA.
Register Indirect with Literal Offset
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
The sum of Wn and a literal forms the EA.
DS70135E-page 33
dsPIC30F4011/4012
4.1.3
MOVE AND ACCUMULATOR
INSTRUCTIONS
Move instructions and the DSP accumulator class of
instructions provide a greater degree of addressing
flexibility than other instructions. In addition to the
addressing modes supported by most MCU instructions, move and accumulator instructions also support
Register Indirect with Register Offset Addressing
mode, also referred to as Register Indexed mode.
Note:
For the MOV instructions, the addressing
mode specified in the instruction can differ
for the source and destination EA.
However, the 4-bit Wb (register offset) field
is shared between both source and
destination (but typically only used by one).
In summary, the following addressing modes are
supported by move and accumulator instructions:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Register Direct
Register Indirect
Register Indirect Post-Modified
Register Indirect Pre-Modified
Register Indirect with Register Offset (Indexed)
Register Indirect with Literal Offset
8-bit Literal
16-bit Literal
Note:
4.1.4
Not all instructions support all the addressing modes given above. Individual
instructions may support different subsets
of these addressing modes.
MAC INSTRUCTIONS
The dual source operand DSP instructions (CLR, ED,
EDAC, MAC, MPY, MPY.N, MOVSAC and MSC), also
referred to as MAC instructions, utilize a simplified set of
addressing modes to allow the user to effectively
manipulate the Data Pointers through register indirect
tables.
The two source operand prefetch registers must be
members of the set {W8, W9, W10, W11}. For data
reads, W8 and W9 will always be directed to the X
RAGU, and W10 and W11 will always be directed to the
Y AGU. The Effective Addresses (EA) generated
(before and after modification) must, therefore, be valid
addresses within X data space for W8 and W9, and Y
data space for W10 and W11.
Note:
In summary, the following addressing modes are
supported by the MAC class of instructions:
•
•
•
•
•
Register Indirect
Register Indirect Post-Modified by 2
Register Indirect Post-Modified by 4
Register Indirect Post-Modified by 6
Register Indirect with Register Offset (Indexed)
4.1.5
OTHER INSTRUCTIONS
Besides the various addressing modes outlined above,
some instructions use literal constants of various sizes.
For example, BRA (branch) instructions use 16-bit
signed literals to specify the branch destination directly,
whereas the DISI instruction uses a 14-bit unsigned
literal field. In some instructions, such as ADD Acc, the
source of an operand or result is implied by the opcode
itself. Certain operations, such as NOP, do not have any
operands.
4.2
Modulo Addressing
Modulo Addressing is a method of providing an automated means to support circular data buffers using
hardware. The objective is to remove the need for software to perform data address boundary checks when
executing tightly looped code, as is typical in many
DSP algorithms.
Modulo Addressing can operate in either data or program space (since the Data Pointer mechanism is
essentially the same for both). One circular buffer can be
supported in each of the X (which also provides the
pointers into program space) and Y data spaces. Modulo
Addressing can operate on any W register pointer. However, it is not advisable to use W14 or W15 for Modulo
Addressing, since these two registers are used as the
Stack Frame Pointer and Stack Pointer, respectively.
In general, any particular circular buffer can only be
configured to operate in one direction, as there are
certain restrictions on the buffer start address (for incrementing buffers) or end address (for decrementing
buffers) based upon the direction of the buffer.
The only exception to the usage restrictions is for buffers which have a power-of-2 length. As these buffers
satisfy the start and end address criteria, they may
operate in a Bidirectional mode (i.e., address boundary
checks will be performed on both the lower and upper
address boundaries).
Register Indirect with Register Offset
Addressing is only available for W9 (in X
data space) and W11 (in Y data space).
DS70135E-page 34
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
4.2.1
START AND END ADDRESS
4.2.2
The Modulo Addressing scheme requires that a start and
end address be specified and loaded into the 16-bit Modulo Buffer Address registers: XMODSRT, XMODEND,
YMODSRT and YMODEND (see Table 3-3).
Note:
Y space Modulo Addressing EA calculations assume word-sized data (LSb of
every EA is always clear).
The length of a circular buffer is not directly specified. It
is determined by the difference between the
corresponding start and end addresses. The maximum
possible length of the circular buffer is 32K words
(64 Kbytes).
W ADDRESS REGISTER
SELECTION
The Modulo and Bit-Reversed Addressing Control register, MODCON<15:0>, contains enable flags as well
as a W register field to specify the W Address registers.
The XWM and YWM fields select which registers operate with Modulo Addressing. If XWM = 15, X RAGU and
X WAGU Modulo Addressing are disabled. Similarly, if
YWM = 15, Y AGU Modulo Addressing is disabled.
The X Address Space Pointer W register (XWM), to
which Modulo Addressing is to be applied, is stored in
MODCON<3:0> (see Table 3-3). Modulo Addressing is
enabled for X data space when XWM is set to any value
other than 15 and the XMODEN bit is set at
MODCON<15>.
The Y Address Space Pointer W register (YWM), to
which Modulo Addressing is to be applied, is stored in
MODCON<7:4>. Modulo Addressing is enabled for Y
data space when YWM is set to any value other than 15
and the YMODEN bit is set at MODCON<14>.
FIGURE 4-1:
MODULO ADDRESSING OPERATION EXAMPLE
Byte
Address
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
DO
MOV
AGAIN:
0x1100
#0x1100,W0
W0, XMODSRT
#0x1163,W0
W0,MODEND
#0x8001,W0
W0,MODCON
#0x0000,W0
#0x1110,W1
AGAIN,#0x31
W0, [W1++]
INC W0,W0
;set modulo start address
;set modulo end address
;enable W1, X AGU for modulo
;W0 holds buffer fill value
;point W1 to buffer
;fill the 50 buffer locations
;fill the next location
;increment the fill value
0x1163
Start Addr = 0x1100
End Addr = 0x1163
Length = 0x0032 words
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 35
dsPIC30F4011/4012
4.2.3
MODULO ADDRESSING
APPLICABILITY
Modulo Addressing can be applied to the Effective
Address (EA) calculation associated with any W register.
It is important to realize that the address boundaries
check for addresses less than or greater than the upper
(for incrementing buffers) and lower (for decrementing
buffers) boundary addresses (not just equal to). Address
changes may, therefore, jump beyond boundaries and
still be adjusted correctly.
Note:
4.3
The modulo corrected Effective Address is
written back to the register only when PreModify or Post-Modify Addressing mode is
used to compute the Effective Address.
When an address offset (e.g., [W7+W2]) is
used, Modulo Addressing correction is
performed, but the contents of the register
remain unchanged.
Bit-Reversed Addressing
Bit-Reversed Addressing is intended to simplify data
reordering for radix-2 FFT algorithms. It is supported by
the X AGU for data writes only.
The modifier, which may be a constant value or register
contents, is regarded as having its bit order reversed.
The address source and destination are kept in normal
order. Thus, the only operand requiring reversal is the
modifier.
4.3.1
If the length of a bit-reversed buffer is M = 2N bytes,
then the last ’N’ bits of the data buffer start address
must be zeros.
XB<14:0> is the Bit-Reversed Addressing modifier, or
‘pivot point’, which is typically a constant. In the case of
an FFT computation, its value is equal to half of the FFT
data buffer size.
Note:
When enabled, Bit-Reversed Addressing is only
executed for Register Indirect with Pre-Increment or
Post-Increment Addressing mode and word-sized data
writes. It will not function for any other addressing
mode or for byte-sized data, and normal addresses will
be generated instead. When Bit-Reversed Addressing
is active, the W Address Pointer will always be added
to the address modifier (XB) and the offset associated
with the Register Indirect Addressing mode will be
ignored. In addition, as word-sized data is a
requirement, the LSb of the EA is ignored (and always
clear).
Note:
BIT-REVERSED ADDRESSING
IMPLEMENTATION
Bit-Reversed Addressing is enabled when:
1.
2.
3.
BWM (W register selection) in the MODCON register is any value other than 15 (the stack can not
be accessed using Bit-Reversed Addressing)
and
The BREN bit is set in the XBREV register and
The addressing mode used is Register Indirect
with Pre-Increment or Post-Increment.
FIGURE 4-2:
All bit-reversed EA calculations assume
word-sized data (LSb of every EA is
always clear). The XB value is scaled
accordingly to generate compatible (byte)
addresses.
Modulo Addressing and Bit-Reversed
Addressing should not be enabled
together. In the event that the user
attempts to do this, Bit-Reversed Addressing will assume priority when active for the
X WAGU, and X WAGU Modulo Addressing will be disabled. However, Modulo
Addressing will continue to function in the
X RAGU.
If Bit-Reversed Addressing has already been enabled
by setting the BREN (XBREV<15>) bit, then a write to
the XBREV register should not be immediately followed
by an indirect read operation using the W register that
has been designated as the Bit-Reversed Pointer.
BIT-REVERSED ADDRESS EXAMPLE
Sequential Address
b15 b14 b13 b12 b11 b10 b9 b8
b7 b6 b5 b4
b3 b2 b1
0
Bit Locations Swapped Left-to-Right
Around Center of Binary Value
b15 b14 b13 b12 b11 b10 b9 b8
b7 b6 b5 b1
b2 b3 b4
0
Bit-Reversed Address
Pivot Point
XB = 0x0008 for a 16-Word Bit-Reversed Buffer
DS70135E-page 36
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 4-2:
BIT-REVERSED ADDRESS SEQUENCE (16-ENTRY)
Normal Address
Bit-Reversed Address
A3
A2
A1
A0
Decimal
A3
A2
A1
A0
Decimal
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
8
0
0
1
0
2
0
1
0
0
4
0
0
1
1
3
1
1
0
0
12
0
1
0
0
4
0
0
1
0
2
0
1
0
1
5
1
0
1
0
10
0
1
1
0
6
0
1
1
0
6
0
1
1
1
7
1
1
1
0
14
1
0
0
0
8
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
9
1
0
0
1
9
1
0
1
0
10
0
1
0
1
5
1
0
1
1
11
1
1
0
1
13
1
1
0
0
12
0
0
1
1
3
1
1
0
1
13
1
0
1
1
11
1
1
1
0
14
0
1
1
1
7
1
1
1
1
15
1
1
1
1
15
TABLE 4-3:
BIT-REVERSED ADDRESS MODIFIER VALUES FOR XBREV REGISTER
Buffer Size (Words)
XB<14:0> Bit-Reversed Address Modifier Value*
32768
0x4000
16384
0x2000
8192
0x1000
4096
0x0800
2048
0x0400
1024
0x0200
512
0x0100
256
0x0080
128
0x0040
64
0x0020
32
0x0010
16
0x0008
8
0x0004
4
0x0002
2
0x0001
*Modifier values for buffer sizes greater than 1024 words will exceed the available data memory on the
dsPIC30F4011/4012 devices.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 37
dsPIC30F4011/4012
NOTES:
DS70135E-page 38
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
5.0
INTERRUPTS
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
The dsPIC30F4011/4012 has 30 interrupt sources and
4 processor exceptions (traps), which must be
arbitrated based on a priority scheme.
The CPU is responsible for reading the Interrupt
Vector Table (IVT) and transferring the address contained in the interrupt vector to the program counter.
The interrupt vector is transferred from the program
data bus into the program counter via a 24-bit wide
multiplexer on the input of the program counter.
The Interrupt Vector Table (IVT) and Alternate
Interrupt Vector Table (AIVT) are placed near the
beginning of program memory (0x000004). The IVT
and AIVT are shown in Figure 5-1.
The interrupt controller is responsible for preprocessing the interrupts and processor exceptions,
prior to their being presented to the processor core.
The peripheral interrupts and traps are enabled,
prioritized and controlled using centralized Special
Function Registers:
• IFS0<15:0>, IFS1<15:0>, IFS2<15:0>
All interrupt request flags are maintained in these
three registers. The flags are set by their respective peripherals or external signals, and they are
cleared via software.
• IEC0<15:0>, IEC1<15:0>, IEC2<15:0>
All interrupt enable control bits are maintained in
these three registers. These control bits are used
to individually enable interrupts from the
peripherals or external signals.
• IPC0<15:0>... IPC11<7:0>
The user-assignable priority level associated with
each of these interrupts is held centrally in these
twelve registers.
• IPL<3:0>
The current CPU priority level is explicitly stored
in the IPL bits. IPL<3> is present in the CORCON
register, whereas IPL<2:0> are present in the
STATUS register (SR) in the processor core.
• INTCON1<15:0>, INTCON2<15:0>
Global interrupt control functions are derived from
these two registers. INTCON1 contains the control and status flags for the processor exceptions.
The INTCON2 register controls the external
interrupt request signal behavior and the use of
the AIVT.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Note:
Interrupt flag bits get set when an interrupt
condition occurs, regardless of the state of
its corresponding enable bit. User
software should ensure the appropriate
interrupt flag bits are clear prior to
enabling an interrupt.
All interrupt sources can be user-assigned to one of
seven priority levels, 1 through 7, via the IPCx
registers. Each interrupt source is associated with an
interrupt vector, as shown in Table 5-1. Levels 7 and 1
represent the highest and lowest maskable priorities,
respectively.
Note:
Assigning a priority level of 0 to an
interrupt source is equivalent to disabling
that interrupt.
If the NSTDIS bit (INTCON1<15>) is set, nesting of
interrupts is prevented. Thus, if an interrupt is currently
being serviced, processing of a new interrupt is prevented, even if the new interrupt is of higher priority
than the one currently being serviced.
Note:
The IPL bits become read-only whenever
the NSTDIS bit has been set to ‘1’.
Certain interrupts have specialized control bits for features like edge or level triggered interrupts, interrupton-change, etc. Control of these features remains
within the peripheral module which generates the
interrupt.
The DISI instruction can be used to disable the
processing of interrupts of priorities 6 and lower for a
certain number of instructions, during which the DISI bit
(INTCON2<14>) remains set.
When an interrupt is serviced, the PC is loaded with the
address stored in the vector location in program memory
that corresponds to the interrupt. There are 63 different
vectors within the IVT (refer to Figure 5-2). These vectors are contained in locations 0x000004 through
0x0000FE of program memory (refer to Figure 5-2).
These locations contain 24-bit addresses, and in order
to preserve robustness, an address error trap will take
place should the PC attempt to fetch any of these words
during normal execution. This prevents execution of
random data as a result of accidentally decrementing a
PC into vector space, accidentally mapping a data space
address into vector space or the PC rolling over to
0x000000 after reaching the end of implemented
program memory space. Execution of a GOTO instruction
to this vector space will also generate an address error
trap.
DS70135E-page 39
dsPIC30F4011/4012
5.1Interrupt Priority
The user-assignable Interrupt Priority (IP<2:0>) bits for
each individual interrupt source are located in the Least
Significant 3 bits of each nibble within the IPCx register(s). Bit 3 of each nibble is not used and is read as a
‘0’. These bits define the priority level assigned to a
particular interrupt by the user.
Note:
The user-selectable priority levels start at
0 as the lowest priority, and level 7 as the
highest priority.
Since more than one interrupt request source may be
assigned to a specific user-specified priority level, a
means is provided to assign priority within a given level.
This method is called “Natural Order Priority”.
Natural order priority is determined by the position of
an interrupt in the vector table, and only affects
interrupt operation when multiple interrupts with the
same user-assigned priority become pending at the
same time.
Table 5-1 lists the interrupt numbers and interrupt
sources for the dsPIC DSCs and their associated
vector numbers.
Note 1: The natural order priority scheme has 0
as the highest priority and 53 as the
lowest priority.
2: The natural order priority number is the
same as the INT number.
The ability for the user to assign every interrupt to one
of seven priority levels implies that the user can assign
a very high overall priority level to an interrupt with a
low natural order priority. For example, the PLVD (LowVoltage Detect) can be given a priority of 7. The INT0
(External Interrupt 0) may be assigned to priority
level 1, thus giving it a very low effective priority.
TABLE 5-1:
INT
Number
INTERRUPT VECTOR TABLE
Vector
Number
Interrupt Source
Highest Natural Order Priority
0
8
INT0 – External Interrupt 0
1
2
3
4
5
6
9
10
11
12
13
14
IC1 – Input Capture 1
OC1 – Output Compare 1
T1 – Timer 1
IC2 – Input Capture 2
OC2 – Output Compare 2
T2 – Timer 2
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
T3 – Timer 3
SPI1
U1RX – UART1 Receiver
U1TX – UART1 Transmitter
ADC – ADC Convert Done
NVM – NVM Write Complete
SI2C – I2C™ Slave Interrupt
MI2C – I2C Master Interrupt
Input Change Interrupt
INT1 – External Interrupt 1
IC7 – Input Capture 7
IC8 – Input Capture 8
OC3 – Output Compare 3
OC4 – Output Compare 4
T4 – Timer4
T5 – Timer5
INT2 – External Interrupt 2
U2RX – UART2 Receiver
U2TX – UART2 Transmitter
Reserved
C1 – Combined IRQ for CAN1
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
PWM – PWM Period Match
QEI – QEI Interrupt
Reserved
Reserved
43
51
FLTA – PWM Fault A
44
52
Reserved
45-53
53-61 Reserved
Lowest Natural Order Priority
DS70135E-page 40
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
5.2
Reset Sequence
A Reset is not a true exception, because the interrupt
controller is not involved in the Reset process. The processor initializes its registers in response to a Reset,
which forces the PC to zero. The processor then begins
program execution at location 0x000000. A GOTO
instruction is stored in the first program memory location, immediately followed by the address target for the
GOTO instruction. The processor executes the GOTO to
the specified address and then begins operation at the
specified target (start) address.
5.2.1
5.3
Traps
Traps can be considered as non-maskable interrupts,
indicating a software or hardware error which adhere to
a predefined priority, as shown in Figure 5-1. They are
intended to provide the user a means to correct erroneous operation during debug and when operating within
the application.
Note:
RESET SOURCES
There are 5 sources of error which will cause a device
reset.
• Watchdog Time-out:
The watchdog has timed out, indicating that the
processor is no longer executing the correct flow
of code.
• Uninitialized W Register Trap:
An attempt to use an uninitialized W register as
an Address Pointer will cause a Reset.
• Illegal Instruction Trap:
Attempted execution of any unused opcodes will
result in an illegal instruction trap. Note that a
fetch of an illegal instruction does not result in an
illegal instruction trap if that instruction is flushed
prior to execution due to a flow change.
• Brown-out Reset (BOR):
A momentary dip in the power supply to the
device has been detected which may result in
malfunction.
• Trap Lockout:
Occurrence of multiple trap conditions
simultaneously will cause a Reset.
If the user does not intend to take corrective action in the event of a trap error
condition, these vectors must be loaded
with the address of a default handler that
simply contains the RESET instruction. If,
on the other hand, one of the vectors
containing an invalid address is called, an
address error trap is generated.
Note that many of these trap conditions can only be
detected when they occur. Consequently, the questionable instruction is allowed to complete prior to trap
exception processing. If the user chooses to recover
from the error, the result of the erroneous action that
caused the trap may have to be corrected.
There are 8 fixed priority levels for traps, Level 8
through Level 15, which means that the IPL3 is always
set during processing of a trap.
If the user is not currently executing a trap and he sets
the IPL<3:0> bits to a value of ‘0111’ (Level 7), then all
interrupts are disabled, but traps can still be processed.
5.3.1
TRAP SOURCES
The following traps are provided with increasing
priority. However, since all traps can be nested, priority
has little effect.
5.3.1.1
Math Error Trap
The math error trap executes under the following four
circumstances:
1.
2.
3.
4.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Should an attempt be made to divide by zero,
the divide operation will be aborted on a cycle
boundary and the trap taken.
If enabled, a math error trap will be taken when
an arithmetic operation on either accumulator A
or B causes an overflow from bit 31 and the
accumulator guard bits are not utilized.
If enabled, a math error trap will be taken when
an arithmetic operation on either accumulator A
or B causes a catastrophic overflow from bit 39
and all saturation is disabled.
If the shift amount specified in a shift instruction
is greater than the maximum allowed shift
amount, a trap will occur.
DS70135E-page 41
dsPIC30F4011/4012
5.3.1.2
Address Error Trap
This trap is initiated when any of the following
circumstances occurs:
1.
2.
3.
4.
A misaligned data word access is attempted.
A data fetch from an unimplemented data
memory location is attempted.
A data access of an unimplemented program
memory location is attempted.
An instruction fetch from vector space is
attempted.
Note:
5.
6.
In the MAC class of instructions, wherein
the data space is split into X and Y data
space, unimplemented X space includes
all of Y space and unimplemented Y space
includes all of X space.
Execution of a “BRA #literal” instruction, or a
“GOTO #literal” instruction, where literal
is an unimplemented program memory address.
Executing instructions after modifying the PC to
point to unimplemented program memory
addresses. The PC may be modified by loading
a value into the stack and executing a RETURN
instruction.
5.3.1.3
Stack Error Trap
5.3.2
HARD AND SOFT TRAPS
It is possible that multiple traps can become active
within the same cycle (e.g., a misaligned word stack
write to an overflowed address). In such a case, the
fixed priority shown in Figure 5-2 is implemented,
which may require the user to check if other traps are
pending in order to completely correct the Fault.
‘Soft’ traps include exceptions of priority level 8 through
level 11, inclusive. The arithmetic error trap (level 11)
falls into this category of traps.
‘Hard’ traps include exceptions of priority level 12
through level 15, inclusive. The address error (level
12), stack error (level 13) and oscillator error (level 14)
traps fall into this category.
Each hard trap that occurs must be acknowledged
before code execution of any type may continue. If a
lower priority hard trap occurs while a higher priority
trap is pending, acknowledged or is being processed, a
hard trap conflict will occur.
The device is automatically Reset in a hard trap conflict
condition. The TRAPR status bit (RCON<15>) is set
when the Reset occurs, so that the condition may be
detected in software.
FIGURE 5-1:
TRAP VECTORS
1.
2.
The Stack Pointer is loaded with a value which
is greater than the (user-programmable) limit
value written into the SPLIM register (stack
overflow).
The Stack Pointer is loaded with a value which
is less than 0x0800 (simple stack underflow).
5.3.1.4
Decreasing
Priority
This trap is initiated under the following conditions:
IVT
Oscillator Fail Trap
This trap is initiated if the external oscillator fails and
operation becomes reliant on an internal RC backup.
AIVT
DS70135E-page 42
Reset – GOTO Instruction
Reset – GOTO Address
Reserved
Oscillator Fail Trap Vector
Address Error Trap Vector
Stack Error Trap Vector
Math Error Trap Vector
Reserved Vector
Reserved Vector
Reserved Vector
Interrupt 0 Vector
Interrupt 1 Vector
—
—
—
Interrupt 52 Vector
Interrupt 53 Vector
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Oscillator Fail Trap Vector
Stack Error Trap Vector
Address Error Trap Vector
Math Error Trap Vector
Reserved Vector
Reserved Vector
Reserved Vector
Interrupt 0 Vector
Interrupt 1 Vector
—
—
—
Interrupt 52 Vector
Interrupt 53 Vector
0x000000
0x000002
0x000004
0x000014
0x00007E
0x000080
0x000082
0x000084
0x000094
0x0000FE
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
5.4
Interrupt Sequence
5.5
All interrupt event flags are sampled in the beginning of
each instruction cycle by the IFSx registers. A pending
interrupt request (IRQ) is indicated by the flag bit being
equal to a ‘1’ in an IFSx register. The IRQ will cause an
interrupt to occur if the corresponding bit in the interrupt
enable (IECx) register is set. For the remainder of the
instruction cycle, the priorities of all pending interrupt
requests are evaluated.
If there is a pending IRQ with a priority level greater
than the current processor priority level in the IPL bits,
the processor will be interrupted.
The processor then stacks the current program counter
and the low byte of the processor STATUS register
(SRL), as shown in Figure 5-2. The low byte of the
STATUS register contains the processor priority level at
the time prior to the beginning of the interrupt cycle.
The processor then loads the priority level for this interrupt into the STATUS register. This action will disable
all lower priority interrupts until the completion of the
Interrupt Service Routine.
FIGURE 5-2:
Stack Grows Towards
Higher Address
0x0000 15
INTERRUPT STACK
FRAME
0
PC<15:0>
SRL IPL3 PC<22:16>
<Free Word>
W15 (before CALL)
W15 (after CALL)
POP : [--W15]
PUSH: [W15++]
Note 1: The user can always lower the priority level
by writing a new value into SR. The Interrupt
Service Routine must clear the interrupt flag
bits in the IFSx register before lowering the
processor interrupt priority in order to avoid
recursive interrupts.
2: The IPL3 bit (CORCON<3>) is always clear
when interrupts are being processed. It is
set only during execution of traps.
The RETFIE (return from interrupt) instruction will
unstack the program counter and STATUS registers to
return the processor to its state prior to the interrupt
sequence.
Alternate Interrupt Vector Table
In program memory, the Interrupt Vector Table (IVT) is
followed by the Alternate Interrupt Vector Table (AIVT),
as shown in Figure 5-1. Access to the Alternate Interrupt Vector Table is provided by the ALTIVT bit in the
INTCON2 register. If the ALTIVT bit is set, all interrupt
and exception processes will use the alternate vectors
instead of the default vectors. The alternate vectors are
organized in the same manner as the default vectors.
The AIVT supports emulation and debugging efforts by
providing a means to switch between an application
and a support environment, without requiring the interrupt vectors to be reprogrammed. This feature also
enables switching between applications for evaluation
of different software algorithms at run time.
If the AIVT is not required, the program memory
allocated to the AIVT may be used for other purposes.
AIVT is not a protected section and may be freely
programmed by the user.
5.6
Fast Context Saving
A context saving option is available using shadow registers. Shadow registers are provided for the DC, N,
OV, Z and C bits in SR, and the registers W0 through
W3. The shadows are only one-level deep. The
shadow registers are accessible using the PUSH.S and
POP.S instructions only.
When the processor vectors to an interrupt, the
PUSH.S instruction can be used to store the current
value of the aforementioned registers into their
respective shadow registers.
If an ISR of a certain priority uses the PUSH.S and
POP.S instructions for fast context saving, then a
higher priority ISR should not include the same instructions. Users must save the key registers in software
during a lower priority interrupt if the higher priority ISR
uses fast context saving.
5.7
External Interrupt Requests
The interrupt controller supports three external interrupt request signals, INT0-INT2. These inputs are edge
sensitive; they require a low-to-high, or a high-to-low
transition, to generate an interrupt request. The
INTCON2 register has three bits, INT0EP-INT2EP, that
select the polarity of the edge detection circuitry.
5.8
Wake-up from Sleep and Idle
The interrupt controller may be used to wake-up the
processor from either Sleep or Idle modes if Sleep or
Idle modes are active when the interrupt is generated.
If an enabled interrupt request of sufficient priority is
received by the interrupt controller, then the standard
interrupt request is presented to the processor. At the
same time, the processor will wake-up from Sleep or
Idle and begin execution of the Interrupt Service
Routine (ISR) needed to process the interrupt request.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 43
SFR
Name
ADR
INTERRUPT CONTROLLER REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
INTCON1
0080 NSTDIS
—
—
—
—
OVATE
OVBTE
COVTE
—
—
—
MATHERR
ADDRERR
INTCON2
0082 ALTIVT
DISI
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
INT2EP
Bit 1
STKERR OSCFAIL
INT1EP
Bit 0
Reset State
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
INT0EP 0000 0000 0000 0000
IFS0
0084
CNIF
MI2CIF
SI2CIF
NVMIF
ADIF
U1TXIF
U1RXIF
SPI1IF
T3IF
T2IF
OC2IF
IC2IF
T1IF
OC1IF
IC1IF
INT0IF
0000 0000 0000 0000
IFS1
0086
—
—
—
—
C1IF
—
U2TXIF
U2RXIF
INT2IF
T5IF
T4IF
OC4IF
OC3IF
IC8IF
IC7IF
INT1IF
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
IFS2
0088
—
—
—
—
FLTAIF
IEC0
008C
CNIE
MI2CIE
SI2CIE
NVMIE
ADIE
IEC1
008E
—
—
—
—
C1IE
—
IEC2
0090
—
—
—
—
FLTAIE
—
IPC0
0094
—
T1IP<2:0>
—
IPC1
0096
—
T31P<2:0>
IPC2
0098
—
ADIP<2:0>
IPC3
009A
—
IPC4
009C
IPC5
QEIIF
PWMIF
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
SPI1IE
T3IE
T2IE
OC2IE
IC2IE
T1IE
OC1IE
IC1IE
INT0IE
0000 0000 0000 0000
U2TXIE
U2RXIE
INT2IE
T5IE
T4IE
OC4IE
OC3IE
IC8IE
IC7IE
INT1IE
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
QEIIE
PWMIE
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
U1TXIE U1RXIE
OC1IP<2:0>
—
—
T2IP<2:0>
—
U1TXIP<2:0>
CNIP<2:0>
—
—
OC3IP<2:0>
009E
—
IPC6
00A0
—
IPC7
00A2
—
—
—
IPC8
00A4
—
—
—
IPC9
00A6
—
IPC10
00A8
—
IPC11
00AA
—
Legend:
u = uninitialized bit
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
—
IC1IP<2:0>
—
—
OC2IP<2:0>
—
U1RXIP<2:0>
MI2CIP<2:0>
—
—
IC8IP<2:0>
INT2IP<2:0>
—
T5IP<2:0>
C1IP<2:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PWMIP<2:0>
FLTAIP<2:0>
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
INT0IP<2:0>
0100 0100 0100 0100
—
IC2IP<2:0>
0100 0100 0100 0100
—
SPI1IP<2:0>
0100 0100 0100 0100
SI2CIP<2:0>
—
NVMIP<2:0>
0100 0100 0100 0100
—
IC7IP<2:0>
—
INT1IP<2:0>
0100 0100 0100 0100
—
T4IP<2:0>
—
OC4IP<2:0>
0100 0100 0100 0100
—
—
U2TXIP<2:0>
—
U2RXIP<2:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0100 0000 0100 0100
QEIIP<2:0>
—
—
0100 0000 0100 0100
0100 0000 0000 0100
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 44
TABLE 5-2:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
6.0
FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
6.2
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
RTSP is accomplished using TBLRD (table read) and
TBLWT (table write) instructions.
With RTSP, the user may erase program memory,
32 instructions (96 bytes) at a time, and can write
program memory data, 32 instructions (96 bytes) at a
time.
The dsPIC30F family of devices contains internal
program Flash memory for executing user code. There
are two methods by which the user can program this
memory:
1.
2.
6.1
6.3
Table Instruction Operation Summary
The TBLRDL and the TBLWTL instructions are used to
read or write to bits <15:0> of program memory.
TBLRDL and TBLWTL can access program memory in
Word or Byte mode.
In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™)
Run-Time Self-Programming (RTSP)
The TBLRDH and TBLWTH instructions are used to read
or write to bits<23:16> of program memory. TBLRDH
and TBLWTH can access program memory in Word or
Byte mode.
In-Circuit Serial Programming
(ICSP)
dsPIC30F devices can be serially programmed while in
the end application circuit. This is simply done with two
lines for Programming Clock and Programming Data
(which are named PGC and PGD, respectively), and
three other lines for Power (VDD), Ground (VSS) and
Master Clear (MCLR). This allows customers to manufacture boards with unprogrammed devices, and then
program the digital signal controller just before shipping
the product. This also allows the most recent firmware
or a custom firmware to be programmed.
FIGURE 6-1:
Run-Time Self-Programming
(RTSP)
A 24-bit program memory address is formed using
bits<7:0> of the TBLPAG register and the Effective
Address (EA) from a W register, specified in the table
instruction, as shown in Figure 6-1.
ADDRESSING FOR TABLE AND NVM REGISTERS
24 bits
Using
Program
Counter
Program Counter
0
0
NVMADR Reg EA
Using
NVMADR
Addressing
1/0
NVMADRU Reg
8 bits
16 bits
Working Reg EA
Using
Table
Instruction
User/Configuration
Space Select
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
1/0
TBLPAG Reg
8 bits
16 bits
24-bit EA
Byte
Select
DS70135E-page 45
dsPIC30F4011/4012
6.4
RTSP Operation
The dsPIC30F Flash program memory is organized
into rows and panels. Each row consists of 32 instructions or 96 bytes. Each panel consists of 128 rows or
4K x 24 instructions. RTSP allows the user to erase one
row (32 instructions) at a time and to program
32 instructions at one time.
Each panel of program memory contains write latches
that hold 32 instructions of programming data. Prior to
the actual programming operation, the write data must
be loaded into the panel write latches. The data to be
programmed into the panel is loaded in sequential
order into the write latches: instruction 0, instruction 1,
etc. The addresses loaded must always be from a
32 address boundary.
6.5
RTSP Control Registers
The four SFRs used to read and write the program
Flash memory are:
•
•
•
•
NVMCON
NVMADR
NVMADRU
NVMKEY
6.5.1
NVMCON REGISTER
The NVMCON register controls which blocks are to be
erased, which memory type is to be programmed and
the start of the programming cycle.
6.5.2
NVMADR REGISTER
The basic sequence for RTSP programming is to set up
a Table Pointer, then do a series of TBLWT instructions
to load the write latches. Programming is performed by
setting the special bits in the NVMCON register.
32 TBLWTL and 32 TBLWTH instructions are required
to load the 32 instructions.
The NVMADR register is used to hold the lower two
bytes of the Effective Address. The NVMADR register
captures the EA<15:0> of the last table instruction that
has been executed and selects the row to write.
All of the table write operations are single-word writes
(2 instruction cycles) because only the table latches are
written.
The NVMADRU register is used to hold the upper byte
of the Effective Address. The NVMADRU register captures the EA<23:16> of the last table instruction that
has been executed.
After the latches are written, a programming operation
needs to be initiated to program the data.
The Flash program memory is readable, writable and
erasable during normal operation over the entire VDD
range.
6.5.3
6.5.4
NVMKEY REGISTER
NVMKEY is a write-only register that is used for write
protection. To start a programming or an erase
sequence, the user must consecutively write 0x55 and
0xAA to the NVMKEY register. Refer to Section 6.6
“Programming Operations” for further details.
Note:
DS70135E-page 46
NVMADRU REGISTER
The user can also directly write to the
NVMADR and NVMADRU registers to
specify a program memory address for
erasing or programming.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
6.6
Programming Operations
A complete programming sequence is necessary for
programming or erasing the internal Flash in RTSP
mode. A programming operation is nominally 2 msec in
duration and the processor stalls (waits) until the operation is finished. Setting the WR bit (NVMCON<15>)
starts the operation, and the WR bit is automatically
cleared when the operation is finished.
6.6.1
4.
5.
PROGRAMMING ALGORITHM FOR
PROGRAM FLASH
The user can erase or program one row of program
Flash memory at a time. The general process is:
1.
2.
3.
Read one row of program Flash (32 instruction
words) and store into data RAM as a data
“image”.
Update the data image with the desired new
data.
Erase program Flash row.
a) Set up NVMCON register for multi-word,
program Flash, erase and set WREN bit.
b) Write address of row to be erased into
NVMADRU/NVMDR.
c) Write ‘55’ to NVMKEY.
d) Write ‘AA’ to NVMKEY.
e) Set the WR bit. This will begin erase cycle.
f) CPU will stall for the duration of the erase
cycle.
g) The WR bit is cleared when erase cycle
ends.
EXAMPLE 6-1:
6.
Write 32 instruction words of data from data
RAM “image” into the program Flash write
latches.
Program 32 instruction words into program
Flash.
a) Setup NVMCON register for multi-word,
program Flash, program and set WREN bit.
b) Write ‘55’ to NVMKEY.
c) Write ‘AA’ to NVMKEY.
d) Set the WR bit. This will begin program
cycle.
e) CPU will stall for duration of the program
cycle.
f) The WR bit is cleared by the hardware
when program cycle ends.
Repeat steps 1 through 5 as needed to program
desired amount of program Flash memory.
6.6.2
ERASING A ROW OF PROGRAM
MEMORY
Example 6-1 shows a code sequence that can be used
to erase a row (32 instructions) of program memory.
ERASING A ROW OF PROGRAM MEMORY
; Setup NVMCON for erase operation, multi word
; program memory selected, and writes enabled
MOV
#0x4041,W0
;
;
MOV
W0,NVMCON
; Init pointer to row to be ERASED
MOV
#tblpage(PROG_ADDR),W0
;
;
MOV
W0,NVMADRU
MOV
#tbloffset(PROG_ADDR),W0
;
MOV
W0, NVMADR
;
DISI
#5
;
;
MOV
#0x55,W0
;
MOV
W0,NVMKEY
MOV
#0xAA,W1
;
;
MOV
W1,NVMKEY
BSET
NVMCON,#WR
;
NOP
;
NOP
;
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
write
Init NVMCON SFR
Initialize PM Page Boundary SFR
Intialize in-page EA[15:0] pointer
Intialize NVMADR SFR
Block all interrupts with priority <7
for next 5 instructions
Write the 0x55 key
Write the 0xAA key
Start the erase sequence
Insert two NOPs after the erase
command is asserted
DS70135E-page 47
dsPIC30F4011/4012
6.6.3
LOADING WRITE LATCHES
Example 6-2 shows a sequence of instructions that
can be used to load the 96 bytes of write latches.
32 TBLWTL and 32 TBLWTH instructions are needed to
load the write latches selected by the Table Pointer.
EXAMPLE 6-2:
LOADING WRITE LATCHES
; Set up a pointer to the first program memory location to be written
; program memory selected, and writes enabled
MOV
#0x0000,W0
;
; Initialize PM Page Boundary SFR
MOV
W0,TBLPAG
MOV
#0x6000,W0
; An example program memory address
; Perform the TBLWT instructions to write the latches
; 0th_program_word
MOV
#LOW_WORD_0,W2
;
MOV
#HIGH_BYTE_0,W3
;
; Write PM low word into program latch
TBLWTL W2,[W0]
; Write PM high byte into program latch
TBLWTH W3,[W0++]
; 1st_program_word
MOV
#LOW_WORD_1,W2
;
MOV
#HIGH_BYTE_1,W3
;
; Write PM low word into program latch
TBLWTL W2,[W0]
TBLWTH W3,[W0++]
; Write PM high byte into program latch
; 2nd_program_word
MOV
#LOW_WORD_2,W2
;
MOV
#HIGH_BYTE_2,W3
;
; Write PM low word into program latch
TBLWTL W2, [W0]
; Write PM high byte into program latch
TBLWTH W3, [W0++]
•
•
•
; 31st_program_word
MOV
#LOW_WORD_31,W2
;
MOV
#HIGH_BYTE_31,W3
;
; Write PM low word into program latch
TBLWTL W2, [W0]
; Write PM high byte into program latch
TBLWTH W3, [W0++]
Note: In Example 6-2, the contents of the upper byte of W3 has no effect.
6.6.4
INITIATING THE PROGRAMMING
SEQUENCE
For protection, the write initiate sequence for NVMKEY
must be used to allow any erase or program operation
to proceed. After the programming command has been
executed, the user must wait for the programming time
until programming is complete. The two instructions
following the start of the programming sequence
should be NOPs.
EXAMPLE 6-3:
INITIATING A PROGRAMMING SEQUENCE
DISI
#5
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
BSET
NOP
NOP
#0x55,W0
W0,NVMKEY
#0xAA,W1
W1,NVMKEY
NVMCON,#WR
DS70135E-page 48
; Block all interrupts with priority <7
; for next 5 instructions
;
;
;
;
;
;
Write the 0x55 key
Write the 0xAA key
Start the erase sequence
Insert two NOPs after the erase
command is asserted
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 6-1:
File Name
NVM REGISTER MAP
Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9
NVMCON
0760
WR
WREN
WRERR
NVMADR
0762
NVMADRU
0764
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
NVMKEY
0766
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Bit 8
Bit 7
TWRI
—
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
PROGOP<6:0>
NVMADR<15:0>
—
Legend:
u = uninitialized bit
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
Bit 1
Bit 0
All Resets
0000 0000 0000 0000
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
NVMADR<22:16>
0000 0000 uuuu uuuu
KEY<7:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 49
dsPIC30F4011/4012
NOTES:
DS70135E-page 50
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
7.0
DATA EEPROM MEMORY
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
The data EEPROM memory is readable and writable
during normal operation over the entire VDD range. The
data EEPROM memory is directly mapped in the
program memory address space.
The four SFRs used to read and write the program
Flash memory are used to access data EEPROM
memory, as well. As described in Section 6.0 “Flash
Program Memory”, these registers are:
•
•
•
•
NVMCON
NVMADR
NVMADRU
NVMKEY
The EEPROM data memory allows read and write of
single words and 16-word blocks. When interfacing to
data memory, NVMADR, in conjunction with the
NVMADRU register, is used to address the EEPROM
location being accessed. TBLRDL and TBLWTL instructions are used to read and write data EEPROM. The
dsPIC30F4011/4012 devices have 1 Kbyte (512 words)
of data EEPROM, with an address range from
0x7FFC00 to 0x7FFFFE.
Control bit, WR, initiates write operations, similar to
program Flash writes. This bit cannot be cleared, only
set, in software. This bit is cleared in hardware at the
completion of the write operation. The inability to clear
the WR bit in software prevents the accidental or
premature termination of a write operation.
The WREN bit, when set, will allow a write operation.
On power-up, the WREN bit is clear. The WRERR bit is
set when a write operation is interrupted by a MCLR
Reset, or a WDT Time-out Reset, during normal operation. In these situations, following Reset, the user can
check the WRERR bit and rewrite the location. The
address register, NVMADR, remains unchanged.
Note:
7.1
Interrupt flag bit, NVMIF in the IFS0 register, is set when write is complete. It must
be cleared in software.
Reading the Data EEPROM
A TBLRD instruction reads a word at the current program word address. This example uses W0 as a
pointer to data EEPROM. The result is placed in
register W4, as shown in Example 7-1.
EXAMPLE 7-1:
MOV
MOV
MOV
TBLRDL
DATA EEPROM READ
#LOW_ADDR_WORD,W0 ; Init Pointer
#HIGH_ADDR_WORD,W1
W1,TBLPAG
[ W0 ], W4
; read data EEPROM
A word write operation should be preceded by an erase
of the corresponding memory location(s). The write
typically requires 2 ms to complete, but the write time
will vary with voltage and temperature.
A program or erase operation on the data EEPROM
does not stop the instruction flow. The user is responsible for waiting for the appropriate duration of time
before initiating another data EEPROM write/erase
operation. Attempting to read the data EEPROM while
a programming or erase operation is in progress results
in unspecified data.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 51
dsPIC30F4011/4012
7.2
7.2.1
Erasing Data EEPROM
ERASING A BLOCK OF DATA
EEPROM
In order to erase a block of data EEPROM, the
NVMADRU and NVMADR registers must initially
point to the block of memory to be erased. Configure
NVMCON for erasing a block of data EEPROM and
set the WR and WREN bits in the NVMCON register.
Setting the WR bit initiates the erase, as shown in
Example 7-2.
EXAMPLE 7-2:
DATA EEPROM BLOCK ERASE
; Select data EEPROM block, WR, WREN bits
MOV
#0x4045,W0
; Initialize NVMCON SFR
MOV
W0,NVMCON
; Start erase cycle by setting WR after writing key sequence
DISI
#5
; Block all interrupts with priority <7
; for next 5 instructions
MOV
#0x55,W0
;
; Write the 0x55 key
MOV
W0,NVMKEY
MOV
#0xAA,W1
;
MOV
W1,NVMKEY
; Write the 0xAA key
BSET
NVMCON,#WR
; Initiate erase sequence
NOP
NOP
; Erase cycle will complete in 2mS. CPU is not stalled for the Data Erase Cycle
; User can poll WR bit, use NVMIF or Timer IRQ to determine erasure complete
7.2.2
ERASING A WORD OF DATA
EEPROM
The TBLPAG and NVMADR registers must point to
the block. Select erase a block of data Flash and set
the WR and WREN bits in the NVMCON register.
Setting the WR bit initiates the erase, as shown in
Example 7-3.
EXAMPLE 7-3:
DATA EEPROM WORD ERASE
; Select data EEPROM word, WR, WREN bits
MOV
#0x4044,W0
MOV
W0,NVMCON
; Start erase cycle by setting WR after writing key sequence
DISI
#5
; Block all interrupts with priority <7
; for next 5 instructions
MOV
#0x55,W0
;
; Write the 0x55 key
MOV
W0,NVMKEY
MOV
#0xAA,W1
;
; Write the 0xAA key
MOV
W1,NVMKEY
BSET
NVMCON,#WR
; Initiate erase sequence
NOP
NOP
; Erase cycle will complete in 2mS. CPU is not stalled for the Data Erase Cycle
; User can poll WR bit, use NVMIF or Timer IRQ to determine erasure complete
DS70135E-page 52
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
7.3
Writing to the Data EEPROM
To write an EEPROM data location, the following
sequence must be followed:
1.
2.
3.
Erase data EEPROM word.
a) Select word, data EEPROM; erase and set
WREN bit in NVMCON register.
b) Write address of word to be erased into
NVMADRU/NVMADR.
c) Enable NVM interrupt (optional).
d) Write ‘55’ to NVMKEY.
e) Write ‘AA’ to NVMKEY.
f) Set the WR bit. This will begin erase cycle.
g) Either poll NVMIF bit or wait for NVMIF
interrupt.
h) The WR bit is cleared when the erase cycle
ends.
Write data word into data EEPROM write
latches.
Program 1 data word into data EEPROM.
a) Select word, data EEPROM; program and
set WREN bit in NVMCON register.
b) Enable NVM write done interrupt (optional).
c) Write ‘55’ to NVMKEY.
d) Write ‘AA’ to NVMKEY.
e) Set the WR bit. This will begin program
cycle.
f) Either poll NVMIF bit or wait for NVM
interrupt.
g) The WR bit is cleared when the write cycle
ends.
EXAMPLE 7-4:
The write will not initiate if the above sequence is not
exactly followed (write 0x55 to NVMKEY, write 0xAA to
NVMCON, then set WR bit) for each word. It is strongly
recommended that interrupts be disabled during this
code segment.
Additionally, the WREN bit in NVMCON must be set to
enable writes. This mechanism prevents accidental
writes to data EEPROM due to unexpected code execution. The WREN bit should be kept clear at all times
except when updating the EEPROM. The WREN bit is
not cleared by hardware.
After a write sequence has been initiated, clearing the
WREN bit will not affect the current write cycle. The WR
bit will be inhibited from being set unless the WREN bit
is set. The WREN bit must be set on a previous instruction. Both WR and WREN cannot be set with the same
instruction.
At the completion of the write cycle, the WR bit is
cleared in hardware and the Nonvolatile Memory Write
Complete Interrupt Flag bit (NVMIF) is set. The user
may either enable this interrupt or poll this bit. NVMIF
must be cleared by software.
7.3.1
WRITING A WORD OF DATA
EEPROM
Once the user has erased the word to be programmed,
then a table write instruction is used to write one write
latch, as shown in Example 7-4.
DATA EEPROM WORD WRITE
; Point to data memory
MOV
#LOW_ADDR_WORD,W0
MOV
#HIGH_ADDR_WORD,W1
MOV
W1,TBLPAG
MOV
#LOW(WORD),W2
TBLWTL
W2,[ W0]
; The NVMADR captures last table access address
; Select data EEPROM for 1 word op
MOV
#0x4004,W0
MOV
W0,NVMCON
; Operate key to allow write operation
DISI
#5
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
BSET
NOP
NOP
; Write cycle will
; User can poll WR
#0x55,W0
W0,NVMKEY
#0xAA,W1
W1,NVMKEY
NVMCON,#WR
; Init pointer
; Get data
; Write data
; Block all interrupts with priority <7
; for next 5 instructions
; Write the 0x55 key
; Write the 0xAA key
; Initiate program sequence
complete in 2mS. CPU is not stalled for the Data Write Cycle
bit, use NVMIF or Timer IRQ to determine write complete
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 53
dsPIC30F4011/4012
7.3.2
WRITING A BLOCK OF DATA
EEPROM
To write a block of data EEPROM, write to all sixteen
latches first, then set the NVMCON register and
program the block.
EXAMPLE 7-5:
DATA EEPROM BLOCK WRITE
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
MOV
DISI
#LOW_ADDR_WORD,W0
#HIGH_ADDR_WORD,W1
W1,TBLPAG
#data1,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data2,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data3,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data4,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data5,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data6,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data7,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data8,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data9,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data10,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data11,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data12,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data13,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data14,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data15,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data16,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#0x400A,W0
W0,NVMCON
#5
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
BSET
NOP
NOP
#0x55,W0
W0,NVMKEY
#0xAA,W1
W1,NVMKEY
NVMCON,#WR
DS70135E-page 54
; Init pointer
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
Get 1st data
write data
Get 2nd data
write data
Get 3rd data
write data
Get 4th data
write data
Get 5th data
write data
Get 6th data
write data
Get 7th data
write data
Get 8th data
write data
Get 9th data
write data
Get 10th data
write data
Get 11th data
write data
Get 12th data
write data
Get 13th data
write data
Get 14th data
write data
Get 15th data
write data
Get 16th data
write data. The NVMADR captures last table access address.
Select data EEPROM for multi word op
Operate Key to allow program operation
Block all interrupts with priority <7
for next 5 instructions
; Write the 0x55 key
; Write the 0xAA key
; Start write cycle
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
7.4
Write Verify
Depending on the application, good programming
practice may dictate that the value written to the memory should be verified against the original value. This
should be used in applications where excessive writes
can stress bits near the specification limit.
7.5
Protection Against Spurious Write
There are conditions when the device may not want to
write to the data EEPROM memory. To protect against
spurious EEPROM writes, various mechanisms have
been built-in. On power-up, the WREN bit is cleared;
also, the Power-up Timer prevents EEPROM write.
The write initiate sequence, and the WREN bit
together, help prevent an accidental write during
brown-out, power glitch or software malfunction.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 55
dsPIC30F4011/4012
NOTES:
DS70135E-page 56
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
8.0
I/O PORTS
Any bit and its associated data and control registers
that are not valid for a particular device will be
disabled. That means the corresponding LATx and
TRISx registers and the port pin will read as zeros.
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
When a pin is shared with another peripheral or function that is defined as an input only, it is nevertheless
regarded as a dedicated port because there is no
other competing source of outputs. An example is the
INT4 pin.
All of the device pins (except VDD, VSS, MCLR and
OSC1/CLKI) are shared between the peripherals and
the parallel I/O ports.
The format of the registers for PORTx are shown in
Table 8-1.
The TRISx (Data Direction) register controls the direction of the pins. The LATx register supplies data to the
outputs and is readable/writable. Reading the PORTx
register yields the state of the input pins, while writing
to the PORTx register modifies the contents of the
LATx register.
All I/O input ports feature Schmitt Trigger inputs for
improved noise immunity.
8.1
Parallel I/O (PIO) Ports
When a peripheral is enabled and the peripheral is
actively driving an associated pin, the use of the pin as
a general purpose output pin is disabled. The I/O pin
may be read, but the output driver for the Parallel Port
bit will be disabled. If a peripheral is enabled, but the
peripheral is not actively driving a pin, that pin may be
driven by a port.
A parallel I/O (PIO) port that shares a pin with a peripheral is, in general, subservient to the peripheral. The
peripheral’s output buffer data and control signals are
provided to a pair of multiplexers. The multiplexers
select whether the peripheral or the associated port
has ownership of the output data and control signals of
the I/O pad cell. Figure 8-2 shows how ports are shared
with other peripherals and the associated I/O cell (pad)
to which they are connected. Table 8-1 and Table 8-2
show the formats of the registers for the shared ports,
PORTB through PORTG.
All port pins have three registers directly associated
with the operation of the port pin. The Data Direction
register (TRISx) determines whether the pin is an input
or an output. If the Data Direction register bit is a ‘1’,
then the pin is an input. All port pins are defined as
inputs after a Reset. Reads from the latch (LATx), read
the latch. Writes to the latch, write the latch (LATx).
Reads from the port (PORTx), read the port pins and
writes to the port pins, write the latch (LATx).
FIGURE 8-1:
BLOCK DIAGRAM OF A DEDICATED PORT STRUCTURE
Dedicated Port Module
Read TRIS
I/O Cell
TRIS Latch
Data Bus
D
WR TRIS
CK
Q
Data Latch
D
WR LAT +
WR PORT
Q
I/O Pad
CK
Read LAT
Read PORT
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 57
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 8-2:
BLOCK DIAGRAM OF A SHARED PORT STRUCTURE
Output Multiplexers
Peripheral Module
Peripheral Input Data
Peripheral Module Enable
I/O Cell
Peripheral Output Enable
1
Peripheral Output Data
0
1
PIO Module
Output Enable
Output Data
0
Read TRIS
I/O Pad
Data Bus
D
WR TRIS
CK
Q
TRIS Latch
D
WR LAT +
WR PORT
Q
CK
Data Latch
Read LAT
Input Data
Read PORT
8.2
Configuring Analog Port Pins
The use of the ADPCFG and TRIS registers control the
operation of the A/D port pins. The port pins that are
desired as analog inputs must have their corresponding TRIS bit set (input). If the TRIS bit is cleared
(output), the digital output level (VOH or VOL) will be
converted.
When reading the PORT register, all pins configured as
analog input channels will read as cleared (a low level).
Pins configured as digital inputs will not convert an analog input. Analog levels on any pin that is defined as a
digital input (including the ANx pins), may cause the
input buffer to consume current that exceeds the
device specifications.
DS70135E-page 58
8.2.1
I/O PORT WRITE/READ TIMING
One instruction cycle is required between a port
direction change or port write operation and a read
operation of the same port. Typically this instruction
would be a NOP.
EXAMPLE 8-1:
MOV
0xFF00, W0 ;
;
MOV W0, TRISBB ;
NOP
;
BTSS PORTB, #13 ;
PORT WRITE/READ
EXAMPLE
Configure PORTB<15:8>
as inputs
and PORTB<7:0> as outputs
Delay 1 cycle
Next Instruction
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 8-1:
SFR
Name
dsPIC30F4011 PORT REGISTER MAP
Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
TRISB
02C6
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PORTB
02C8
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RB8
RB7
RB6
RB5
RB4
RB3
RB2
RB1
RB0
LATB
02CA
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
LATB8
LATB7
LATB6
LATB5
LATB4
LATB3
LATB2
LATB1
LATB0
0000 0000 0000 0000
TRISC
02CC TRISC15 TRISC14 TRISC13
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
1110 0000 0000 0000
PORTC
02CE
RC15
RC14
RC13
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
LATC
02D0
LATC15
LATC14
LATC13
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TRISD
02D2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PORTD
02D4
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RD3
RD2
RD1
RD0
0000 0000 0000 0000
LATD
02D6
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
LATD3
LATD2
LATD1
LATD0
0000 0000 0000 0000
TRISE
02D8
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TRISE8
—
—
TRISE5 TRISE4 TRISE3 TRISE2 TRISE1 TRISE0
0000 0001 0011 1111
PORTE
02DA
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RE8
—
—
RE5
RE4
RE3
RE2
RE1
RE0
0000 0000 0000 0000
LATE
02DC
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
LATE8
—
—
LATE5
LATE4
LATE3
LATE2
LATE1
LATE0
0000 0000 0000 0000
TRISF
02DE
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PORTF
02E0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RF6
RF5
RF4
RF3
RF2
RF1
RF0
0000 0000 0000 0000
02E2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
LATF6
LATF5
LATF4
LATF3
LATF2
LATF1
LATF0
0000 0000 0000 0000
LATF
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
TRISB8 TRISB7 TRISB6 TRISB5 TRISB4 TRISB3 TRISB2 TRISB1 TRISB0
Legend:
u = uninitialized bit
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
TRISD3 TRISD2 TRISD1 TRISD0
TRISF6 TRISF5 TRISF4 TRISF3 TRISF2 TRISF1 TRISF0
Reset State
0000 0001 1111 1111
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 1111
0000 0000 0111 1111
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 59
SFR
Name
dsPIC30F4012 PORT REGISTER MAP
Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
TRISB
02C6
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PORTB
02C8
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RB5
RB4
RB3
RB2
RB1
RB0
0000 0000 0000 0000
LATB
02CB
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
LATB5
LATB4
LATB3
LATB2
LATB1
LATB0
0000 0000 0000 0000
TRISC
02CC TRISC15 TRISC14 TRISC13
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
1110 0000 0000 0000
PORTC
02CE
RC15
RC14
RC13
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
LATC
02D0
LATC15
LATC14
LATC13
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
TRISD
02D2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PORTD
02D4
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RD1
RD0
LATD
02D6
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
LATD1
LATD0
0000 0000 0000 0000
TRISE
02D8
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TRISE8
—
—
TRISE5 TRISE4 TRISE3 TRISE2 TRISE1 TRISE0
0000 0001 0011 1111
PORTE
02DA
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RE8
—
—
RE5
RE4
RE3
RE2
RE1
RE0
0000 0000 0000 0000
LATE
02DC
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
LATE8
—
—
LATE5
LATE4
LATE3
LATE2
LATE1
LATE0
0000 0000 0000 0000
TRISF
02EE
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0000 0000 1100
PORTF
02E0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RF3
RF2
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
LATF
02E2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
LATF3
LATF2
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
Legend:
u = uninitialized bit
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
TRISB5 TRISB4 TRISB3 TRISB2 TRISB1 TRISB0
Reset State
TRISF3 TRISF2
TRISD1 TRISD0
0000 0000 0011 1111
0000 0000 0000 0011
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 60
TABLE 8-2:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
8.3
Input Change Notification Module
The input change notification module provides the
dsPIC30F devices the ability to generate interrupt
requests to the processor in response to a change of
state on selected input pins. This module is capable of
detecting input change of states, even in Sleep mode,
when the clocks are disabled. There are 10 external
signals (CN0 through CN7, CN17 and CN18) that may
be selected (enabled) for generating an interrupt
request on a change of state.
Please refer to the pin diagrams for CN pin locations.
TABLE 8-3:
INPUT CHANGE NOTIFICATION REGISTER MAP (BITS 7-0)
SFR Name
Addr.
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
CNEN1
00C0
CN7IE
CN6IE
CN5IE
CN4IE
CN3IE
CN2IE
CN1IE
CN0IE
0000 0000 0000 0000
CNEN2
00C2
—
—
—
—
—
CN18IE*
CN17IE*
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
CNPU1
00C4
CN7PUE
CN6PUE
CN5PUE
CN4PUE
CN3PUE
CN2PUE
CN1PUE
CN0PUE
0000 0000 0000 0000
CNPU2
00C6
—
—
—
—
—
CN18PUE*
CN17PUE*
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
Legend:
*
u = uninitialized bit
Not available on dsPIC30F4012
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 61
dsPIC30F4011/4012
NOTES:
DS70135E-page 62
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
9.0
TIMER1 MODULE
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
This section describes the 16-bit general purpose
Timer1 module and associated operational modes.
Figure 9-1 depicts the simplified block diagram of the
16-bit Timer1 module.
Note:
Timer1 is a ‘Type A’ timer. Please refer to
the specifications for a Type A timer in
Section 24.0 “Electrical Characteristics”
of this document.
The following sections provide a detailed description,
including setup and control registers, along with associated block diagrams for the operational modes of the
timers.
The Timer1 module is a 16-bit timer which can serve as
the time counter for the Real-Time Clock, or operate as
a free-running, interval timer/counter. The 16-bit timer
has the following modes:
• 16-bit Timer
• 16-bit Synchronous Counter
• 16-bit Asynchronous Counter
Further, the following operational characteristics are
supported:
• Timer gate operation
• Selectable prescaler settings
• Timer operation during CPU Idle and Sleep
modes
• Interrupt on 16-bit Period register match or falling
edge of external gate signal
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
These operating modes are determined by setting the
appropriate bit(s) in the 16-bit SFR, T1CON. Figure 9-1
presents a block diagram of the 16-bit timer module.
16-bit Timer Mode: In the 16-bit Timer mode, the timer
increments on every instruction cycle up to a match
value, preloaded into the Period register, PR1, then
resets to 0 and continues to count.
When the CPU goes into the Idle mode, the timer will
stop incrementing unless the TSIDL (T1CON<13>)
bit = 0. If TSIDL = 1, the timer module logic will resume
the incrementing sequence upon termination of the
CPU Idle mode.
16-bit Synchronous Counter Mode: In the 16-bit
Synchronous Counter mode, the timer increments on
the rising edge of the applied external clock signal,
which is synchronized with the internal phase clocks.
The timer counts up to a match value preloaded in PR1,
then resets to 0 and continues.
When the CPU goes into the Idle mode, the timer will
stop incrementing unless the respective TSIDL bit = 0.
If TSIDL = 1, the timer module logic will resume the
incrementing sequence upon termination of the CPU
Idle mode.
16-bit Asynchronous Counter Mode: In the 16-bit
Asynchronous Counter mode, the timer increments on
every rising edge of the applied external clock signal.
The timer counts up to a match value preloaded in PR1,
then resets to 0 and continues.
When the timer is configured for the Asynchronous mode
of operation, and the CPU goes into the Idle mode, the
timer will stop incrementing if TSIDL = 1.
DS70135E-page 63
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 9-1:
16-BIT TIMER1 MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM (TYPE A TIMER)
PR1
Equal
Comparator x 16
TSYNC
1
Sync
TMR1
Reset
0
0
1
Q
D
Q
CK
TGATE
TCS
TGATE
2
1x
LPOSCEN
SOSCI
Timer Gate Operation
The 16-bit timer can be placed in the Gated Time Accumulation mode. This mode allows the internal TCY to
increment the respective timer when the gate input
signal (T1CK pin) is asserted high. Control bit, TGATE
(T1CON<6>), must be set to enable this mode. The
timer must be enabled (TON = 1) and the timer clock
source set to internal (TCS = 0).
When the CPU goes into the Idle mode, the timer will
stop incrementing unless TSIDL = 0. If TSIDL = 1, the
timer will resume the incrementing sequence upon
termination of the CPU Idle mode.
9.2
TCKPS<1:0>
TON
SOSCO/
T1CK
9.1
TGATE
T1IF
Event Flag
Timer Prescaler
The input clock (FOSC/4 or external clock) to the 16-bit
Timer has a prescale option of 1:1, 1:8, 1:64 and 1:256
selected by control bits, TCKPS<1:0> (T1CON<5:4>).
The prescaler counter is cleared when any of the
following occurs:
Gate
Sync
01
TCY
00
9.3
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
Timer Operation During Sleep
Mode
During CPU Sleep mode, the timer will operate if:
• The timer module is enabled (TON = 1) and
• The timer clock source is selected as external
(TCS = 1) and
• The TSYNC bit (T1CON<2>) is asserted to a logic
‘0’, which defines the external clock source as
asynchronous
When all three conditions are true, the timer will
continue to count up to the Period register and be reset
to 0x0000.
When a match between the timer and the Period register occurs, an interrupt can be generated if the
respective timer interrupt enable bit is asserted.
• a write to the TMR1 register
• clearing of the TON bit (T1CON<15>)
• device Reset, such as POR and BOR
However, if the timer is disabled (TON = 0), then the
timer prescaler cannot be reset since the prescaler
clock is halted.
TMR1 is not cleared when T1CON is written. It is
cleared by writing to the TMR1 register.
DS70135E-page 64
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
9.4
9.5.1
Timer Interrupt
The 16-bit timer has the ability to generate an interrupt
on period match. When the timer count matches the
Period register, the T1IF bit is asserted and an interrupt
will be generated, if enabled. The T1IF bit must be
cleared in software. The Timer Interrupt Flag, T1IF, is
located in the IFS0 control register in the interrupt
controller.
When the Gated Time Accumulation mode is enabled,
an interrupt will also be generated on the falling edge of
the gate signal (at the end of the accumulation cycle).
RTC OSCILLATOR OPERATION
When TON = 1, TCS = 1 and TGATE = 0, the timer
increments on the rising edge of the 32 kHz LP oscillator output signal, up to the value specified in the Period
register, and is then reset to ‘0’.
The TSYNC bit must be asserted to a logic ‘0’
(Asynchronous mode) for correct operation.
Enabling LPOSCEN (OSCCON<1>) will disable the
normal Timer and Counter modes and enable a timer
carry-out wake-up event.
Enabling an interrupt is accomplished via the respective Timer Interrupt Enable bit, T1IE. The timer interrupt
enable bit is located in the IEC0 Control register in the
interrupt controller.
When the CPU enters Sleep mode, the RTC will continue to operate, provided the 32 kHz external crystal
oscillator is active and the control bits have not been
changed. The TSIDL bit should be cleared to ‘0’ in
order for RTC to continue operation in Idle mode.
9.5
9.5.2
Real-Time Clock
Timer1, when operating in Real-Time Clock (RTC)
mode, provides time-of-day and event time-stamping
capabilities. Key operational features of the RTC are:
•
•
•
•
Operation from 32 kHz LP oscillator
8-bit prescaler
Low power
Real-Time Clock interrupts
These operating modes are determined by setting the
appropriate bit(s) in the T1CON Control register
FIGURE 9-2:
RTC INTERRUPTS
When an interrupt event occurs, the respective Timer
Interrupt Flag, T1IF, is asserted and an interrupt will be
generated, if enabled. The T1IF bit must be cleared in
software. The respective Timer Interrupt Flag, T1IF, is
located in the IFS0 Status register in the interrupt
controller.
Enabling an interrupt is accomplished via the
respective Timer Interrupt Enable bit, T1IE. The Timer
Interrupt Enable bit is located in the IEC0 control
register in the interrupt controller.
RECOMMENDED
COMPONENTS FOR
TIMER1 LP OSCILLATOR
REAL-TIME CLOCK (RTC)
C1
SOSCI
32.768 kHz
XTAL
dsPIC30FXXXX
SOSCO
C2
R
C1 = C2 = 18 pF; R = 100K
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 65
SFR Name
Addr.
TMR1
0100
PR1
0102
T1CON
0104
TIMER1 REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Timer1 Register
Period Register 1
TON
—
TSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
Legend:
u = uninitialized bit
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
TGATE
Reset State
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
1111 1111 1111 1111
TCKPS1 TCKPS0
—
TSYNC
TCS
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 66
TABLE 9-1:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
10.0
TIMER2/3 MODULE
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
This section describes the 32-bit general purpose timer
module (Timer2/3) and associated operational modes.
Figure 10-1 depicts the simplified block diagram of the
32-bit Timer2/3 module. Figure 10-2 and Figure 10-3
show Timer2/3 configured as two independent 16-bit
timers, Timer2 and Timer3, respectively.
Note:
Timer2 is a ‘Type B’ timer and Timer3 is a
‘Type C’ timer. Please refer to the
appropriate timer type in Section 24.0
“Electrical Characteristics” of this
document.
The Timer2/3 module is a 32-bit timer, which can be
configured as two 16-bit timers, with selectable operating modes. These timers are utilized by other
peripheral modules, such as:
For 32-bit timer/counter operation, Timer2 is the least
significant word and Timer3 is the most significant word
of the 32-bit timer.
Note:
For 32-bit timer operation, T3CON control
bits are ignored. Only T2CON control bits
are used for setup and control. Timer2
clock and gate inputs are utilized for the
32-bit timer module, but an interrupt is
generated with the Timer3 Interrupt Flag
(T3IF) and the interrupt is enabled with the
Timer3 Interrupt Enable bit (T3IE).
16-bit Mode: In the 16-bit mode, Timer2 and Timer3
can be configured as two independent 16-bit timers.
Each timer can be set up in either 16-bit Timer mode or
16-bit Synchronous Counter mode. See Section 9.0
“Timer1 Module”, Timer1 Module, for details on these
two operating modes.
The only functional difference between Timer2 and
Timer3 is that Timer2 provides synchronization of the
clock prescaler output. This is useful for high-frequency
external clock inputs.
• Input Capture
• Output Compare/Simple PWM
32-bit Timer Mode: In the 32-bit Timer mode, the timer
increments on every instruction cycle up to a match
value, preloaded into the combined 32-bit Period
register, PR3/PR2, then resets to 0 and continues to
count.
The following sections provide a detailed description,
including setup and control registers, along with associated block diagrams for the operational modes of the
timers.
For synchronous 32-bit reads of the Timer2/Timer3
pair, reading the least significant word (TMR2 register)
will cause the msw to be read and latched into a 16-bit
holding register, termed TMR3HLD.
The 32-bit timer has the following modes:
For synchronous 32-bit writes, the holding register
(TMR3HLD) must first be written to. When followed by
a write to the TMR2 register, the contents of TMR3HLD
will be transferred and latched into the MSB of the
32-bit timer (TMR3).
• Two independent 16-bit timers (Timer2 and
Timer3) with all 16-bit operating modes (except
Asynchronous Counter mode)
• Single 32-bit timer operation
• Single 32-bit synchronous counter
Further, the following operational characteristics are
supported:
•
•
•
•
•
ADC Event Trigger
Timer Gate Operation
Selectable Prescaler Settings
Timer Operation During Idle and Sleep Modes
Interrupt on a 32-bit Period Register Match
These operating modes are determined by setting the
appropriate bit(s) in the 16-bit T2CON and T3CON
SFRs.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
32-bit Synchronous Counter Mode: In the 32-bit
Synchronous Counter mode, the timer increments on
the rising edge of the applied external clock signal,
which is synchronized with the internal phase clocks.
The timer counts up to a match value preloaded in the
combined 32-bit period register, PR3/PR2, then resets
to 0 and continues.
When the timer is configured for the Synchronous
Counter mode of operation and the CPU goes into the
Idle mode, the timer will stop incrementing unless the
TSIDL (T2CON<13>) bit = 0. If TSIDL = 1, the timer
module logic will resume the incrementing sequence
upon termination of the CPU Idle mode.
DS70135E-page 67
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 10-1:
32-BIT TIMER2/3 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Data Bus<15:0>
TMR3HLD
16
16
Write TMR2
Read TMR2
16
Reset
TMR3
TMR2
MSB
LSB
Sync
ADC Event Trigger
Equal
Comparator x 32
PR3
0
T3IF
Event Flag 1
Q
D
Q
CK
TGATE(T2CON<6>)
TCS
TGATE
TGATE
(T2CON<6>)
PR2
TON
T2CK
Note:
TCKPS<1:0>
2
1x
Gate
Sync
01
TCY
00
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
Timer configuration bit, T32 (T2CON<3>), must be set to ‘1’ for a 32-bit timer/counter operation. All control
bits are respective to the T2CON register.
DS70135E-page 68
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 10-2:
16-BIT TIMER2 BLOCK DIAGRAM
PR2
Equal
Reset
TMR2
Sync
0
1
Q
D
Q
CK
TGATE
TCS
TGATE
T2IF
Event Flag
Comparator x 16
TGATE
TON
T2CK
TCKPS<1:0>
2
1x
FIGURE 10-3:
Gate
Sync
01
TCY
00
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
16-BIT TIMER3 BLOCK DIAGRAM
PR3
ADC Event Trigger
Equal
Reset
TMR3
0
1
Q
D
Q
CK
TGATE
TCS
TGATE
T3IF
Event Flag
Comparator x 16
TGATE
Sync
TON
1x
01
TCY
Note:
TCKPS<1:0>
2
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
00
The dsPIC30F4011/4012 devices do not have external pin inputs to Timer3. In these devices, the following
modes should not be used:
1. TCS = 1.
2. TCS = 0 and TGATE = 1 (gated time accumulation).
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 69
dsPIC30F4011/4012
10.1
Timer Gate Operation
The 32-bit timer can be placed in the Gated Time Accumulation mode. This mode allows the internal TCY to
increment the respective timer when the gate input signal (T2CK pin) is asserted high. Control bit, TGATE
(T2CON<6>), must be set to enable this mode. When
in this mode, Timer2 is the originating clock source.
The TGATE setting is ignored for Timer3. The timer
must be enabled (TON = 1) and the timer clock source
set to internal (TCS = 0).
The falling edge of the external signal terminates the
count operation but does not reset the timer. The user
must reset the timer in order to start counting from zero.
10.2
ADC Event Trigger
When a match occurs between the 32-bit timer (TMR3/
TMR2) and the 32-bit combined Period register (PR3/
PR2), a special ADC trigger event signal is generated
by Timer3.
10.3
10.4
Timer Operation During Sleep
Mode
During CPU Sleep mode, the timer will not operate
because the internal clocks are disabled.
10.5
Timer Interrupt
The 32-bit timer module can generate an interrupt on
period match, or on the falling edge of the external gate
signal. When the 32-bit timer count matches the
respective 32-bit Period register, or the falling edge of
the external “gate” signal is detected, the T3IF bit
(IFS0<7>) is asserted and an interrupt will be generated, if enabled. In this mode, the T3IF interrupt flag is
used as the source of the interrupt. The T3IF bit must
be cleared in software.
Enabling an interrupt is accomplished via the
respective Timer Interrupt Enable bit, T3IE (IEC0<7>).
Timer Prescaler
The input clock (FOSC/4 or external clock) to the timer
has a prescale option of 1:1, 1:8, 1:64 and 1:256,
selected by control bits, TCKPS<1:0> (T2CON<5:4>
and T3CON<5:4>). For the 32-bit timer operation, the
originating clock source is Timer2. The prescaler operation for Timer3 is not applicable in this mode. The
prescaler counter is cleared when any of the following
occurs:
• a write to the TMR2/TMR3 register
• clearing either of the TON (T2CON<15> or
T3CON<15>) bits to ‘0’
• device Reset, such as POR and BOR
However, if the timer is disabled (TON = 0), then the
Timer 2 prescaler cannot be reset, since the prescaler
clock is halted.
TMR2/TMR3 is not cleared when T2CON/T3CON is
written.
DS70135E-page 70
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 10-1:
TIMER2/3 REGISTER MAP
SFR Name Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
TMR2
0106
Timer2 Register
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
TMR3HLD
0108
Timer3 Holding Register (For 32-bit timer operations only)
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
TMR3
010A
Timer3 Register
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
PR2
010C
Period Register 2
1111 1111 1111 1111
PR3
010E
Period Register 3
T2CON
0110
TON
—
TSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
TGATE
TCKPS1 TCKPS0
T32
—
TCS
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
0112
TON
—
TSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
TGATE
TCKPS1 TCKPS0
—
—
TCS
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
T3CON
Legend:
u = uninitialized bit
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
1111 1111 1111 1111
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 71
dsPIC30F4011/4012
NOTES:
DS70135E-page 72
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
11.0
TIMER4/5 MODULE
The Timer4/5 module is similar in operation to the
Timer 2/3 module. However, there are some
differences, which are as follows:
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
• The Timer4/5 module does not support the ADC
event trigger feature
• Timer4/5 can not be utilized by other peripheral
modules such as input capture and output compare
The operating modes of the Timer4/5 module are
determined by setting the appropriate bit(s) in the 16-bit
T4CON and T5CON SFRs.
This section describes the second 32-bit general
purpose timer module (Timer4/5) and associated
operational modes. Figure 11-1 depicts the simplified
block diagram of the 32-bit Timer4/5 module.
Figure 11-2 and Figure 11-3 show Timer4/5 configured
as two independent 16-bit timers, Timer4 and Timer5,
respectively.
Note:
For 32-bit timer/counter operation, Timer4 is the least
significant word and Timer5 is the most significant word
of the 32-bit timer.
Note:
For 32-bit timer operation, T5CON control
bits are ignored. Only T4CON control bits
are used for setup and control. Timer4
clock and gate inputs are utilized for the
32-bit timer module, but an interrupt is
generated with the Timer5 Interrupt Flag
(T5IF) and the interrupt is enabled with the
Timer5 Interrupt Enable bit (T5IE).
Timer4 is a ‘Type B’ timer and Timer5 is a
‘Type C’ timer. Please refer to the
appropriate timer type in Section 24.0
“Electrical Characteristics” of this
document.
FIGURE 11-1:
32-BIT TIMER4/5 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Data Bus<15:0>
TMR5HLD
16
16
Write TMR4
Read TMR4
16
Reset
Equal
TMR5
TMR4
MSB
LSB
Comparator x 32
PR5
PR4
0
1
TGATE
(T4CON<6>)
Q
D
Q
CK
TGATE(T4CON<6>)
TCS
TGATE
T5IF
Event Flag
Sync
T4CK
Note:
TCKPS<1:0>
TON
2
1x
Gate
Sync
01
TCY
00
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
Timer configuration bit, T32 (T2CON<3>), must be set to ‘1’ for a 32-bit timer/counter operation. All
control bits are respective to the T4CON register.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 73
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 11-2:
16-BIT TIMER4 BLOCK DIAGRAM
PR4
Equal
Comparator x 16
Reset
Sync
0
1
Q
D
Q
CK
TGATE
TCS
TGATE
TCKPS<1:0>
TON
T4CK
DS70135E-page 74
TGATE
T4IF
Event Flag
TMR4
2
1x
Gate
Sync
01
TCY
00
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 11-3:
16-BIT TIMER5 BLOCK DIAGRAM
PR5
Equal
ADC Event Trigger
Comparator x 16
TMR5
Reset
0
1
Q
D
Q
CK
TGATE
TCS
TGATE
TGATE
T5IF
Event Flag
TCKPS<1:0>
TON
Sync
01
TCY
Note:
2
1x
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
00
The dsPIC30F4011/4012 devices do not have an external pin input to Timer5. In these devices, the
following modes should not be used:
1. TCS = 1.
2. TCS = 0 and TGATE = 1 (gated time accumulation).
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 75
SFR Name
Addr.
TIMER4/5 REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
TMR4
0114
Timer4 Register
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
TMR5HLD
0116
Timer5 Holding Register (For 32-bit operations only)
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
TMR5
0118
Timer5 Register
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
PR4
011A
Period Register 4
1111 1111 1111 1111
PR5
011C
Period Register 5
T4CON
011E
TON
—
TSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
TGATE
TCKPS1
TCKPS0
T45
—
TCS
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
0120
TON
—
TSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
TGATE
TCKPS1
TCKPS0
—
—
TCS
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
T5CON
Legend:
u = uninitialized bit
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
1111 1111 1111 1111
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 76
TABLE 11-1:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
12.0
INPUT CAPTURE MODULE
The key operational features of the input capture
module are:
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
• Simple Capture Event mode
• Timer2 and Timer3 mode selection
• Interrupt on input capture event
These operating modes are determined by setting the
appropriate bits in the ICxCON register (where x = 1, 2,
..., N). The dsPIC30F4011/4012 devices have 4 capture
channels.
This section describes the input capture module and
associated operational modes. The features provided by
this module are useful in applications requiring
frequency (period) and pulse measurement. Figure 12-1
depicts a block diagram of the input capture module.
Input capture is useful for such modes as:
Note:
• Frequency/Period/Pulse Measurements
• Additional Sources of External Interrupts
FIGURE 12-1:
The dsPIC30F4011/4012 devices have
four capture inputs: IC1, IC2, IC7 and IC8.
The naming of these four capture channels is intentional and preserves software
compatibility with other dsPIC Digital
Signal Controllers.
INPUT CAPTURE MODE BLOCK DIAGRAM
From Timer Module
T3_CNT
T2_CNT
16
ICx
Pin
16
ICTMR
1
Prescaler
1, 4, 16
3
Edge
Detection
Logic
Clock
Synchronizer
0
FIFO
R/W
Logic
ICM<2:0>
Mode Select
ICxBUF
ICBNE, ICOV
ICI<1:0>
ICxCON
Data Bus
Note:
Interrupt
Logic
Set Flag
ICxIF
Where ‘x’ is shown, reference is made to the registers or bits associated to the respective input capture
channels 1 through N.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 77
dsPIC30F4011/4012
12.1
Simple Capture Event Mode
The simple capture events in the dsPIC30F product
family are:
•
•
•
•
•
Capture every falling edge
Capture every rising edge
Capture every 4th rising edge
Capture every 16th rising edge
Capture every rising and falling edge
These simple Input Capture modes are configured by
setting the appropriate bits ICM<2:0> (ICxCON<2:0>).
12.1.1
CAPTURE PRESCALER
There are four input capture prescaler settings, specified by bits, ICM<2:0> (ICxCON<2:0>). Whenever the
capture channel is turned off, the prescaler counter will
be cleared. In addition, any Reset will clear the
prescaler counter.
12.1.2
CAPTURE BUFFER OPERATION
Each capture channel has an associated FIFO buffer
which is four, 16-bit words deep. There are two status
flags which provide status on the FIFO buffer:
• ICBNE – Input Capture Buffer Not Empty
• ICOV – Input Capture Overflow
The ICBNE bit will be set on the first input capture event
and remain set until all capture events have been read
from the FIFO. As each word is read from the FIFO, the
remaining words are advanced by one position within
the buffer.
In the event that the FIFO is full with four capture
events, and a fifth capture event occurs prior to a read
of the FIFO, an overflow condition will occur and the
ICOV bit will be set to a logic ‘1’. The fifth capture event
is lost and is not stored in the FIFO. No additional
events will be captured till all four events have been
read from the buffer.
If a FIFO read is performed after the last read and no
new capture event has been received, the read will
yield indeterminate results.
12.1.3
TIMER2 AND TIMER3 SELECTION
MODE
Each capture channel can select between one of two
timers for the time base, Timer2 or Timer3.
Selection of the timer resource is accomplished
through SFR bit, ICTMR (ICxCON<7>). Timer3 is the
default timer resource available for the input capture
module.
12.1.4
HALL SENSOR MODE
When the input capture module is set for capture on
every edge, rising and falling, ICM<2:0> = 001, the following operations are performed by the input capture
logic:
• The input capture interrupt flag is set on every
edge, rising and falling.
• The interrupt on Capture mode setting bits,
ICI<1:0>, is ignored, since every capture
generates an interrupt.
• A capture overflow condition is not generated in
this mode.
12.2
Input Capture Operation During
Sleep and Idle Modes
An input capture event will generate a device wake-up
or interrupt, if enabled, if the device is in CPU Idle or
Sleep mode.
Independent of the timer being enabled, the input
capture module will wake-up from the CPU Sleep or Idle
mode when a capture event occurs, if ICM<2:0> = 111
and the interrupt enable bit is asserted. The same wakeup can generate an interrupt if the conditions for
processing the interrupt have been satisfied. The wakeup feature is useful as a method of adding extra external
pin interrupts.
12.2.1
INPUT CAPTURE IN CPU SLEEP
MODE
CPU Sleep mode allows input capture module operation with reduced functionality. In the CPU Sleep
mode, the ICI<1:0> bits are not applicable, and the
input capture module can only function as an external
interrupt source.
The capture module must be configured for interrupt
only on the rising edge (ICM<2:0> = 111) in order for
the input capture module to be used while the device
is in Sleep mode. The prescale settings of 4:1 or 16:1
are not applicable in this mode.
DS70135E-page 78
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
12.2.2
INPUT CAPTURE IN CPU IDLE
MODE
CPU Idle mode allows input capture module operation
with full functionality. In the CPU Idle mode, the interrupt
mode selected by the ICI<1:0> bits are applicable, as
well as the 4:1 and 16:1 capture prescale settings which
are defined by control bits ICM<2:0>. This mode
requires the selected timer to be enabled. Moreover, the
ICSIDL bit must be asserted to a logic ‘0’.
If the input capture module is defined as
ICM<2:0> = 111 in CPU Idle mode, the input capture
pin will serve only as an external interrupt pin.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
12.3
Input Capture Interrupts
The input capture channels have the ability to generate
an interrupt, based upon the selected number of
capture events. The selection number is set by control
bits, ICI<1:0> (ICxCON<6:5>).
Each channel provides an interrupt flag (ICxIF) bit. The
respective capture channel interrupt flag is located in
the corresponding IFSx register.
Enabling an interrupt is accomplished via the respective Capture Channel Interrupt Enable (ICxIE) bit. The
capture interrupt enable bit is located in the
corresponding IECx register.
DS70135E-page 79
SFR Name Addr.
IC1BUF
0140
IC1CON
0142
IC2BUF
0144
IC2CON
0146
IC7BUF
0158
IC7CON
015A
IC8BUF
015C
IC8CON
015E
INPUT CAPTURE REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
—
—
ICSIDL
—
—
—
—
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
ICOV
ICBNE
Bit 2
Bit 1
Input 1 Capture Register
—
ICTMR
—
ICSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
ICTMR
ICM<2:0>
—
ICSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
ICTMR
ICI<1:0>
ICOV
ICBNE
ICM<2:0>
ICI<1:0>
ICOV
ICBNE
ICM<2:0>
—
—
ICSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
ICTMR
u = uninitialized bit
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
0000 0000 0000 0000
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
Input 8 Capture Register
Legend:
0000 0000 0000 0000
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
Input 7 Capture Register
—
Reset State
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
ICI<1:0>
Input 2 Capture Register
—
Bit 0
0000 0000 0000 0000
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
ICI<1:0>
ICOV
ICBNE
ICM<2:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 80
TABLE 12-1:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
13.0
OUTPUT COMPARE MODULE
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
This section describes the output compare module and
associated operational modes. The features provided
by this module are useful in applications requiring
operational modes, such as:
• Generation of Variable Width Output Pulses
• Power Factor Correction
Figure 13-1 depicts a block diagram of the output
compare module.
FIGURE 13-1:
The key operational features of the output compare
module include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Timer2 and Timer3 Selection mode
Simple Output Compare Match mode
Dual Output Compare Match mode
Simple PWM mode
Output Compare during Sleep and Idle modes
Interrupt on Output Compare/PWM Event
These operating modes are determined by setting the
appropriate bits in the 16-bit OCxCON SFR (where x = 1,
2, 3, ..., N). The dsPIC30F4011/4012 devices have
4/2 compare channels, respectively.
OCxRS and OCxR in the figure represent the Dual
Compare registers. In the Dual Compare mode, the
OCxR register is used for the first compare and OCxRS
is used for the second compare.
OUTPUT COMPARE MODE BLOCK DIAGRAM
Set Flag bit,
OCxIF
OCxRS
Output
Logic
OCxR
3
OCM<2:0>
Mode Select
Comparator
S Q
R
OCx
Output Enable
OCFA
(for x = 1, 2, 3 or 4)
0
1
OCTSEL
0
1
From Timer Module
TMR2<15:0
Note:
TMR3<15:0> T2P2_MATCH
T3P3_MATCH
Where ‘x’ is shown, reference is made to the registers associated with the respective output compare channels 1
through N.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 81
dsPIC30F4011/4012
13.1
Timer2 and Timer3 Selection Mode
Each output compare channel can select between one
of two 16-bit timers: Timer2 or Timer3.
The selection of the timers is controlled by the OCTSEL
bit (OCxCON<3>). Timer2 is the default timer resource
for the output compare module.
13.2
Simple Output Compare Match
Mode
When control bits, OCM<2:0> (OCxCON<2:0>) = 001,
010 or 011, the selected output compare channel is
configured for one of three simple Output Compare
Match modes:
• Compare forces I/O pin low
• Compare forces I/O pin high
• Compare toggles I/O pin
The OCxR register is used in these modes. The OCxR
register is loaded with a value and is compared to the
selected incrementing timer count. When a compare
occurs, one of these Compare Match modes occurs. If
the counter resets to zero before reaching the value in
OCxR, the state of the OCx pin remains unchanged.
13.3
Dual Output Compare Match Mode
When control bits, OCM<2:0> (OCxCON<2:0>) = 100
or 101, the selected output compare channel is configured for one of two Dual Output Compare modes which
are:
• Single Output Pulse mode
• Continuous Output Pulse mode
13.3.1
SINGLE OUTPUT PULSE MODE
13.3.2
CONTINUOUS OUTPUT PULSE
MODE
For the user to configure the module for the generation
of a continuous stream of output pulses, the following
steps are required:
• Determine instruction cycle time TCY.
• Calculate desired pulse value based on TCY.
• Calculate timer to start pulse width from timer start
value of 0x0000.
• Write pulse width start and stop times into OCxR
and OCxRS (x denotes channel 1, 2, ..., N)
Compare registers, respectively.
• Set Timer Period register to value equal to, or
greater than, value in OCxRS Compare register.
• Set OCM<2:0> = 101.
• Enable timer, TON (TxCON<15>) = 1.
13.4
Simple PWM Mode
When control bits, OCM<2:0> (OCxCON<2:0>) = 110
or 111, the selected output compare channel is configured for the PWM mode of operation. When configured
for the PWM mode of operation, OCxR is the main latch
(read-only) and OCxRS is the secondary latch. This
enables glitchless PWM transitions.
The user must perform the following steps in order to
configure the output compare module for PWM
operation:
1.
2.
3.
Set the PWM period by writing to the appropriate
Period register.
Set the PWM duty cycle by writing to the OCxRS
register.
Configure the output compare module for PWM
operation.
Set the TMRx prescale value and enable the
timer, TON (TxCON<15>) = 1.
For the user to configure the module for the generation
of a single output pulse, the following steps are
required (assuming timer is off):
4.
• Determine instruction cycle time TCY.
• Calculate desired pulse width value based on TCY.
• Calculate time to start pulse from timer start value
of 0x0000.
• Write pulse width start and stop times into OCxR
and OCxRS Compare registers (x denotes
channel 1, 2, ..., N).
• Set Timer Period register to value equal to, or
greater than, value in OCxRS Compare register.
• Set OCM<2:0> = 100.
• Enable timer, TON (TxCON<15>) = 1.
13.4.1
To initiate another single pulse, issue another write to
set OCM<2:0> = 100.
• The external Fault condition has been removed.
• The PWM mode has been re-enabled by writing
to the appropriate control bits.
DS70135E-page 82
INPUT PIN FAULT PROTECTION
FOR PWM
When control bits, OCM<2:0> (OCxCON<2:0>) = 111,
the selected output compare channel is again configured for the PWM mode of operation with the additional
feature of input Fault protection. While in this mode, if
a logic ‘0’ is detected on the OCFA pin, the respective
PWM output pin is placed in the high-impedance input
state. The OCFLT bit (OCxCON<4>) indicates whether
a Fault condition has occurred. This state will be
maintained until both of the following events have
occurred:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
13.4.2
PWM PERIOD
When the selected TMRx is equal to its respective
Period register, PRx, the following four events occur on
the next increment cycle:
The PWM period is specified by writing to the PRx
register. The PWM period can be calculated using
Equation 13-1.
EQUATION 13-1:
• TMRx is cleared.
• The OCx pin is set.
- Exception 1: If PWM duty cycle is 0x0000,
the OCx pin will remain low.
- Exception 2: If duty cycle is greater than PRx,
the pin will remain high.
• The PWM duty cycle is latched from OCxRS into
OCxR.
• The corresponding timer interrupt flag is set.
PWM PERIOD
PWM period = [(PRx) + 1] • 4 • TOSC •
(TMRx prescale value)
PWM frequency is defined as 1/[PWM period].
See Figure 13-1 for key PWM period comparisons.
Timer3 is referred to in the figure for clarity.
FIGURE 13-1:
PWM OUTPUT TIMING
Period
Duty Cycle
TMR3 = PR3
T3IF = 1
(Interrupt Flag)
OCxR = OCxRS
TMR3 = PR3
T3IF = 1
(Interrupt Flag)
OCxR = OCxRS
TMR3 = Duty Cycle (OCxR)
13.5
Output Compare Operation During
CPU Sleep Mode
When the CPU enters the Sleep mode, all internal
clocks are stopped. Therefore, when the CPU enters
the Sleep state, the output compare channel will drive
the pin to the active state that was observed prior to
entering the CPU Sleep state.
For example, if the pin was high when the CPU
entered the Sleep state, the pin will remain high. Likewise, if the pin was low when the CPU entered the
Sleep state, the pin will remain low. In either case, the
output compare module will resume operation when
the device wakes up.
13.6
Output Compare Operation During
CPU Idle Mode
When the CPU enters the Idle mode, the output
compare module can operate with full functionality.
TMR3 = Duty Cycle (OCxR)
13.7
Output Compare Interrupts
The output compare channels have the ability to generate an interrupt on a compare match for whichever
Match mode has been selected.
For all modes except the PWM mode, when a compare
event occurs, the respective interrupt flag (OCxIF) is
asserted and an interrupt will be generated if enabled.
The OCxIF bit is located in the corresponding IFSx register, and must be cleared in software. The interrupt is
enabled via the respective Compare Interrupt Enable
(OCxIE) bit, located in the corresponding IECx register.
For the PWM mode, when an event occurs, the respective Timer Interrupt Flag (T2IF or T3IF) is asserted and
an interrupt will be generated if enabled. The TxIF bit is
located in the IFS0 register and must be cleared in
software. The interrupt is enabled via the respective
Timer Interrupt Enable bit (T2IE or T3IE) located in the
IEC0 register. The output compare interrupt flag is
never set during the PWM mode of operation.
The output compare channel will operate during the
CPU Idle mode if the OCSIDL bit (OCxCON<13>) is at
logic ‘0’ and the selected time base (Timer2 or Timer3)
is enabled and the TSIDL bit of the selected timer is
set to logic ‘0’.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 83
SFR Name
Addr.
OUTPUT COMPARE REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
OC1RS
0180
Output Compare 1 Secondary Register
OC1R
0182
Output Compare 1 Main Register
OC1CON
0184
—
—
OCSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
OC2RS
0186
Output Compare 2 Secondary Register
OC2R
0188
Output Compare 2 Main Register
OC2CON
018A
OC3RS*
018C
Output Compare 3 Secondary Register
OC3R*
018E
Output Compare 3 Main Register
OC3CON*
0190
OC4RS*
0192
Output Compare 4 Secondary Register
OC4R*
0194
Output Compare 4 Main Register
OC4CON*
0196
—
—
—
—
—
—
OCSIDL
OCSIDL
OCSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Legend:
*
u = uninitialized bit
Not available on dsPIC30F4012.
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
—
—
—
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
OCFLT
OCTSEL
OCM<2:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
OCFLT
OCTSE
OCM<2:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
OCFLT
OCTSEL
OCM<2:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
OCFLT
OCTSEL
OCM<2:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 84
TABLE 13-1:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
14.0
QUADRATURE ENCODER
INTERFACE (QEI) MODULE
The operational features of the QEI include:
• Three input channels for two phase signals and
index pulse
• 16-bit up/down position counter
• Count direction status
• Position Measurement (x2 and x4) mode
• Programmable digital noise filters on inputs
• Alternate 16-bit Timer/Counter mode
• Quadrature Encoder Interface interrupts
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
This section describes the Quadrature Encoder Interface (QEI) module and associated operational modes.
The QEI module provides the interface to incremental
encoders for obtaining mechanical position data.
FIGURE 14-1:
These operating modes are determined by setting the
appropriate bits QEIM<2:0> (QEICON<10:8>).
Figure 14-1 depicts the Quadrature Encoder Interface
block diagram.
QUADRATURE ENCODER INTERFACE BLOCK DIAGRAM
TQCKPS<1:0>
Sleep Input
TQCS
TCY
Synchronize
0
Det
1
2
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
1
QEIM<2:0>
0
TQGATE
QEA
Programmable
Digital Filter
UPDN_SRC
0
QEICON<11>
2
Quadrature
Encoder
Interface Logic
QEB
Programmable
Digital Filter
INDX
Programmable
Digital Filter
Q
CK
Q
QEIIF
Event
Flag
16-bit Up/Down Counter
(POSCNT)
Reset
Comparator/
Zero Detect
Equal
3
QEIM<2:0>
Mode Select
1
D
Max Count Register
(MAXCNT)
3
Up/Down
Note: In dsPIC30F4011/4012, the UPDN pin is not available. Up/Down logic bit can still be polled by software.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 85
dsPIC30F4011/4012
14.1
Quadrature Encoder Interface
Logic
A typical, incremental (a.k.a. optical) encoder has three
outputs: Phase A, Phase B and an index pulse. These
signals are useful and often required in position and
speed control of ACIM and SR motors.
The two channels, Phase A (QEA) and Phase B (QEB),
have a unique relationship. If Phase A leads Phase B,
then the direction (of the motor) is deemed positive or
forward. If Phase A lags Phase B, then the direction (of
the motor) is deemed negative or reverse.
A third channel, termed index pulse, occurs once per
revolution and is used as a reference to establish an
absolute position. The index pulse coincides with
Phase A and Phase B, both low.
14.2
16-bit Up/Down Position Counter
Mode
The 16-bit Up/Down Counter counts up or down on
every count pulse, which is generated by the difference
of the Phase A and Phase B input signals. The counter
acts as an integrator, whose count value is proportional
to position. The direction of the count is determined by
the UPDN signal which is generated by the Quadrature
Encoder Interface Logic.
14.2.1
POSITION COUNTER ERROR
CHECKING
Position counter error checking in the QEI is provided
for and indicated by the CNTERR bit (QEICON<15>).
The error checking only applies when the position
counter is configured for Reset on the Index Pulse
modes (QEIM<2:0> = 110 or 100). In these modes, the
contents of the POSCNT register are compared with
the values (0xFFFF or MAXCNT + 1, depending on
direction). If these values are detected, an error condition is generated by setting the CNTERR bit and a QEI
count error interrupt is generated. The QEI count error
interrupt can be disabled by setting the CEID bit
(DFLTCON<8>). The position counter continues to
count encoder edges after an error has been detected.
The POSCNT register continues to count up/down until
a natural rollover/underflow. No interrupt is generated
for the natural rollover/underflow event. The CNTERR
bit is a read/write bit and reset in software by the user.
DS70135E-page 86
14.2.2
POSITION COUNTER RESET
The Position Counter Reset Enable bit, POSRES
(QEICON<2>) controls whether the position counter is
reset when the index pulse is detected. This bit is only
applicable when QEIM<2:0> = 100 or 110.
If the POSRES bit is set to ‘1’, then the position counter
is reset when the index pulse is detected. If the
POSRES bit is set to ‘0’, then the position counter is not
reset when the index pulse is detected. The position
counter will continue counting up or down and will be
reset on the rollover or underflow condition.
When selecting the INDX signal to reset the position
counter (POSCNT), the user has to specify the states
on the QEA and QEB input pins. These states have to
be matched in order for a Reset to occur. These states
are selected by the IMV<1:0> bits (DFLTCON<10:9>).
The Index Match Value bits (IMV<1:0>) allow the user
to specify the state of the QEA and QEB input pins,
during an index pulse, when the POSCNT register is to
be reset.
In 4x Quadrature Count mode:
IMV1 = Required state of Phase B input signal for
match on index pulse
IMV0 = Required state of Phase A input signal for
match on index pulse
In 2x Quadrature Count mode:
IMV1 = Selects phase input signal for index state
match (0 = Phase A, 1 = Phase B)
IMV0 = Required state of the selected phase input
signal for match on index pulse
The interrupt is still generated on the detection of the
index pulse and not on the position counter overflow/
underflow.
14.2.3
COUNT DIRECTION STATUS
As mentioned in the previous section, the QEI logic
generates an UPDN signal, based upon the relationship between Phase A and Phase B. In addition to the
output pin, the state of this internal UPDN signal is
supplied to an SFR bit, UPDN (QEICON<11>), as a
read-only bit.
Note:
QEI pins are multiplexed with analog
inputs. The user must insure that all QEI
associated pins are set as digital inputs in
the ADPCFG register.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
14.3
Position Measurement Mode
There are two Measurement modes which are supported and are termed x2 and x4. These modes are
selected by the QEIM<2:0> (QEICON<10:8>) mode
select bits.
When control bits, QEIM<2:0> = 100 or 101, the x2
Measurement mode is selected and the QEI logic only
looks at the Phase A input for the position counter
increment rate. Every rising and falling edge of the
Phase A signal causes the position counter to be incremented or decremented. The Phase B signal is still
utilized for the determination of the counter direction
just as in the x4 mode.
Within the x2 Measurement mode, there are two
variations of how the position counter is reset:
1.
2.
Position counter reset by detection of index
pulse, QEIM<2:0> = 100.
Position counter reset by match with MAXCNT,
QEIM<2:0> = 101.
When control bits, QEIM<2:0> = 110 or 111, the x4
Measurement mode is selected and the QEI logic looks
at both edges of the Phase A and Phase B input signals. Every edge of both signals causes the position
counter to increment or decrement.
Within the x4 Measurement mode, there are two
variations of how the position counter is reset:
1.
2.
Position counter reset by detection of index
pulse, QEIM<2:0> = 110.
Position counter reset by match with MAXCNT,
QEIM<2:0> = 111.
The x4 Measurement mode provides for finer resolution data (more position counts) for determining motor
position.
14.4
14.5
When the QEI module is not configured for the QEI
mode, QEIM<2:0> = 001, the module can be configured as a simple 16-bit timer/counter. The setup and
control of the auxiliary timer is accomplished through
the QEICON SFR register. This timer functions identically to Timer1. The QEA pin is used as the timer clock
input.
When configured as a timer, the POSCNT register
serves as the Timer Count register and the MAXCNT
register serves as the Period register. When a Timer/
Period register match occurs, the QEI interrupt flag will
be asserted.
The only exception between the general purpose timers and this timer is the added feature of external up/
down input select. When the UPDN pin is asserted
high, the timer will increment up. When the UPDN pin
is asserted low, the timer will be decremented.
Note:
The filter ensures that the filtered output signal is not
permitted to change until a stable value has been
registered for three consecutive clock cycles.
For the QEA, QEB and INDX pins, the clock divide
frequency for the digital filter is programmed by bits
QECK<2:0> (DFLTCON<6:4>) and are derived from
the base instruction cycle TCY.
Changing the operational mode (i.e., from
QEI to timer or vice versa) will not affect the
Timer/Position Count register contents.
The UPDN control/status bit (QEICON<11>) can be
used to select the count direction state of the Timer
register. When UPDN = 1, the timer will count up. When
UPDN = 0, the timer will count down.
In addition, control bit, UPDN_SRC (QEICON<0>),
determines whether the timer count direction state is
based on the logic state written into the UPDN control/
status bit (QEICON<11>) or the QEB pin state. When
UPDN_SRC = 1, the timer count direction is controlled
from the QEB pin. Likewise, when UPDN_SRC = 0, the
timer count direction is controlled by the UPDN bit.
Note:
Programmable Digital Noise
Filters
The digital noise filter section is responsible for rejecting noise on the incoming capture or quadrature
signals. Schmitt Trigger inputs and a three-clock cycle
delay filter combine to reject low-level noise and large,
short duration, noise spikes that typically occur in noise
prone applications, such as a motor system.
Alternate 16-bit Timer/Counter
14.6
14.6.1
This timer does not support the External
Asynchronous Counter mode of operation.
If using an external clock source, the clock
will automatically be synchronized to the
internal instruction cycle.
QEI Module Operation During CPU
Sleep Mode
QEI OPERATION DURING CPU
SLEEP MODE
The QEI module will be halted during the CPU Sleep
mode.
14.6.2
TIMER OPERATION DURING CPU
SLEEP MODE
During CPU Sleep mode, the timer will not operate
because the internal clocks are disabled.
To enable the filter output for channels QEA, QEB and
INDX, the QEOUT bit must be ‘1’. The filter network for
all channels is disabled on POR and BOR.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 87
dsPIC30F4011/4012
14.7
QEI Module Operation During CPU
Idle Mode
Since the QEI module can function as a quadrature
encoder interface, or as a 16-bit timer, the following
section describes operation of the module in both
modes.
14.7.1
QEI OPERATION DURING CPU IDLE
MODE
When the CPU is placed in the Idle mode, the QEI module will operate if the QEISIDL bit (QEICON<13>) = 0.
This bit defaults to a logic ‘0’ upon executing POR and
BOR. For halting the QEI module during the CPU Idle
mode, QEISIDL should be set to ‘1’.
14.7.2
TIMER OPERATION DURING CPU
IDLE MODE
When the CPU is placed in the Idle mode and the QEI
module is configured in the 16-bit Timer mode, the
16-bit timer will operate if the QEISIDL bit
(QEICON<13>) = 0. This bit defaults to a logic ‘0’ upon
executing POR and BOR. For halting the timer module
during the CPU Idle mode, QEISIDL should be set
to ‘1’.
14.8
Quadrature Encoder Interface
Interrupts
The quadrature encoder interface has the ability to
generate an interrupt on occurrence of the following
events:
• Interrupt on 16-bit up/down position counter
rollover/underflow
• Detection of qualified index pulse or if CNTERR
bit is set
• Timer period match event (overflow/underflow)
• Gate accumulation event
The QEI Interrupt Flag bit, QEIIF, is asserted upon
occurrence of any of the above events. The QEIIF bit
must be cleared in software. QEIIF is located in the
IFS2 register.
Enabling an interrupt is accomplished via the respective Enable bit, QEIIE. The QEIIE bit is located in the
IEC2 register.
If the QEISIDL bit is cleared, the timer will function
normally as if the CPU Idle mode had not been
entered.
DS70135E-page 88
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 14-1:
SFR
Name
QEICON
Addr.
QEI REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
0122 CNTERR
DFLTCON 0124
—
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
—
QEISIDL
INDX
UPDN
QEIM2
—
—
—
—
IMV1
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
QEIM1 QEIM0 SWPAB
IMV0
CEID
—
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
TQGATE TQCKPS1 TQCKPS0 POSRES TQCS UPDN_SRC 0000 0000 0000 0000
QEOUT QECK2 QECK1
QECK0
—
—
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
POSCNT
0126
Position Counter<15:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
MAXCNT
0128
Maximun Count<15:0>
1111 1111 1111 1111
ADPCFG
02A8
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PCFG8 PCFG7 PCFG6
Legend:
u = uninitialized bit
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
PCFG5
PCFG4
PCFG3
PCFG2
PCFG1
PCFG0
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 89
dsPIC30F4011/4012
NOTES:
DS70135E-page 90
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
15.0
MOTOR CONTROL PWM
MODULE
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
This module simplifies the task of generating multiple,
synchronized Pulse-Width Modulated (PWM) outputs.
In particular, the following power and motion control
applications are supported by the PWM module:
•
•
•
•
Three-Phase AC Induction Motor
Switched Reluctance (SR) Motor
Brushless DC (BLDC) Motor
Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS)
The PWM module has the following features:
•
•
•
•
•
•
6 PWM I/O pins with 3 duty cycle generators
Up to 16-bit resolution
‘On-the-Fly’ PWM frequency changes
Edge and Center-Aligned Output modes
Single Pulse Generation mode
Interrupt support for asymmetrical updates in
Center-Aligned mode
• Output override control for Electrically
Commutative Motor (ECM) operation
• ‘Special Event’ comparator for scheduling other
peripheral events
• Fault pins to optionally drive each of the PWM
output pins to a defined state
This module contains 3 duty cycle generators, numbered 1 through 3. The module has 6 PWM output pins,
numbered PWM1H/PWM1L through PWM3H/PWM3L.
The six I/O pins are grouped into high/low numbered
pairs, denoted by the suffix H or L, respectively. For
complementary loads, the low PWM pins are always
the complement of the corresponding high I/O pin.
The PWM module allows several modes of operation
which are beneficial for specific power control
applications.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 91
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 15-1:
PWM MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM
PWMCON1
PWM Enable and Mode SFRs
PWMCON2
DTCON1
Dead-Time Control SFRs
FLTACON
Fault Pin Control SFRs
OVDCON
PWM Manual
Control SFR
PWM Generator #3
16-bit Data Bus
PDC3 Buffer
PDC3
Comparator
PWM Generator
#2
PTMR
PWM3H
Channel 3 Dead-Time
Generator and
Override Logic
Channel 2 Dead-Time
Generator and
Override Logic
Comparator
PWM3L
PWM2H
Output
Driver
PWM2L
Block
PWM Generator
#1
Channel 1 Dead-Time
Generator and
Override Logic
PTPER
PWM1H
PWM1L
FLTA
PTPER Buffer
PTCON
Comparator
SEVTDIR
SEVTCMP
Special Event
Postscaler
Special Event Trigger
PTDIR
PWM Time Base
Note:
Details of PWM Generator #1 and #2 not shown for clarity.
DS70135E-page 92
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
15.1
PWM Time Base
The PWM time base is provided by a 15-bit timer with
a prescaler and postscaler. The time base is accessible
via the PTMR SFR. PTMR<15> is a read-only status
bit, PTDIR, that indicates the present count direction of
the PWM time base. If PTDIR is cleared, PTMR is
counting upwards. If PTDIR is set, PTMR is counting
downwards. The PWM time base is configured via the
PTCON SFR. The time base is enabled/disabled by
setting/clearing the PTEN bit in the PTCON SFR.
PTMR is not cleared when the PTEN bit is cleared in
software.
The PTPER SFR sets the counting period for PTMR.
The user must write a 15-bit value to PTPER<14:0>.
When the value in PTMR<14:0> matches the value in
PTPER<14:0>, the time base will either reset to ‘0’, or
reverse the count direction on the next occurring clock
cycle. The action taken depends on the operating
mode of the time base.
Note:
If the Period register is set to 0x0000, the
timer will stop counting, and the interrupt
and special event trigger will not be generated even if the special event value is also
0x0000. The module will not update the
Period register if it is already at 0x0000;
therefore, the user must disable the
module in order to update the Period
register.
The PWM time base can be configured for four different
modes of operation:
•
•
•
•
Free-Running mode
Single-Shot mode
Continuous Up/Down Count mode
Continuous Up/Down Count mode with interrupts
for double updates
These four modes are selected by the PTMOD<1:0>
bits in the PTCON SFR. The Continuous Up/Down
Count modes support center-aligned PWM generation.
The Single-Shot mode allows the PWM module to support pulse control of certain Electronically Commutative
Motors (ECMs).
The interrupt signals generated by the PWM time base
depend on the mode selection bits (PTMOD<1:0>) and
the postscaler bits (PTOPS<3:0>) in the PTCON SFR.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
15.1.1
FREE-RUNNING MODE
In the Free-Running mode, the PWM time base counts
upwards until the value in the Time Base Period register (PTPER) is matched. The PTMR register is reset on
the following input clock edge and the time base will
continue to count upwards as long as the PTEN bit
remains set.
When the PWM time base is in the Free-Running mode
(PTMOD<1:0> = 00), an interrupt event is generated
each time a match with the PTPER register occurs and
the PTMR register is reset to zero. The postscaler
selection bits may be used in this mode of the timer to
reduce the frequency of the interrupt events.
15.1.2
SINGLE-SHOT MODE
In the Single-Shot mode, the PWM time base begins
counting upwards when the PTEN bit is set. When the
value in the PTMR register matches the PTPER register, the PTMR register will be reset on the following
input clock edge and the PTEN bit will be cleared by the
hardware to halt the time base.
When the PWM time base is in the Single-Shot mode
(PTMOD<1:0> = 01), an interrupt event is generated
when a match with the PTPER register occurs, the
PTMR register is reset to zero on the following input
clock edge and the PTEN bit is cleared. The postscaler
selection bits have no effect in this mode of the timer.
15.1.3
CONTINUOUS UP/DOWN COUNT
MODES
In the Continuous Up/Down Count modes, the PWM
time base counts upwards until the value in the PTPER
register is matched. The timer will begin counting
downwards on the following input clock edge. The
PTDIR bit in the PTMR SFR is read-only and indicates
the counting direction. The PTDIR bit is set when the
timer counts downwards.
In the Continuous Up/Down Count mode
(PTMOD<1:0> = 10), an interrupt event is generated
each time the value of the PTMR register becomes
zero and the PWM time base begins to count upwards.
The postscaler selection bits may be used in this mode
of the timer to reduce the frequency of the interrupt
events.
DS70135E-page 93
dsPIC30F4011/4012
15.1.4
DOUBLE UPDATE MODE
15.2
PWM Period
In the Double Update mode (PTMOD<1:0> = 11), an
interrupt event is generated each time the PTMR register is equal to zero, as well as each time a period match
occurs. The postscaler selection bits have no effect in
this mode of the timer.
PTPER is a 15-bit register and is used to set the
counting period for the PWM time base. PTPER is a
double-buffered register. The PTPER buffer contents
are loaded into the PTPER register at the following
instants:
The Double Update mode provides two additional functions to the user. First, the control loop bandwidth is
doubled because the PWM duty cycles can be
updated, twice per period. Second, asymmetrical
center-aligned PWM waveforms can be generated
which are useful for minimizing output waveform
distortion in certain motor control applications.
• Free-Running and Single-Shot modes: When the
PTMR register is reset to zero after a match with
the PTPER register.
• Continuous Up/Down Count modes: When the
PTMR register is zero.
Note:
15.1.5
Programming a value of 0x0001 in the
Period register could generate a continuous interrupt pulse, and hence, must be
avoided.
PWM TIME BASE PRESCALER
The input clock to PTMR (FOSC/4) has prescaler
options of 1:1, 1:4, 1:16 or 1:64, selected by control
bits, PTCKPS<1:0>, in the PTCON SFR. The prescaler
counter is cleared when any of the following occurs:
The value held in the PTPER buffer is automatically
loaded into the PTPER register when the PWM time
base is disabled (PTEN = 0).
The PWM period
Equation 15-1:
EQUATION 15-1:
TPWM =
can
be
determined
using
PWM PERIOD
TCY • (PTPER + 1)
(PTMR Prescale Value)
• a write to the PTMR register
• a write to the PTCON register
• any device Reset
If the PWM time base is configured for one of the
Continuous Up/Down Count modes, the PWM period is
provided by Equation 15-2.
The PTMR register is not cleared when PTCON is
written.
EQUATION 15-2:
15.1.6
PWM TIME BASE POSTSCALER
The match output of PTMR can optionally be postscaled through a 4-bit postscaler (which gives a 1:1 to
1:16 scaling).
The postscaler counter is cleared when any of the
following occurs:
• a write to the PTMR register
• a write to the PTCON register
• any device Reset
The PTMR register is not cleared when PTCON is written.
TPWM =
PWM PERIOD
(CENTER-ALIGNED
MODE)
2 TCY • PTPER + 0.75
(PTMR Prescale Value)
The maximum resolution (in bits) for a given device
oscillator and PWM frequency can be determined using
Equation 15-3:
EQUATION 15-3:
Resolution =
PWM RESOLUTION
log (2 • TPWM/TCY)
log (2)
DS70135E-page 94
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
15.3
Edge-Aligned PWM
Edge-aligned PWM signals are produced by the module
when the PWM time base is in the Free-Running or
Single-Shot mode. For edge-aligned PWM outputs, the
output has a period specified by the value in PTPER
and a duty cycle specified by the appropriate duty cycle
register (see Figure 15-2). The PWM output is driven
active at the beginning of the period (PTMR = 0) and is
driven inactive when the value in the duty cycle register
matches PTMR.
If the value in a particular duty cycle register is zero,
then the output on the corresponding PWM pin will be
inactive for the entire PWM period. In addition, the output on the PWM pin will be active for the entire PWM
period if the value in the duty cycle register is greater
than the value held in the PTPER register.
FIGURE 15-2:
EDGE-ALIGNED PWM
New Duty Cycle Latched
15.4
Center-Aligned PWM
Center-aligned PWM signals are produced by the
module when the PWM time base is configured in a
Continuous Up/Down Count mode (see Figure 15-3).
The PWM compare output is driven to the active state
when the value of the duty cycle register matches the
value of PTMR and the PWM time base is counting
downwards (PTDIR = 1). The PWM compare output is
driven to the inactive state when the PWM time base is
counting upwards (PTDIR = 0) and the value in the
PTMR register matches the duty cycle value.
If the value in a particular duty cycle register is zero,
then the output on the corresponding PWM pin will be
inactive for the entire PWM period. In addition, the output on the PWM pin will be active for the entire PWM
period if the value in the duty cycle register is equal to
the value held in the PTPER register.
FIGURE 15-3:
CENTER-ALIGNED PWM
Period/2
PTPER
PTPER
PTMR
Value
0
PTMR
Value
Duty
Cycle
0
Duty Cycle
Period
Period
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 95
dsPIC30F4011/4012
15.5
PWM Duty Cycle Comparison
Units
There are three 16-bit Special Function Registers
(PDC1, PDC2 and PDC3) used to specify duty cycle
values for the PWM module.
The value in each duty cycle register determines the
amount of time that the PWM output is in the active
state. The duty cycle registers are 16-bits wide. The
LSb of a duty cycle register determines whether the
PWM edge occurs in the beginning. Thus, the PWM
resolution is effectively doubled.
15.5.1
DUTY CYCLE REGISTER BUFFERS
15.6
Complementary PWM Operation
In the Complementary mode of operation, each pair of
PWM outputs is obtained by a complementary PWM
signal. A dead time may be optionally inserted during
device switching when both outputs are inactive for
a short period (refer to Section 15.7 “Dead-Time
Generators”).
In Complementary mode, the duty cycle comparison
units are assigned to the PWM outputs as follows:
• PDC1 register controls PWM1H/PWM1L outputs
• PDC2 register controls PWM2H/PWM2L outputs
• PDC3 register controls PWM3H/PWM3L outputs
The three PWM duty cycle registers are doublebuffered to allow glitchless updates of the PWM
outputs. For each duty cycle, there is a duty cycle
register that is accessible by the user and a second
duty cycle register that holds the actual compare value
used in the present PWM period.
The Complementary mode is selected for each PWM
I/O pin pair by clearing the appropriate PTMODx bit in
the PWMCON1 SFR. The PWM I/O pins are set to
Complementary mode by default upon a device Reset.
For edge-aligned PWM output, a new duty cycle value
will be updated whenever a match with the PTPER register occurs and PTMR is reset. The contents of the
duty cycle buffers are automatically loaded into the
duty cycle registers when the PWM time base is disabled (PTEN = 0) and the UDIS bit is cleared in
PWMCON2.
Dead-time generation may be provided when any of
the PWM I/O pin pairs are operating in the
Complementary Output mode. The PWM outputs use
push-pull drive circuits. Due to the inability of the power
output devices to switch instantaneously, some amount
of time must be provided between the turn-off event
of one PWM output in a complementary pair and the
turn-on event of the other transistor.
When the PWM time base is in the Continuous Up/
Down Count mode, new duty cycle values are updated
when the value of the PTMR register is zero and the
PWM time base begins to count upwards. The contents
of the duty cycle buffers are automatically loaded into
the duty cycle registers when the PWM time base is
disabled (PTEN = 0).
When the PWM time base is in the Continuous Up/
Down Count mode with double updates, new duty cycle
values are updated when the value of the PTMR register is zero, and when the value of the PTMR register
matches the value in the PTPER register. The contents
of the duty cycle buffers are automatically loaded into
the duty cycle registers when the PWM time base is
disabled (PTEN = 0).
DS70135E-page 96
15.7
Dead-Time Generators
The PWM module allows two different dead times to be
programmed. These two dead times may be used in
one of two methods described below to increase user
flexibility:
• The PWM output signals can be optimized for
different turn-off times in the high side and low
side transistors in a complementary pair of transistors. The first dead time is inserted between
the turn-off event of the lower transistor of the
complementary pair and the turn-on event of the
upper transistor. The second dead time is inserted
between the turn-off event of the upper transistor
and the turn-on event of the lower transistor.
• The two dead times can be assigned to individual
PWM I/O pin pairs. This operating mode allows
the PWM module to drive different transistor/load
combinations with each complementary PWM I/O
pin pair.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
15.7.1
DEAD-TIME GENERATORS
Each complementary output pair for the PWM module
has a 6-bit down counter that is used to produce the
dead-time insertion. As shown in Figure 15-4, each
dead-time unit has a rising and falling edge detector
connected to the duty cycle comparison output.
15.7.2
DEAD-TIME RANGES
The amount of dead time provided by the dead-time
unit is selected by specifying the input clock prescaler
value and a 6-bit unsigned value.
Four input clock prescaler selections have been
provided to allow a suitable range of dead time based
on the device operating frequency. The dead-time
clock prescaler values are selected using the
FIGURE 15-4:
DTAPS<1:0> control bits in the DTCON1 SFR. One of
four clock prescaler options (TCY, 2 TCY, 4 TCY or 8 TCY)
may be selected.
After the prescaler value is selected, the dead time is
adjusted by loading 6-bit unsigned values into the
DTCON1 SFR.
The dead-time unit prescaler is cleared on the following
events:
• On a load of the down timer due to a duty cycle
comparison edge event.
• On a write to the DTCON1 register.
• On any device Reset.
Note:
The user should not modify the DTCON1
value while the PWM module is operating
(PTEN = 1). Unexpected results may
occur.
DEAD-TIME TIMING DIAGRAM
Duty Cycle Generator
PWMxH
PWMxL
Dead-Time A (Active)
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Dead-Time A (Inactive)
DS70135E-page 97
dsPIC30F4011/4012
15.8
Independent PWM Output
An Independent PWM Output mode is required for
driving certain types of loads. A particular PWM output
pair is in the Independent Output mode when the
corresponding PTMODx bit in the PWMCON1 register
is set. No dead-time control is implemented between
adjacent PWM I/O pins when the module is operating
in the Independent Output mode and both I/O pins are
allowed to be active simultaneously.
In the Independent Output mode, each duty cycle
generator is connected to both of the PWM I/O pins in
an output pair. By using the associated duty cycle register and the appropriate bits in the OVDCON register,
the user may select the following signal output options
for each PWM I/O pin operating in the Independent
Output mode:
15.10 PWM Output Override
The PWM output override bits allow the user to manually drive the PWM I/O pins to specified logic states,
independent of the duty cycle comparison units.
All control bits associated with the PWM output override function are contained in the OVDCON register.
The upper half of the OVDCON register contains six
bits, POVDxH<3:1> and POVDxL<3:1>, that determine
which PWM I/O pins will be overridden. The lower half
of the OVDCON register contains six bits,
POUTxH<3:1> and POUTxL<3:1>, that determine the
state of the PWM I/O pins when a particular output is
overridden via the POVD bits.
15.10.1
COMPLEMENTARY OUTPUT MODE
• I/O pin outputs PWM signal
• I/O pin inactive
• I/O pin active
When a PWMxL pin is driven active via the OVDCON
register, the output signal is forced to be the complement of the corresponding PWMxH pin in the pair.
Dead-time insertion is still performed when PWM
channels are overridden manually.
15.9
15.10.2
Single Pulse PWM Operation
The PWM module produces single pulse outputs when
the PTCON control bits, PTMOD<1:0> = 10. Only
edge-aligned outputs may be produced in the Single
Pulse mode. In Single Pulse mode, the PWM I/O pin(s)
are driven to the active state when the PTEN bit is set.
When a match with a duty cycle register occurs, the
PWM I/O pin is driven to the inactive state. When a
match with the PTPER register occurs, the PTMR register is cleared, all active PWM I/O pins are driven to
the inactive state, the PTEN bit is cleared and an
interrupt is generated.
DS70135E-page 98
OVERRIDE SYNCHRONIZATION
If the OSYNC bit in the PWMCON2 register is set, all
output overrides performed via the OVDCON register
are synchronized to the PWM time base. Synchronous
output overrides occur at the following times:
• Edge-Aligned mode when PTMR is zero.
• Center-Aligned modes when PTMR is zero and
when the value of PTMR matches PTPER.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
15.11 PWM Output and Polarity Control
15.12.2
There are three device Configuration bits associated
with the PWM module that provide PWM output pin
control:
The FLTACON Special Function Register has 6 bits
that determine the state of each PWM I/O pin when it is
overridden by a Fault input. When these bits are
cleared, the PWM I/O pin is driven to the inactive state.
If the bit is set, the PWM I/O pin will be driven to the
active state. The active and inactive states are referenced to the polarity defined for each PWM I/O pin
(HPOL and LPOL polarity control bits).
• HPOL Configuration bit
• LPOL Configuration bit
• PWMPIN Configuration bit
These three bits in the FPORBOR Configuration register (see Section 21.0 “System Integration”) work in
conjunction with the six PWM Enable bits (PENxL and
PENxH). The Configuration bits and PWM Enable bits
ensure that the PWM pins are in the correct states after
a device Reset occurs. The PWMPIN Configuration
fuse allows the PWM module outputs to be optionally
enabled on a device Reset. If PWMPIN = 0, the PWM
outputs will be driven to their inactive states at Reset. If
PWMPIN = 1 (default), the PWM outputs will be tristated. The HPOL bit specifies the polarity for the
PWMxH outputs, whereas the LPOL bit specifies the
polarity for the PWMxL outputs.
15.11.1
OUTPUT PIN CONTROL
The PEN<3:1>H and PEN<3:1>L control bits in the
PWMCON1 SFR enable each high PWM output pin
and each low PWM output pin, respectively. If a particular PWM output pin is not enabled, it is treated as a
general purpose I/O pin.
15.12 PWM Fault Pin
There is one Fault pin (FLTA) associated with the PWM
module. When asserted, these pins can optionally drive
each of the PWM I/O pins to a defined state.
15.12.1
FAULT PIN ENABLE BITS
The FLTACON SFR has 3 control bits that determine
whether a particular pair of PWM I/O pins is to be
controlled by the Fault input pin. To enable a
specific PWM I/O pin pair for Fault overrides, the
corresponding bit should be set in the FLTACON
register.
FAULT STATES
A special case exists when a PWM module I/O pair is
in the Complementary mode and both pins are
programmed to be active on a Fault condition. The
PWMxH pin always has priority in the Complementary
mode, so that both I/O pins cannot be driven active
simultaneously.
15.12.3
FAULT INPUT MODES
The Fault input pin has two modes of operation:
• Latched Mode: When the Fault pin is driven low,
the PWM outputs will go to the states defined in
the FLTACON register. The PWM outputs will
remain in this state until the Fault pin is driven
high and the corresponding interrupt flag has
been cleared in software. When both of these
actions have occurred, the PWM outputs will
return to normal operation at the beginning of the
next PWM cycle or half-cycle boundary. If the
interrupt flag is cleared before the Fault condition
ends, the PWM module will wait until the Fault pin
is no longer asserted to restore the outputs.
• Cycle-by-Cycle Mode: When the Fault input pin
is driven low, the PWM outputs remain in the
defined Fault states for as long as the Fault pin is
held low. After the Fault pin is driven high, the
PWM outputs return to normal operation at the
beginning of the following PWM cycle or
half-cycle boundary.
The operating mode for the Fault input pin is selected
using the FLTAM control bit in the FLTACON Special
Function Register.
The Fault pin can be controlled manually in software.
If all enable bits are cleared in the FLTACON register,
then the corresponding Fault input pin has no effect on
the PWM module and the pin may be used as a general
purpose interrupt or I/O pin.
Note:
The Fault pin logic can operate independent of the PWM logic. If all the enable bits
in the FLTACON register are cleared, then
the Fault pin could be used as a general
purpose interrupt pin. The Fault pin has an
interrupt vector, interrupt flag bit and
interrupt priority bits associated with it.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 99
dsPIC30F4011/4012
15.13 PWM Update Lockout
15.14.1
For a complex PWM application, the user may need to
write up to three duty cycle registers and the Time Base
Period register, PTPER, at a given time. In some applications, it is important that all buffer registers be written
before the new duty cycle and period values are loaded
for use by the module.
The PWM special event trigger has a postscaler that
allows a 1:1 to 1:16 postscale ratio. The postscaler is
configured by writing the SEVOPS<3:0> control bits in
the PWMCON2 SFR.
The PWM update lockout feature is enabled by setting
the UDIS control bit in the PWMCON2 SFR. The UDIS
bit affects all duty cycle buffer registers and the PWM
Time Base Period buffer, PTPER. No duty cycle
changes or period value changes will have effect while
UDIS = 1.
15.14 PWM Special Event Trigger
The PWM module has a special event trigger that
allows A/D conversions to be synchronized to the PWM
time base. The A/D sampling and conversion time may
be programmed to occur at any point within the PWM
period. The special event trigger allows the user to minimize the delay between the time when A/D conversion
results are acquired and the time when the duty cycle
value is updated.
The PWM special event trigger has an SFR named
SEVTCMP and five control bits to control its operation.
The PTMR value for which a special event trigger
should occur is loaded into the SEVTCMP register.
When the PWM time base is in a Continuous Up/Down
Count mode, an additional control bit is required to
specify the counting phase for the special event trigger.
The count phase is selected using the SEVTDIR control bit in the SEVTCMP SFR. If the SEVTDIR bit is
cleared, the special event trigger will occur on the
upward counting cycle of the PWM time base. If the
SEVTDIR bit is set, the special event trigger will occur
on the downward count cycle of the PWM time base.
The SEVTDIR control bit has no effect unless the PWM
time base is configured for a Continuous Up/Down
Count mode.
DS70135E-page 100
SPECIAL EVENT TRIGGER
POSTSCALER
The special event output postscaler is cleared on the
following events:
• Any write to the SEVTCMP register
• Any device Reset
15.15 PWM Operation During CPU Sleep
Mode
The Fault A input pin has the ability to wake the CPU
from Sleep mode. The PWM module generates an
interrupt if the Fault pin is driven low while in Sleep.
15.16 PWM Operation During CPU Idle
Mode
The PTCON SFR contains a PTSIDL control bit. This
bit determines if the PWM module will continue to
operate or stop when the device enters Idle mode. If
PTSIDL = 0, the module will continue to operate. If
PTSIDL = 1, the module will stop operation as long as
the CPU remains in Idle mode.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 15-1:
SFR Name Addr.
6-OUTPUT PWM REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
—
PTSIDL
—
—
—
—
Bit 8
Bit 7
—
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
PTOPS<3:0>
Bit 3
Bit 2
PTCKPS<1:0>
Bit 1
Bit 0
PTMOD<1:0>
Reset State
PTCON
01C0
PTEN
PTMR
01C2
PTDIR
PWM Timer Count Value
0000 0000 0000 0000
PTPER
01C4
—
PWM Time Base Period Register
0111 1111 1111 1111
SEVTCMP
01C6 SEVTDIR
PWM Special Event Compare Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
PWMCON1 01C8
—
—
—
—
PWMCON2 01CA
—
—
—
—
DTCON1
01CC
—
—
—
—
FLTACON
01D0
—
—
FAOV3H FAOV3L FAOV2H FAOV2L FAOV1H FAOV1L FLTAM
—
OVDCON
01D4
—
—
POVD3H POVD3L POVD2H POVD2L POVD1H POVD1L
—
PDC1
01D6
PWM Duty Cycle #1 Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
PDC2
01D8
PWM Duty Cycle #2 Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
PDC3
01DA
PWM Duty Cycle #3 Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
PTMOD3 PTMOD2 PTMOD1
SEVOPS<3:0>
—
—
—
—
—
PEN3H
PEN2H
PEN1H
—
—
—
—
DTAPS<1:0>
—
Legend:
u = uninitialized bit
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
—
PEN3L
PEN2L
PEN1L
0000 0000 1111 1111
—
—
OSYNC
UDIS
0000 0000 0000 0000
FAEN2
FAEN1
0000 0000 0000 0000
Dead-Time A Value
—
—
—
FAEN3
0000 0000 0000 0000
POUT3H POUT3L POUT2H POUT2L POUT1H POUT1L 1111 1111 0000 0000
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 101
dsPIC30F4011/4012
NOTES:
DS70135E-page 102
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
16.0
SPI MODULE
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) module is a
synchronous serial interface. It is useful for communicating with other peripheral devices, such as
EEPROMs, shift registers, display drivers and A/D
converters, or other microcontrollers. It is compatible
with Motorola’s SPI and SIOP interfaces.
16.1
Operating Function Description
The SPI module consists of a 16-bit shift register,
SPI1SR, used for shifting data in and out, and a buffer
register, SPI1BUF. A control register, SPI1CON,
configures the module. Additionally, a status register,
SPI1STAT, indicates various status conditions.
The serial interface consists of 4 pins: SDI1 (Serial Data
Input), SDO1 (Serial Data Output), SCK1 (Shift Clock
Input or Output), and SS1 (active-low Slave Select).
In Master mode operation, SCK1 is a clock output, but
in Slave mode, it is a clock input.
In Master mode, the clock is generated by prescaling
the system clock. Data is transmitted as soon as a
value is written to SPI1BUF. The interrupt is generated
at the middle of the transfer of the last bit.
In Slave mode, data is transmitted and received as
external clock pulses appear on SCK1. Again, the
interrupt is generated when the last bit is latched. If
SS1 control is enabled, then transmission and reception are enabled only when SS1 = low. The SDO1
output will be disabled in SS1 mode with SS1 high.
The clock provided to the module is (FOSC/4). This
clock is then prescaled by the primary (PPRE<1:0>)
and secondary (SPRE<2:0>) prescale factors. The
CKE bit determines whether transmit occurs on transition from active clock state to Idle clock state, or vice
versa. The CKP bit selects the Idle state (high or low)
for the clock.
16.1.1
WORD AND BYTE
COMMUNICATION
A control bit, MODE16 (SPI1CON<10>), allows the
module to communicate in either 16-bit or 8-bit mode.
16-bit operation is identical to 8-bit operation, except
that the number of bits transmitted is 16 instead of 8.
The user software must disable the module prior to
changing the MODE16 bit. The SPI module is reset
when the MODE16 bit is changed by the user.
A series of eight (8) or sixteen (16) clock pulses shift
out bits from the SPI1SR to SDO1 pin, and simultaneously, shifts in data from SDI1 pin. An interrupt is
generated when the transfer is complete and the
corresponding interrupt flag bit (SPI1IF) is set. This
interrupt can be disabled through an interrupt enable
bit (SPI1IE).
A basic difference between 8-bit and 16-bit operation is
that the data is transmitted out of bit 7 of the SPI1SR
for 8-bit operation, and data is transmitted out of bit 15
of the SPI1SR for 16-bit operation. In both modes, data
is shifted into bit 0 of the SPI1SR.
The receive operation is double-buffered. When a
complete byte is received, it is transferred from
SPI1SR to SPI1BUF.
A control bit, DISSDO, is provided to the SPI1CON
register to allow the SDO1 output to be disabled. This
will allow the SPI module to be connected in an input
only configuration. SDO1 can also be used for general
purpose I/O.
If the receive buffer is full when new data is being
transferred from SPI1SR to SPI1BUF, the module will
set the SPIROV bit, indicating an overflow condition.
The transfer of the data from SPI1SR to SPI1BUF will
not be completed and the new data will be lost. The
module will not respond to SCL transitions while
SPIROV is ‘1’, effectively disabling the module until
SPI1BUF is read by user software.
Transmit writes are also double-buffered. The user
writes to SPI1BUF. When the master or slave transfer
is completed, the contents of the shift register
(SPI1SR) is moved to the receive buffer. If any transmit data has been written to the buffer register, the
contents of the transmit buffer are moved to SPI1SR.
The received data is thus placed in SPI1BUF and the
transmit data in SPI1SR is ready for the next transfer.
Note:
16.1.2
16.2
SDO1 DISABLE
Framed SPI Support
The module supports a basic framed SPI protocol in
Master or Slave mode. The control bit, FRMEN,
enables framed SPI support and causes the SS1 pin to
perform the frame synchronization pulse (FSYNC)
function. The control bit, SPIFSD, determines whether
the SS1 pin is an input or an output (i.e., whether the
module receives or generates the frame synchronization pulse). The frame pulse is an active-high pulse for
a single SPI clock cycle. When frame synchronization
is enabled, the data transmission starts only on the
subsequent transmit edge of the SPI clock.
Both the transmit buffer (SPI1TXB) and
the receive buffer (SPI1RXB) are mapped
to the same register address, SPI1BUF.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 103
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 16-1:
SPI BLOCK DIAGRAM
Internal
Data Bus
Read
Write
SPI1BUF
SPI1BUF
Transmit
Receive
SPI1SR
SDI1
bit 0
SDO1
Shift
Clock
SS1 and
FSYNC
Control
SS1
Clock
Control
Edge
Select
Secondary
Prescaler
1, 2, 4, 6, 8
SCK1
Primary
Prescaler
1, 4, 16, 64
FCY
Enable Master Clock
FIGURE 16-2:
SPI MASTER/SLAVE CONNECTION
SPI Master
SPI Slave
SDI1
SDO1
Serial Input Buffer
(SPI1BUF)
LSb
MSb
SCK1
PROCESSOR 1
DS70135E-page 104
Shift Register
(SPI1SR)
SDO1
SDI1
Shift Register
(SPI1SR)
MSb
Serial Input Buffer
(SPI1BUF)
Serial Clock
LSb
SCK1
PROCESSOR 2
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
16.3
Slave Select Synchronization
The SS1 pin allows a Synchronous Slave mode. The
SPI must be configured in SPI Slave mode, with SS1
pin control enabled (SSEN = 1). When the SS1 pin is
low, transmission and reception are enabled and the
SDO1 pin is driven. When SS1 pin goes high, the
SDO1 pin is no longer driven. Also, the SPI module is
resynchronized and all counters/control circuitry are
reset. Therefore, when the SS1 pin is asserted low
again, transmission/reception will begin at the MSb,
even if SS1 had been deasserted in the middle of a
transmit/receive.
16.4
SPI Operation During CPU Sleep
Mode
During Sleep mode, the SPI module is shut down. If
the CPU enters Sleep mode while an SPI transaction
is in progress, then the transmission and reception is
aborted.
The transmitter and receiver will stop in Sleep mode.
However, register contents are not affected by
entering or exiting Sleep mode.
16.5
SPI Operation During CPU Idle
Mode
When the device enters Idle mode, all clock sources
remain functional. The SPISIDL bit (SPI1STAT<13>)
selects if the SPI module will stop or continue on Idle.
If SPISIDL = 0, the module will continue to operate
when the CPU enters Idle mode. If SPISIDL = 1, the
module will stop when the CPU enters Idle mode.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 105
SPI1 REGISTER MAP
SFR
Name
Addr.
Bit 15
SPI1STAT
0220
SPI1CON
0222
SPI1BUF
0224
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
SPIEN
—
SPISIDL
—
—
FRMEN
SPIFSD
—
Bit 11
Bit 10
—
—
DISSDO MODE16
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
—
—
—
SPIROV
—
—
—
—
SPITBF
SPIRBF 0000 0000 0000 0000
SMP
CKE
SSEN
CKP
MSTEN
SPRE2
SPRE1
SPRE0
PPRE1
PPRE0
Transmit and Receive Buffer
Legend:
u = uninitialized bit
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 106
TABLE 16-1:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
17.0
I2C™ MODULE
17.1.1
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
The Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) module provides
complete hardware support for both Slave and MultiMaster modes of the I2C serial communication
standard with a 16-bit interface.
This module offers the following key features:
• I2C Interface supporting both Master and Slave
Operation.
• I2C Slave mode supports 7 and 10-bit addressing.
• I2C Master mode supports 7 and 10-bit addressing.
• I2C Port allows Bidirectional Transfers between
Master and Slaves.
• Serial Clock Synchronization for I2C Port can be
used as a Handshake Mechanism to Suspend
and Resume Serial Transfer (SCLREL control).
• I2C supports Multi-Master Operation; Detects Bus
Collision and will Arbitrate accordingly.
17.1
Operating Function Description
The hardware fully implements all the master and slave
functions of the I2C Standard and Fast mode
specifications, as well as 7 and 10-bit addressing.
Thus, the I2C module can operate either as a slave or
a master on an I2C bus.
The following types of I2C operation are supported:
•
•
•
I2C slave operation with 7-bit addressing.
I2C slave operation with 10-bit addressing.
I2C master operation with 7 or 10-bit addressing.
See the I2C programmer’s model in Figure 17-1.
17.1.2
PIN CONFIGURATION IN I2C MODE
I2C has a 2-pin interface; SCL pin is clock and SDA pin
is data.
17.1.3
I2C REGISTERS
I2CCON and I2CSTAT are control and status registers,
respectively. The I2CCON register is readable and writable. The lower 6 bits of I2CSTAT are read-only. The
remaining bits of the I2CSTAT are read/write.
I2CRSR is the shift register used for shifting data,
whereas I2CRCV is the buffer register to which data
bytes are written or from which data bytes are read.
I2CRCV is the receive buffer, as shown in Figure 17-1.
I2CTRN is the transmit register to which bytes are
written during a transmit operation, as shown in
Figure 17-2.
The I2CADD register holds the slave address. A status
bit, ADD10, indicates 10-bit Address mode. The
I2CBRG acts as the Baud Rate Generator reload
value.
In receive operations, I2CRSR and I2CRCV together
form a double-buffered receiver. When I2CRSR
receives a complete byte, it is transferred to I2CRCV
and an interrupt pulse is generated. During
transmission, the I2CTRN is not double-buffered.
Note:
FIGURE 17-1:
VARIOUS I2C MODES
Following a Restart condition in 10-bit
mode, the user only needs to match the
first 7-bit address.
PROGRAMMER’S MODEL
I2CRCV (8 bits)
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
bit 0
I2CTRN (8 bits)
I2CBRG (9 bits)
bit 8
bit 0
I2CCON (16-bits)
bit 15
bit 0
bit 15
bit 0
I2CSTAT (16-bits)
I2CADD (10-bits)
bit 9
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
bit 0
DS70135E-page 107
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 17-2:
I2C™ BLOCK DIAGRAM
Internal
Data Bus
I2CRCV
Read
SCL
Shift
Clock
I2CRSR
LSB
SDA
Addr_Match
Match Detect
Write
I2CADD
Read
Start and
Stop bit Detect
I2CSTAT
Write
Control Logic
Start, Restart,
Stop bit Generate
Write
I2CCON
Collision
Detect
Acknowledge
Generation
Clock
Stretching
Read
Read
Write
I2CTRN
LSB
Shift
Clock
Read
Reload
Control
BRG Down
Counter
DS70135E-page 108
Write
I2CBRG
FCY
Read
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
17.2
I2C Module Addresses
The I2CADD register contains the Slave mode
addresses. The register is a 10-bit register.
If the A10M bit (I2CCON<10>) is ‘0’, the address is
interpreted by the module as a 7-bit address. When an
address is received, it is compared to the 7 LSbs of the
I2CADD register.
If the A10M bit is ‘1’, the address is assumed to be a
10-bit address. When an address is received, it will be
compared with the binary value, ‘11110 A9 A8’
(where A9 and A8 are two Most Significant bits of
I2CADD). If that value matches, the next address will
be compared with the Least Significant 8 bits of
I2CADD, as specified in the 10-bit addressing protocol.
17.3.2
If the R_W bit received is a ‘0’ during an address
match, then Receive mode is initiated. Incoming bits
are sampled on the rising edge of SCL. After 8 bits are
received, if I2CRCV is not full or I2COV is not set,
I2CRSR is transferred to I2CRCV. ACK is sent on the
ninth clock.
If the RBF flag is set, indicating that I2CRCV is still
holding data from a previous operation (RBF = 1), then
ACK is not sent; however, the interrupt pulse is generated. In the case of an overflow, the contents of the
I2CRSR are not loaded into the I2CRCV.
Note:
The 7-bit I2C slave addresses supported by the
dsPIC30F are shown in Table 17-1.
TABLE 17-1:
SLAVE RECEPTION
7-BIT I2C™ SLAVE
ADDRESSES
The I2CRCV will be loaded if the I2COV
bit = 1 and the RBF flag = 0. In this case,
a read of the I2CRCV was performed but
the user did not clear the state of the
I2COV bit before the next receive
occurred. The Acknowledgement is not
sent (ACK = 1) and the I2CRCV is
updated.
0x00
General call address or Start byte
0x01-0x03
Reserved
17.4
0x04-0x07
HS mode master codes
0x08-0x77
Valid 7-bit addresses
In 10-bit mode, the basic receive and transmit
operations are the same as in the 7-bit mode. However,
the criteria for address match is more complex.
0x78-0x7B
Valid 10-bit addresses (lower 7 bits)
0x7C-0x7F
Reserved
17.3
I2C 7-bit Slave Mode Operation
Once enabled (I2CEN = 1), the slave module will wait
for a Start bit to occur (i.e., the I2C module is ‘Idle’).
Following the detection of a Start bit, 8 bits are shifted
into I2CRSR and the address is compared against
I2CADD. In 7-bit mode (A10M = 0), I2CADD<6:0> bits
are compared against I2CRSR<7:1>, and I2CRSR<0>
is the R_W bit. All incoming bits are sampled on the
rising edge of SCL.
If an address match occurs, an Acknowledgement will
be sent, and the Slave Event Interrupt Flag (SI2CIF) is
set on the falling edge of the ninth (ACK) bit. The
address match does not affect the contents of the
I2CRCV buffer or the RBF bit.
17.3.1
SLAVE TRANSMISSION
If the R_W bit received is a ‘1’, then the serial port will
go into Transmit mode. It will send ACK on the ninth bit
and then hold SCL to ‘0’ until the CPU responds by writing to I2CTRN. SCL is released by setting the SCLREL
bit and 8 bits of data are shifted out. Data bits are
shifted out on the falling edge of SCL, such that SDA is
valid during SCL high (see timing diagram). The interrupt pulse is sent on the falling edge of the ninth clock
pulse, regardless of the status of the ACK received
from the master.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
I2C 10-bit Slave Mode Operation
The I2C specification dictates that a slave must be
addressed for a write operation, with two address bytes
following a Start bit.
The A10M bit is a control bit that signifies that the
address in I2CADD is a 10-bit address rather than a
7-bit address. The address detection protocol for the
first byte of a message address is identical for 7-bit
and 10-bit messages but the bits being compared are
different.
I2CADD holds the entire 10-bit address. Upon receiving an address following a Start bit, I2CRSR<7:3> is
compared against a literal ‘11110’ (the default 10-bit
address) and I2CRSR<2:1> are compared against
I2CADD<9:8>. If a match occurs and if R_W = 0, the
interrupt pulse is sent. The ADD10 bit will be cleared to
indicate a partial address match. If a match fails or
R_W = 1, the ADD10 bit is cleared and the module
returns to the Idle state.
The low byte of the address is then received and compared with I2CADD<7:0>. If an address match occurs,
the interrupt pulse is generated and the ADD10 bit is
set, indicating a complete 10-bit address match. If an
address match did not occur, the ADD10 bit is cleared
and the module returns to the Idle state.
DS70135E-page 109
dsPIC30F4011/4012
17.4.1
10-BIT MODE SLAVE
TRANSMISSION
Once a slave is addressed in this fashion, with the full
10-bit address (we will refer to this state as
“PRIOR_ADDR_MATCH”), the master can begin
sending data bytes for a slave reception operation.
17.4.2
10-BIT MODE SLAVE RECEPTION
Once addressed, the master can generate a Repeated
Start, reset the high byte of the address and set the
R_W bit without generating a Stop bit, thus initiating a
slave transmit operation.
17.5
Automatic Clock Stretch
In the Slave modes, the module can synchronize buffer
reads and write to the master device by clock stretching.
17.5.1
In Slave Transmit modes, clock stretching is always
performed, irrespective of the STREN bit.
Clock synchronization takes place following the ninth
clock of the transmit sequence. If the device samples
an ACK on the falling edge of the ninth clock, and if the
TBF bit is still clear, then the SCLREL bit is automatically cleared. The SCLREL being cleared to ‘0’ will
assert the SCL line low. The user’s ISR must set the
SCLREL bit before transmission is allowed to
continue. By holding the SCL line low, the user has
time to service the ISR and load the contents of the
I2CTRN before the master device can initiate another
transmit sequence.
Note 1: If the user loads the contents of I2CTRN,
setting the TBF bit before the falling edge
of the ninth clock, the SCLREL bit will not
be cleared and clock stretching will not
occur.
2: The SCLREL bit can be set in software
regardless of the state of the TBF bit.
RECEIVE CLOCK STRETCHING
The STREN bit in the I2CCON register can be used to
enable clock stretching in Slave Receive mode. When
the STREN bit is set, the SCL pin will be held low at
the end of each data receive sequence.
17.5.3
Note 1: If the user reads the contents of the
I2CRCV, clearing the RBF bit before the
falling edge of the ninth clock, the
SCLREL bit will not be cleared and clock
stretching will not occur.
2: The SCLREL bit can be set in software,
regardless of the state of the RBF bit. The
user should be careful to clear the RBF bit
in the ISR before the next receive
sequence in order to prevent an overflow
condition.
TRANSMIT CLOCK STRETCHING
Both 10-bit and 7-bit Transmit modes implement clock
stretching by asserting the SCLREL bit after the falling
edge of the ninth clock if the TBF bit is cleared,
indicating the buffer is empty.
17.5.2
Clock stretching takes place following the ninth clock of
the receive sequence. On the falling edge of the ninth
clock at the end of the ACK sequence, if the RBF bit is
set, the SCLREL bit is automatically cleared, forcing the
SCL output to be held low. The user’s ISR must set the
SCLREL bit before reception is allowed to continue. By
holding the SCL line low, the user has time to service
the ISR and read the contents of the I2CRCV before the
master device can initiate another receive sequence.
This will prevent buffer overruns from occurring.
CLOCK STRETCHING DURING
7-BIT ADDRESSING (STREN = 1)
17.5.4
CLOCK STRETCHING DURING
10-BIT ADDRESSING (STREN = 1)
Clock stretching takes place automatically during the
addressing sequence. Because this module has a
register for the entire address, it is not necessary for
the protocol to wait for the address to be updated.
After the address phase is complete, clock stretching
will occur on each data receive or transmit sequence
as was described earlier.
17.6
Software Controlled Clock
Stretching (STREN = 1)
When the STREN bit is ‘1’, the SCLREL bit may be
cleared by software to allow software to control the
clock stretching. The logic will synchronize writes to
the SCLREL bit with the SCL clock. Clearing the
SCLREL bit will not assert the SCL output until the
module detects a falling edge on the SCL output and
SCL is sampled low. If the SCLREL bit is cleared by
the user while the SCL line has been sampled low, the
SCL output will be asserted (held low). The SCL output will remain low until the SCLREL bit is set and all
other devices on the I2C bus have deasserted SCL.
This ensures that a write to the SCLREL bit will not
violate the minimum high time requirement for SCL.
If the STREN bit is ‘0’, a software write to the SCLREL
bit will be disregarded and have no effect on the
SCLREL bit.
When the STREN bit is set in Slave Receive mode,
the SCL line is held low when the buffer register is full.
The method for stretching the SCL output is the same
for both 7 and 10-bit Addressing modes.
DS70135E-page 110
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
17.7
Interrupts
The I2C module generates two interrupt flags, MI2CIF
(I2C Master Interrupt Flag) and SI2CIF (I2C Slave Interrupt Flag). The MI2CIF interrupt flag is activated on
completion of a master message event. The SI2CIF
interrupt flag is activated on detection of a message
directed to the slave.
17.8
Slope Control
2
The I C standard requires slope control on the SDA
and SCL signals for Fast mode (400 kHz). The control
bit, DISSLW, enables the user to disable slew rate control, if desired. It is necessary to disable the slew rate
control for 1 MHz mode.
17.9
IPMI Support
The control bit, IPMIEN, enables the module to support
Intelligent Peripheral Management Interface (IPMI).
When this bit is set, the module accepts and acts upon
all addresses.
17.10 General Call Address Support
The general call address can address all devices.
When this address is used, all devices should, in
theory, respond with an Acknowledgement.
The general call address is one of eight addresses
reserved for specific purposes by the I2C protocol. It
consists of all ‘0’s with R_W = 0.
The general call address is recognized when the General Call Enable (GCEN) bit is set (I2CCON<7> = 1).
Following a Start bit detection, 8 bits are shifted into
I2CRSR and the address is compared with I2CADD,
and is also compared with the general call address
which is fixed in hardware.
If a general call address match occurs, the I2CRSR is
transferred to the I2CRCV after the eighth clock, the
RBF flag is set, and on the falling edge of the ninth bit
(ACK bit), the Master Event Interrupt Flag (MI2CIF) is
set.
When the interrupt is serviced, the source for the interrupt
can be checked by reading the contents of the I2CRCV
to determine if the address was device-specific or a
general call address.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
17.11 I2C Master Support
As a master device, six operations are supported.
• Assert a Start condition on SDA and SCL.
• Assert a Restart condition on SDA and SCL.
• Write to the I2CTRN register initiating
transmission of data/address.
• Generate a Stop condition on SDA and SCL.
• Configure the I2C port to receive data.
• Generate an ACK condition at the end of a
received byte of data.
17.12 I2C Master Operation
The master device generates all of the serial clock
pulses and the Start and Stop conditions. A transfer is
ended with a Stop condition or with a Repeated Start
condition. Since the Repeated Start condition is also
the beginning of the next serial transfer, the I2C bus will
not be released.
In Master Transmitter mode, serial data is output
through SDA, while SCL outputs the serial clock. The
first byte transmitted contains the slave address of the
receiving device (7 bits) and the data direction bit. In
this case, the data direction bit (R_W) is logic ‘0’. Serial
data is transmitted 8 bits at a time. After each byte is
transmitted, an ACK bit is received. Start and Stop
conditions are output to indicate the beginning and the
end of a serial transfer.
In Master Receive mode, the first byte transmitted
contains the slave address of the transmitting device
(7 bits) and the data direction bit. In this case, the data
direction bit (R_W) is logic ‘1’. Thus, the first byte
transmitted is a 7-bit slave address, followed by a ‘1’ to
indicate the receive bit. Serial data is received via SDA
while SCL outputs the serial clock. Serial data is
received 8 bits at a time. After each byte is received, an
ACK bit is transmitted. Start and Stop conditions
indicate the beginning and end of transmission.
17.12.1
I2C MASTER TRANSMISSION
Transmission of a data byte, a 7-bit address or the
second half of a 10-bit address, is accomplished by
simply writing a value to the I2CTRN register. The user
should only write to I2CTRN when the module is in a
Wait state. This action will set the buffer full flag (TBF)
and allow the Baud Rate Generator to begin counting
and start the next transmission. Each bit of address/
data will be shifted out onto the SDA pin after the falling
edge of SCL is asserted. The Transmit Status Flag,
TRSTAT (I2CSTAT<14>), indicates that a master
transmit is in progress.
DS70135E-page 111
dsPIC30F4011/4012
17.12.2
I2C MASTER RECEPTION
Master mode reception is enabled by programming the
receive enable (RCEN) bit (I2CCON<3>). The I2C
module must be Idle before the RCEN bit is set, otherwise the RCEN bit will be disregarded. The Baud Rate
Generator begins counting and on each rollover, the
state of the SCL pin toggles and data is shifted in to the
I2CRSR on the rising edge of each clock.
If a transmit was in progress when the bus collision
occurred, the transmission is halted, the TBF flag is
cleared, the SDA and SCL lines are deasserted and a
value can now be written to I2CTRN. When the user
services the I2C master event Interrupt Service Routine
and if the I2C bus is free (i.e., the P bit is set), the user
can resume communication by asserting a Start
condition.
In I2C Master mode, the reload value for the BRG is
located in the I2CBRG register. When the BRG is
loaded with this value, the BRG counts down to ‘0’ and
stops until another reload has taken place. If clock
arbitration is taking place, for instance, the BRG is
reloaded when the SCL pin is sampled high.
If a Start, Restart, Stop or Acknowledge condition was
in progress when the bus collision occurred, the condition is aborted, the SDA and SCL lines are deasserted
and the respective control bits in the I2CCON register
are cleared to ‘0’. When the user services the bus
collision Interrupt Service Routine, and if the I2C bus is
free, the user can resume communication by asserting
a Start condition.
As per the I2C standard, FSCK may be 100 kHz or
400 kHz. However, the user can specify any baud rate
up to 1 MHz. I2CBRG values of ‘0’ or ‘1’ are illegal.
The Master will continue to monitor the SDA and SCL
pins, and if a Stop condition occurs, the MI2CIF bit will
be set.
EQUATION 17-1:
A write to the I2CTRN will start the transmission of data
at the first data bit, regardless of where the transmitter
left off when bus collision occurred.
17.12.3
BAUD RATE GENERATOR (BRG)
I2CBRG =
17.12.4
I2CBRG VALUE
CY –
FCY
–1
( FFSCL
1,111,111 )
CLOCK ARBITRATION
Clock arbitration occurs when the master deasserts the
SCL pin (SCL allowed to float high) during any receive,
transmit or Restart/Stop condition. When the SCL pin is
allowed to float high, the Baud Rate Generator (BRG)
is suspended from counting until the SCL pin is actually
sampled high. When the SCL pin is sampled high, the
Baud Rate Generator is reloaded with the contents of
I2CBRG and begins counting. This ensures that the
SCL high time will always be at least one BRG rollover
count in the event that the clock is held low by an
external device.
17.12.5
MULTI-MASTER COMMUNICATION,
BUS COLLISION AND BUS
ARBITRATION
Multi-master operation support is achieved by bus
arbitration. When the master outputs address/data bits
onto the SDA pin, arbitration takes place when the
master outputs a ‘1’ on SDA, by letting SDA float high,
while another master asserts a ‘0’. When the SCL pin
floats high, data should be stable. If the expected data
on SDA is a ‘1’ and the data sampled on the SDA
pin = 0, then a bus collision has taken place. The
master will set the MI2CIF pulse and reset the master
portion of the I2C port to its Idle state.
DS70135E-page 112
In a Multi-Master environment, the interrupt generation
on the detection of Start and Stop conditions allows the
determination of when the bus is free. Control of the I2C
bus can be taken when the P bit is set in the I2CSTAT
register, or the bus is Idle and the S and P bits are
cleared.
17.13 I2C Module Operation During CPU
Sleep and Idle Modes
17.13.1
I2C OPERATION DURING CPU
SLEEP MODE
When the device enters Sleep mode, all clock sources
to the module are shut down and stay at logic ‘0’. If
Sleep occurs in the middle of a transmission, and the
state machine is partially into a transmission as the
clocks stop, then the transmission is aborted. Similarly,
if Sleep occurs in the middle of a reception, then the
reception is aborted.
17.13.2
I2C OPERATION DURING CPU IDLE
MODE
For the I2C, the I2CSIDL bit selects if the module will
stop on Idle or continue on Idle. If I2CSIDL = 0, the
module will continue operation on assertion of the Idle
mode. If I2CSIDL = 1, the module will stop on Idle.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 17-2:
SFR Name Addr.
I2C™ REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
I2CRCV
0200
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Receive Register
I2CTRN
0202
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Transmit Register
I2CBRG
0204
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
I2CCON
0206
I2CEN
—
A10M
DISSLW
SMEN
GCEN
STREN
ACKDT
ACKEN
RCEN
PEN
RSEN
SEN
0001 0000 0000 0000
I2CSTAT
0208
ACKSTAT
TRSTAT
—
—
—
BCL
GCSTAT
ADD10
IWCOL
I2COV
D_A
P
S
R_W
RBF
TBF
0000 0000 0000 0000
020A
—
—
—
—
—
—
I2CADD
I2CSIDL SCLREL IPMIEN
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 1111 1111
Baud Rate Generator
Legend:
u = uninitialized bit
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
Address Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 113
dsPIC30F4011/4012
NOTES:
DS70135E-page 114
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
18.0
UNIVERSAL ASYNCHRONOUS
RECEIVER TRANSMITTER
(UART) MODULE
18.1
The key features of the UART module are:
•
•
•
•
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
•
This section describes the Universal Asynchronous
Receiver/Transmitter communications module.
•
•
•
•
•
•
FIGURE 18-1:
UART Module Overview
Full-Duplex, 8 or 9-bit Data Communication
Even, Odd or No Parity Options (for 8-bit data)
One or Two Stop bits
Fully Integrated Baud Rate Generator with
16-bit Prescaler
Baud Rates ranging from 38 bps to 1.875 Mbps at
a 30 MHz Instruction Rate
4-Word Deep Transmit Data Buffer
4-Word Deep Receive Data Buffer
Parity, Framing and Buffer Overrun Error Detection
Support for Interrupt Only on Address Detect
(9th bit = 1)
Separate Transmit and Receive Interrupts
Loopback mode for Diagnostic Support
UART TRANSMITTER BLOCK DIAGRAM
Internal Data Bus
Control and Status bits
Write
UTX8
Write
UxTXREG Low Byte
Transmit Control
– Control TSR
– Control Buffer
– Generate Flags
– Generate Interrupt
Load TSR
UxTXIF
UTXBRK
Data
UxTX
Transmit Shift Register (UxTSR)
‘0’ (Start)
‘1’ (Stop)
Parity
Parity
Generator
16 Divider
16x Baud Clock
from Baud Rate
Generator
Control
Signals
Note: x = 1 or 2. dsPIC30F4012 only has UART1.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 115
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 18-2:
UART RECEIVER BLOCK DIAGRAM
Internal Data Bus
16
Write
Read
Read Read
UxMODE
URX8
Write
UxSTA
UxRXREG Low Byte
Receive Buffer Control
– Generate Flags
– Generate Interrupt
– Shift Data Characters
1
UxRX
Control
Signals
FERR
Load RSR
to Buffer
Receive Shift Register
(UxRSR)
From UxTX
PERR
8-9
LPBACK
0
· Start bit Detect
· Parity Check
· Stop bit Detect
· Shift Clock Generation
· Wake Logic
÷ 16 Divider
16x Baud Clock from
Baud Rate Generator
UxRXIF
DS70135E-page 116
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
18.2
18.2.1
Enabling and Setting Up UART
ENABLING THE UART
The UART module is enabled by setting the UARTEN
bit in the UxMODE register (where x = 1 or 2). Once
enabled, the UxTX and UxRX pins are configured as an
output and an input, respectively, overriding the TRIS
and LATCH register bit settings for the corresponding
I/O port pins. The UxTX pin is at logic ‘1’ when no
transmission is taking place.
18.2.2
18.3
18.3.1
Disabling the UART module resets the buffers to
empty states. Any data characters in the buffers are
lost and the baud rate counter is reset.
1.
2.
3.
4.
All error and status flags associated with the UART
module are reset when the module is disabled. The
URXDA, OERR, FERR, PERR, UTXEN, UTXBRK and
UTXBF bits are cleared, whereas RIDLE and TRMT
are set. Other control bits, including ADDEN,
URXISEL<1:0>, UTXISEL, as well as the UxMODE
and UxBRG registers, are not affected.
Clearing the UARTEN bit while the UART is active will
abort all pending transmissions and receptions and
reset the module as defined above. Re-enabling the
UART will restart the UART in the same configuration.
18.2.3
18.2.4
5.
Set up the UART:
First, the data length, parity and number of Stop
bits must be selected. Then, the transmit and
receive interrupt enable and priority bits are set
up in the UxMODE and UxSTA registers. Also,
the appropriate baud rate value must be written
to the UxBRG register.
Enable the UART by setting the UARTEN bit
(UxMODE<15>).
Set the UTXEN bit (UxSTA<10>), thereby
enabling a transmission.
Write the byte to be transmitted to the lower byte
of UxTXREG. The value will be transferred to the
Transmit Shift register (UxTSR) immediately
and the serial bit stream will start shifting out
during the next rising edge of the baud clock.
Alternatively, the data byte may be written while
UTXEN = 0, following which, the user may set
UTXEN. This will cause the serial bit stream to
begin immediately because the baud clock will
start from a cleared state.
A transmit interrupt will be generated depending
on the value of the interrupt control bit UTXISEL
(UxSTA<15>).
18.3.2
ALTERNATE I/O
The alternate I/O function is enabled by setting the
ALTIO bit (UxMODE<10>). If ALTIO = 1, the UxATX
and UxARX pins (alternate transmit and alternate
receive pins, respectively) are used by the UART module instead of the UxTX and UxRX pins. If ALTIO = 0,
the UxTX and UxRX pins are used by the UART
module.
SETTING UP DATA, PARITY AND
STOP BIT SELECTIONS
Control bits, PDSEL<1:0> in the UxMODE register, are
used to select the data length and parity used in the
transmission. The data length may either be 8 bits with
even, odd or no parity, or 9-bits with no parity.
The STSEL bit determines whether one or two Stop bits
will be used during data transmission.
The default (power-on) setting of the UART is 8 bits, no
parity and 1 Stop bit (typically represented as 8, N, 1).
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TRANSMITTING IN 8-BIT DATA
MODE
The following steps must be performed in order to
transmit 8-bit data:
DISABLING THE UART
The UART module is disabled by clearing the UARTEN
bit in the UxMODE register. This is the default state
after any Reset. If the UART is disabled, all I/O pins
operate as port pins under the control of the LATCH and
TRIS bits of the corresponding port pins.
Transmitting Data
TRANSMITTING IN 9-BIT DATA
MODE
The sequence of steps involved in the transmission of
9-bit data is similar to 8-bit transmission, except that a
16-bit data word (of which the upper 7 bits are always
clear) must be written to the UxTXREG register.
18.3.3
TRANSMIT BUFFER (UXTXB)
The transmit buffer is 9 bits wide and 4 characters
deep. Including the Transmit Shift register (UxTSR),
the user effectively has a 5-deep FIFO (First In First
Out) buffer. The UTXBF Status bit (UxSTA<9>)
indicates whether the transmit buffer is full.
If a user attempts to write to a full buffer, the new data
will not be accepted into the FIFO, and no data shift
will occur within the buffer. This enables recovery from
a buffer overrun condition.
The FIFO is reset during any device Reset, but is not
affected when the device enters or wakes up from a
power-saving mode.
DS70135E-page 117
dsPIC30F4011/4012
18.3.4
TRANSMIT INTERRUPT
The Transmit Interrupt Flag (U1TXIF or U2TXIF) is
located in the corresponding interrupt flag register.
The transmitter generates an edge to set the UxTXIF
bit. The condition for generating the interrupt depends
on UTXISEL control bit:
a)
b)
If UTXISEL = 0, an interrupt is generated when a
word is transferred from the transmit buffer to the
Transmit Shift register (UxTSR). This implies that
the transmit buffer has at least one empty word.
If UTXISEL = 1, an interrupt is generated when
a word is transferred from the transmit buffer to
the Transmit Shift register (UxTSR) and the
transmit buffer is empty.
Switching between the two interrupt modes during
operation is possible and sometimes offers more
flexibility.
18.3.5
TRANSMIT BREAK
Setting the UTXBRK bit (UxSTA<11>) will cause the
UxTX line to be driven to logic ‘0’. The UTXBRK bit
overrides all transmission activity. Therefore, the user
should generally wait for the transmitter to be Idle
before setting UTXBRK.
To send a Break character, the UTXBRK bit must be
set by software and must remain set for a minimum of
13 baud clock cycles. The UTXBRK bit is then cleared
by software to generate Stop bits. The user must wait
for a duration of at least one or two baud clock cycles
in order to ensure a valid Stop bit(s) before reloading
the UxTXB or starting other transmitter activity.
Transmission of a Break character does not generate
a transmit interrupt.
18.4
18.4.1
18.4.2
The receive buffer is 4 words deep. Including the
Receive Shift register (UxRSR), the user effectively
has a 5-word deep FIFO buffer.
URXDA (UxSTA<0>) = 1 indicates that the receive
buffer has data available. URXDA = 0 implies that the
buffer is empty. If a user attempts to read an empty
buffer, the old values in the buffer will be read and no
data shift will occur within the FIFO.
The FIFO is reset during any device Reset. It is not
affected when the device enters or wakes up from a
power-saving mode.
18.4.3
a)
b)
c)
If URXISEL<1:0> = 00 or 01, an interrupt is
generated every time a data word is transferred
from the Receive Shift register (UxRSR) to the
receive buffer. There may be one or more
characters in the receive buffer.
If URXISEL<1:0> = 10, an interrupt is generated
when a word is transferred from the Receive
Shift register (UxRSR) to the receive buffer
which, as a result of the transfer, contains
3 characters.
If URXISEL<1:0> = 11, an interrupt is set when
a word is transferred from the Receive Shift
register (UxRSR) to the receive buffer which, as
a result of the transfer, contains 4 characters
(i.e., becomes full).
Switching between the interrupt modes during operation is possible, though generally not advisable during
normal operation.
The following steps must be performed while receiving
8-bit or 9-bit data:
18.5
1.
18.5.1
2.
3.
4.
5.
Set up the UART (see Section 18.3.1
“Transmitting in 8-bit Data Mode”).
Enable the UART (see Section 18.3.1
“Transmitting in 8-bit Data Mode”).
A receive interrupt will be generated when one
or more data words have been received,
depending on the receive interrupt settings
specified by the URXISEL bits (UxSTA<7:6>).
Read the OERR bit to determine if an overrun
error has occurred. The OERR bit must be reset
in software.
Read the received data from UxRXREG. The act
of reading UxRXREG will move the next word to
the top of the receive FIFO and the PERR and
FERR values will be updated.
DS70135E-page 118
RECEIVE INTERRUPT
The Receive Interrupt Flag (U1RXIF or U2RXIF) can
be read from the corresponding interrupt flag register.
The interrupt flag is set by an edge generated by the
receiver. The condition for setting the receive interrupt
flag depends on the settings specified by the
URXISEL<1:0> (UxSTA<7:6>) control bits.
Receiving Data
RECEIVING IN 8-BIT OR 9-BIT DATA
MODE
RECEIVE BUFFER (UXRXB)
Reception Error Handling
RECEIVE BUFFER OVERRUN
ERROR (OERR BIT)
The OERR bit (UxSTA<1>) is set if all of the following
conditions occur:
a)
b)
c)
The receive buffer is full.
The Receive Shift register is full, but unable to
transfer the character to the receive buffer.
The Stop bit of the character in the UxRSR is
detected, indicating that the UxRSR needs to
transfer the character to the buffer.
Once OERR is set, no further data is shifted in UxRSR
(until the OERR bit is cleared in software or a Reset
occurs). The data held in UxRSR and UxRXREG
remains valid.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
18.5.2
FRAMING ERROR (FERR)
The FERR bit (UxSTA<2>) is set if a ‘0’ is detected
instead of a Stop bit. If two Stop bits are selected, both
Stop bits must be ‘1’, otherwise FERR will be set. The
read-only FERR bit is buffered along with the received
data; it is cleared on any Reset.
18.5.3
PARITY ERROR (PERR)
The PERR bit (UxSTA<3>) is set if the parity of the
received word is incorrect. This error bit is applicable
only if a Parity mode (odd or even) is selected. The
read-only PERR bit is buffered along with the received
data bytes; it is cleared on any Reset.
18.5.4
IDLE STATUS
When the receiver is active (i.e., between the initial
detection of the Start bit and the completion of the Stop
bit), the RIDLE bit (UxSTA<4>) is ‘0’. Between the
completion of the Stop bit and detection of the next
Start bit, the RIDLE bit is ‘1’, indicating that the UART
is Idle.
18.5.5
RECEIVE BREAK
The receiver will count and expect a certain number
of bit times based on the values programmed in
the PDSEL<1:0> (UxMODE<2:1>) and STSEL
(UxMODE<0>) bits.
If the Break is longer than 13 bit times, the reception is
considered complete after the number of bit times
specified by PDSEL and STSEL. The URXDA bit is
set, FERR is set, zeros are loaded into the receive
FIFO, interrupts are generated, if appropriate and the
RIDLE bit is set.
When the module receives a long Break signal and the
receiver has detected the Start bit, the data bits and
the invalid Stop bit (which sets the FERR), the receiver
must wait for a valid Stop bit before looking for the next
Start bit. It cannot assume that the Break condition on
the line is the next Start bit.
Break is regarded as a character containing all ‘0’s,
with the FERR bit set. The Break character is loaded
into the buffer. No further reception can occur until a
Stop bit is received. Note that RIDLE goes high when
the Stop bit has not been received yet.
18.6
Address Detect Mode
Setting the ADDEN bit (UxSTA<5>) enables this
special mode in which a 9th bit (URX8) value of ‘1’
identifies the received word as an address, rather than
data. This mode is only applicable for 9-bit data
communication. The URXISELx control bit does not
have any impact on interrupt generation in this mode,
since an interrupt (if enabled) will be generated every
time the received word has the 9th bit set.
18.7
Loopback Mode
Setting the LPBACK bit enables this special mode in
which the UxTX pin is internally connected to the UxRX
pin. When configured for the Loopback mode, the
UxRX pin is disconnected from the internal UART
receive logic. However, the UxTX pin still functions as
in a normal operation.
To select this mode:
a)
b)
c)
Configure UART for desired mode of operation.
Set LPBACK = 1 to enable Loopback mode.
Enable transmission as defined in Section 18.3
“Transmitting Data”.
18.8
Baud Rate Generator
The UART has a 16-bit Baud Rate Generator to allow
maximum flexibility in baud rate generation. The Baud
Rate Generator register (UxBRG) is readable and
writable. The baud rate is computed as follows:
BRG = 16-bit value held in UxBRG register
(0 through 65535)
FCY = Instruction Clock Rate (1/TCY)
The baud rate is given by Equation 18-1.
EQUATION 18-1:
BAUD RATE
Baud Rate = FCY/(16 * (BRG + 1))
Therefore, maximum baud rate possible is:
FCY/16 (if BRG = 0),
and the minimum baud rate possible is:
FCY/(16 * 65536).
With a full, 16-bit Baud Rate Generator, at 30 MIPS
operation, the minimum baud rate achievable is
28.5 bps.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 119
dsPIC30F4011/4012
18.9
Auto-Baud Support
To allow the system to determine baud rates of
received characters, the input can be optionally linked
to a selected capture input (IC1 for UART1, IC2 for
UART2). To enable this mode, the user must program
the input capture module to detect the falling and rising
edges of the Start bit.
18.10.2
UART OPERATION DURING CPU
IDLE MODE
For the UART, the USIDL bit selects if the module will
stop operation when the device enters Idle mode, or
whether the module will continue on Idle. If USIDL = 0,
the module will continue operation during Idle mode. If
USIDL = 1, the module will stop on Idle.
18.10 UART Operation During CPU
Sleep and Idle Modes
18.10.1
UART OPERATION DURING CPU
SLEEP MODE
When the device enters Sleep mode, all clock sources
to the module are shut down and stay at logic ‘0’. If
entry into Sleep mode occurs while a transmission is
in progress, then the transmission is aborted. The
UxTX pin is driven to logic ‘1’. Similarly, if entry into
Sleep mode occurs while a reception is in progress,
then the reception is aborted. The UxSTA, UxMODE,
UxBRG, transmit and receive registers and buffers, are
not affected by Sleep mode.
If the WAKE bit (UxMODE<7>) is set before the device
enters Sleep mode, then a falling edge on the UxRX
pin will generate a receive interrupt. The Receive
Interrupt Select Mode bit (URXISEL) has no effect for
this function. If the receive interrupt is enabled, then
this will wake-up the device from Sleep. The UARTEN
bit must be set in order to generate a wake-up
interrupt.
DS70135E-page 120
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 18-1:
UART1 REGISTER MAP
SFR Name Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
—
ALTIO
U1MODE
020C
UARTEN
—
USIDL
—
U1STA
020E
UTXISEL
—
—
—
U1TXREG
0210
—
—
—
—
—
U1RXREG
0212
—
—
—
—
—
U1BRG
0214
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
WAKE
LPBACK
ABAUD
—
PERR
Bit 0
Reset State
—
—
—
UTX8
Transmit Register
0000 000u uuuu uuuu
—
—
URX8
Receive Register
PDSEL1 PDSEL0 STSEL 0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
FERR
OERR
URXDA 0000 0001 0001 0000
Baud Rate Generator Prescaler
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
Addr.
—
Bit 1
TRMT
URXISEL1 URXISEL0 ADDEN
RIDLE
Bit 2
—
u = uninitialized bit
SFR
Name
Bit 3
UTXBF
UTXBRK UTXEN
Legend:
TABLE 18-2:
Bit 4
0000 0000 0000 0000
UART2 REGISTER MAP (NOT AVAILABLE ON dsPIC30F4012)
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
—
—
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
WAKE
LPBACK
ABAUD
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
U2MODE
0216
UARTEN
—
USIDL
—
U2STA
0218
UTXISEL
—
—
—
U2TXREG
021A
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
UTX8
Transmit Register
0000 000u uuuu uuuu
U2RXREG
021C
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
URX8
Receive Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
U2BRG
021E
UTXBRK UTXEN
—
—
UTXBF
TRMT
URXISEL1 URXISEL0 ADDEN
Baud Rate Generator Prescaler
Legend:
u = uninitialized bit
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
—
—
RIDLE
PERR
PDSEL1 PDSEL0
FERR
OERR
STSEL 0000 0000 0000 0000
URXDA 0000 0001 0001 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 121
dsPIC30F4011/4012
NOTES:
DS70135E-page 122
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
19.0
CAN MODULE
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
19.1
Overview
The Controller Area Network (CAN) module is a serial
interface, useful for communicating with other CAN
modules or digital signal controller devices. This interface/protocol was designed to allow communications
within noisy environments. The dsPIC30F4011/4012
devices have 1 CAN module.
The CAN module is a communication controller implementing the CAN 2.0 A/B protocol, as defined in the
BOSCH specification. The module will support CAN 1.2,
CAN 2.0A, CAN2.0B Passive and CAN 2.0B Active
versions of the protocol. The module implementation is
a full CAN system. The CAN specification is not covered
within this data sheet. The reader may refer to the
BOSCH CAN specification for further details.
The module features are as follows:
• Implementation of the CAN protocol CAN 1.2,
CAN 2.0A and CAN 2.0B
• Standard and extended data frames
• 0-8 bytes data length
• Programmable bit rate up to 1 Mbit/sec
• Support for remote frames
• Double-buffered receiver with two prioritized
received message storage buffers (each buffer
may contain up to 8 bytes of data)
• 6 full (standard/extended identifier), acceptance
filters, 2 associated with the high priority receive
buffer and 4 associated with the low priority
receive buffer
• 2 full, acceptance filter masks, one each associated
with the high and low priority receive buffers
• Three transmit buffers with application specified
prioritization and abort capability (each buffer may
contain up to 8 bytes of data)
• Programmable wake-up functionality with
integrated low-pass filter
• Programmable Loopback mode supports self-test
operation
• Signaling via interrupt capabilities for all CAN
receiver and transmitter error states
• Programmable clock source
• Programmable link to input capture module (IC2,
for both CAN1 and CAN2) for time-stamping and
network synchronization
• Low-power Sleep and Idle mode
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
The CAN bus module consists of a protocol engine and
message buffering/control. The CAN protocol engine
handles all functions for receiving and transmitting
messages on the CAN bus. Messages are transmitted
by first loading the appropriate data registers. Status
and errors can be checked by reading the appropriate
registers. Any message detected on the CAN bus is
checked for errors and then matched against filters to
see if it should be received and stored in one of the
receive registers.
19.2
Frame Types
The CAN module transmits various types of frames
which include data messages or remote transmission
requests, initiated by the user, as other frames that are
automatically generated for control purposes. The
following frame types are supported:
19.2.1
STANDARD DATA FRAME
A standard data frame is generated by a node when the
node wishes to transmit data. It includes an 11-bit
Standard Identifier (SID) but not an 18-bit Extended
Identifier (EID).
19.2.2
EXTENDED DATA FRAME
An extended data frame is similar to a standard data
frame but includes an extended identifier as well.
19.2.3
REMOTE FRAME
It is possible for a destination node to request the data
from the source. For this purpose, the destination node
sends a remote frame with an identifier that matches
the identifier of the required data frame. The appropriate data source node will then send a data frame as a
response to this remote request.
19.2.4
ERROR FRAME
An error frame is generated by any node that detects a
bus error. An error frame consists of 2 fields: an error
flag field and an error delimiter field.
19.2.5
OVERLOAD FRAME
An overload frame can be generated by a node as a
result of 2 conditions. First, the node detects a dominant bit during interframe space which is an illegal
condition. Second, due to internal conditions, the node
is not yet able to start reception of the next message. A
node may generate a maximum of 2 sequential
overload frames to delay the start of the next message.
19.2.6
INTERFRAME SPACE
Interframe space separates a proceeding frame (of
whatever type) from a following data or remote frame.
DS70135E-page 123
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 19-1:
CAN BUFFERS AND PROTOCOL ENGINE BLOCK DIAGRAM
Acceptance Mask
RXM1(1)
BUFFERS
Acceptance Filter
RXF2(1)
TXERR
MESSAGE
TXLARB
TXREQ
TXABT
TXERR
TXB2(1)
MESSAGE
TXLARB
TXREQ
TXABT
TXB1(1)
MESSAGE
TXERR
TXLARB
TXREQ
TXABT
TXB0(1)
A
c
c
e
p
t
RXB0(1)
Message
Queue
Control
Transmit Byte Sequencer
Acceptance Mask
RXM0(1)
Acceptance Filter
RXF3(1)
Acceptance Filter
RXF0(1)
Acceptance Filter
RXF4(1)
Acceptance Filter
RXF1(1)
Acceptance Filter
RXF5(1)
Identifier
M
A
B
Data Field
RERRCNT
TERRCNT
ErrPas
BusOff
Transmit
Error
Counter
CRC Generator
RXB1(1)
Data Field
PROTOCOL
ENGINE
Receive Shift
Protocol
Finite
State
Machine
CRC Check
Transmit
Logic
C1TX
Note 1:
Identifier
Receive
Error
Counter
Transmit Shift
A
c
c
e
p
t
Bit
Timing
Logic
Bit Timing
Generator
C1RX
These are conceptual groups of registers, not SFR names by themselves.
DS70135E-page 124
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
19.3
Modes of Operation
The CAN module can operate in one of several
operation modes selected by the user. These modes
include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Initialization Mode
Disable Mode
Normal Operation Mode
Listen Only Mode
Loopback Mode
Error Recognition Mode
Modes are requested by setting the REQOP<2:0> bits
(C1CTRL<10:8>). Entry into a mode is acknowledged by
monitoring the OPMODE<2:0> bits (C1CTRL<7:5>). The
module will not change the mode and the OPMODE bits
until a change in mode is acceptable, generally during
bus Idle time which is defined as at least 11 consecutive
recessive bits.
19.3.1
INITIALIZATION MODE
In the Initialization mode, the module will not transmit or
receive. The error counters are cleared and the interrupt flags remain unchanged. The programmer will
have access to Configuration registers that are access
restricted in other modes. The module will protect the
user from accidentally violating the CAN protocol
through programming errors. All registers which control
the configuration of the module can not be modified
while the module is online. The CAN module will not be
allowed to enter the Configuration mode while a
transmission is taking place. The Configuration mode
serves as a lock to protect the following registers.
•
•
•
•
•
All Module Control Registers
Baud Rate and Interrupt Configuration Registers
Bus Timing Registers
Identifier Acceptance Filter Registers
Identifier Acceptance Mask Registers
19.3.2
DISABLE MODE
In Disable mode, the module will not transmit or
receive. The module has the ability to set the WAKIF bit
due to bus activity, however, any pending interrupts will
remain and the error counters will retain their value.
If the REQOP<2:0> bits (C1CTRL<10:8>) = 001, the
module will enter the Disable mode. If the module is
active, the module will wait for 11 recessive bits on the
CAN bus, detect that condition as an Idle bus, then
accept
the
disable
command.
When
the
OPMODE<2:0> bits (C1CTRL<7:5>) = 001, that
indicates whether the module successfully went into
Disable mode. The I/O pins will revert to normal I/O
function when the module is in the Disable mode.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
The module can be programmed to apply a low-pass
filter function to the C1RX input line while the module
or the CPU is in Sleep mode. The WAKFIL bit
(C1CFG2<14>) enables or disables the filter.
Note:
19.3.3
Typically, if the CAN module is allowed to
transmit in a particular mode of operation
and a transmission is requested immediately after the CAN module has been
placed in that mode of operation, the
module waits for 11 consecutive recessive
bits on the bus before starting transmission.
If the user switches to Disable mode within
this 11-bit period, then this transmission is
aborted and the corresponding TXABT bit is
set and TXREQ bit is cleared.
NORMAL OPERATION MODE
Normal Operation mode is selected when
REQOP<2:0> = 000. In this mode, the module is
activated and the I/O pins will assume the CAN bus
functions. The module will transmit and receive CAN
bus messages via the C1TX and C1RX pins.
19.3.4
LISTEN ONLY MODE
If the Listen Only mode is activated, the module on the
CAN bus is passive. The transmitter buffers revert to
the port I/O function. The receive pins remain inputs.
For the receiver, no error flags or Acknowledge signals
are sent. The error counters are deactivated in this
state. The Listen Only mode can be used for detecting
the baud rate on the CAN bus. To use this, it is necessary that there are at least two further nodes that
communicate with each other.
19.3.5
ERROR RECOGNITION MODE
The module can be set to ignore all errors and receive
any message. In this mode, the data which is in the
message assembly buffer until the time an error
occurred, is copied in the receive buffer and can be
read via the CPU interface.
19.3.6
LOOPBACK MODE
If the Loopback mode is activated, the module will
connect the internal transmit signal to the internal
receive signal at the module boundary. The transmit
and receive pins revert to their port I/O function.
DS70135E-page 125
dsPIC30F4011/4012
19.4
19.4.1
Message Reception
RECEIVE BUFFERS
The CAN bus module has 3 receive buffers. However,
one of the receive buffers is always committed to monitoring the bus for incoming messages. This buffer is
called the message assembly buffer (MAB). There are
two receive buffers, visibly denoted as RXB0 and
RXB1, that can essentially instantaneously receive a
complete message from the protocol engine.
All messages are assembled by the MAB, and are
transferred to the RXBn buffers only if the acceptance
filter criterion is met. When a message is received, the
RXxIF flag (C1INTF<0> or C1INIF<1>) will be set. This
bit can only be set by the module when a message is
received. The bit is cleared by the CPU when it has
completed processing the message in the buffer. If the
RXxIE bit (C1INTE<0> or C1INTE<1>) is set, an
interrupt will be generated when a message is
received.
RXF0 and RXF1 filters with the RXM0 mask are
associated with RXB0. The filters, RXF2, RXF3, RXF4
and RXF5, and the mask, RXM1, are associated with
RXB1.
19.4.2
MESSAGE ACCEPTANCE FILTERS
The message acceptance filters and masks are used to
determine if a message in the message assembly
buffer should be loaded into either of the receive buffers. Once a valid message has been received into the
Message Assembly Buffer (MAB), the identifier fields of
the message are compared to the filter values. If there
is a match, that message will be loaded into the
appropriate receive buffer.
The acceptance filter looks at incoming messages for
the RXIDE bit (CiRXnSID<0>) to determine how to
compare the identifiers. If the RXIDE bit is clear, the
message is a standard frame and only filters with the
EXIDE bit (C1RXFxSID<0>) clear are compared. If the
RXIDE bit is set, the message is an extended frame
and only filters with the EXIDE bit set are compared.
19.4.3
MESSAGE ACCEPTANCE FILTER
MASKS
The mask bits essentially determine which bits to apply
the filter to. If any mask bit is set to a zero, then that bit
will automatically be accepted regardless of the filter
bit. There are 2 programmable acceptance filter masks
associated with the receive buffers, one for each buffer.
19.4.4
RECEIVE OVERRUN
An overrun condition occurs when the Message
Assembly Buffer (MAB) has assembled a valid
received message, the message is accepted through
the acceptance filters, and when the receive buffer
associated with the filter has not been designated as
clear of the previous message.
The overrun error flag, RXxOVR (C1INTF<15> or
C1INTF<14>) and the ERRIF bit (C1INTF<5>) will be
set and the message in the MAB will be discarded.
If the DBEN bit is clear, RXB1 and RXB0 operate independently. When this is the case, a message intended
for RXB0 will not be diverted into RXB1 if RXB0
contains an unread message and the RX0OVR bit will
be set.
If the DBEN bit is set, the overrun for RXB0 is handled
differently. If a valid message is received for RXB0 and
RXFUL = 1, it indicates that RXB0 is full and
RXFUL = 0 indicates that RXB1 is empty, the message
for RXB0 will be loaded into RXB1. An overrun error will
not be generated for RXB0. If a valid message is
received for RXB0 and RXFUL = 1, and RXFUL = 1
indicates that both RXB0 and RXB1 are full, the
message will be lost and an overrun will be indicated
for RXB1.
19.4.5
RECEIVE ERRORS
The CAN module will detect the following receive
errors:
• Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC) Error
• Bit Stuffing Error
• Invalid Message Receive Error
These receive errors do not generate an interrupt.
However, the receive error counter is incremented by
one in case one of these errors occur. The RXWAR bit
(C1INTF<9>) indicates that the receive error counter
has reached the CPU warning limit of 96 and an
interrupt is generated.
19.4.6
RECEIVE INTERRUPTS
Receive interrupts can be divided into 3 major groups,
each including various conditions that generate
interrupts:
19.4.6.1
Receive Interrupt
A message has been successfully received and loaded
into one of the receive buffers. This interrupt is activated immediately after receiving the End-of-Frame
(EOF) field. Reading the RXxIF flag will indicate which
receive buffer caused the interrupt.
19.4.6.2
Wake-up Interrupt
The CAN module has woken up from Disable mode or
the device has woken up from Sleep mode.
DS70135E-page 126
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
19.4.6.3
Receive Error Interrupts
A receive error interrupt will be indicated by the ERRIF
bit. This bit shows that an error condition occurred. The
source of the error can be determined by checking the
bits in the CAN Interrupt Status register, C1INTF.
• Invalid message received.
• If any type of error occurred during reception of
the last message, an error will be indicated by the
IVRIF bit.
• Receiver overrun.
• The RXxOVR bit indicates that an overrun
condition occurred.
• Receiver warning.
• The RXWAR bit indicates that the Receive Error
Counter (RERRCNT<7:0>) has reached the
warning limit of 96.
• Receiver error passive.
• The RXEP bit indicates that the Receive Error
Counter has exceeded the error passive limit
of 127 and the module has gone into error passive
state.
19.5
19.5.1
Message Transmission
TRANSMIT BUFFERS
The CAN module has three transmit buffers. Each of
the three buffers occupies 14 bytes of data. Eight of the
bytes are the maximum 8 bytes of the transmitted message. Five bytes hold the standard and extended
identifiers and other message arbitration information.
19.5.2
TRANSMIT MESSAGE PRIORITY
Transmit priority is a prioritization within each node of the
pending transmittable messages. There are 4 levels of
transmit priority. If TXPRI<1:0> (C1TXxCON<1:0>, where
x = 0, 1 or 2, represents a particular transmit buffer) for a
particular message buffer is set to ‘11’, that buffer has the
highest priority. If TXPRI<1:0> for a particular message
buffer is set to ‘10’ or ‘01’, that buffer has an intermediate
priority. If TXPRI<1:0> for a particular message buffer is
‘00’, that buffer has the lowest priority.
19.5.3
TRANSMISSION SEQUENCE
To initiate transmission of the message, the TXREQ bit
(C1TXxCON<3>) must be set. The CAN bus module
resolves any timing conflicts between setting of the
TXREQ bit and the Start-of-Frame (SOF), ensuring
that if the priority was changed, it is resolved correctly
before the SOF occurs. When TXREQ is set, the
TXABT (C1TXxCON<6>), TXLARB (C1TXxCON<5>)
and TXERR (C1TXxCON<4>) flag bits are
automatically cleared.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Setting TXREQ bit simply flags a message buffer as
enqueued for transmission. When the module detects
an available bus, it begins transmitting the message
which has been determined to have the highest priority.
If the transmission completes successfully on the first
attempt, the TXREQ bit is cleared automatically and an
interrupt is generated if TXxIE was set.
If the message transmission fails, one of the error
condition flags will be set and the TXREQ bit will
remain set, indicating that the message is still pending
for transmission. If the message encountered an error
condition during the transmission attempt, the TXERR
bit will be set and the error condition may cause an
interrupt. If the message loses arbitration during the
transmission attempt, the TXLARB bit is set. No
interrupt is generated to signal the loss of arbitration.
19.5.4
ABORTING MESSAGE
TRANSMISSION
The system can also abort a message by clearing the
TXREQ bit associated with each message buffer. Setting the ABAT bit (C1CTRL<12>) will request an abort
of all pending messages. If the message has not yet
started transmission, or if the message started but is
interrupted by loss of arbitration or an error, the abort
will be processed. The abort is indicated when the
module sets the TXABT bit, and the TXxIF flag is not
automatically set.
19.5.5
TRANSMISSION ERRORS
The CAN module will detect the following transmission
errors:
• Acknowledge Error
• Form Error
• Bit Error
These transmission errors will not necessarily generate
an interrupt but are indicated by the transmission error
counter. However, each of these errors will cause the
transmission error counter to be incremented by one.
Once the value of the error counter exceeds the value
of 96, the ERRIF (C1INTF<5>) and the TXWAR bit
(C1INTF<10>) are set. Once the value of the error
counter exceeds the value of 96, an interrupt is
generated and the TXWAR bit in the error flag register
is set.
DS70135E-page 127
dsPIC30F4011/4012
19.5.6
TRANSMIT INTERRUPTS
19.6
Baud Rate Setting
Transmit interrupts can be divided into 2 major groups,
each including various conditions that generate
interrupts:
All nodes on any particular CAN bus must have the
same nominal bit rate. In order to set the baud rate, the
following parameters have to be initialized:
• Transmit Interrupt
•
•
•
•
•
•
At least one of the three transmit buffers is empty (not
scheduled) and can be loaded to schedule a message
for transmission. Reading the TXxIF flags will indicate
which transmit buffer is available and caused the
interrupt.
• Transmit Error Interrupts
A transmission error interrupt will be indicated by the
ERRIF flag. This flag shows that an error condition
occurred. The source of the error can be determined by
checking the error flags in the CAN Interrupt Status register, C1INTF. The flags in this register are related to
receive and transmit errors.
• Transmitter warning interrupt.
• The TXWAR bit indicates that the Transmit Error
Counter has reached the CPU warning limit of 96.
• Transmitter error passive.
• The TXEP bit (C1INTF<12>) indicates that the
Transmit Error Counter has exceeded the error
passive limit of 127 and the module has gone to
error passive state.
• Bus off.
• The TXBO bit (C1INTF<13>) indicates that the
Transmit Error Counter (TERRCNT<7:0>) has
exceeded 255 and the module has gone to bus off
state.
FIGURE 19-2:
Synchronization Jump Width
Baud Rate Prescaler
Phase Segments
Length Determination of Phase2 Seg
Sample Point
Propagation Segment Bits
19.6.1
BIT TIMING
All controllers on the CAN bus must have the same
baud rate and bit length. However, different controllers
are not required to have the same master oscillator
clock. At different clock frequencies of the individual
controllers, the baud rate has to be adjusted by
adjusting the number of time quanta in each segment.
The nominal bit time can be thought of as being divided
into separate non-overlapping time segments. These
segments are shown in Figure 19-2.
•
•
•
•
Synchronization segment (Sync Seg)
Propagation time segment (Prop Seg)
Phase segment 1 (Phase1 Seg)
Phase segment 2 (Phase2 Seg)
The time segments and also the nominal bit time are
made up of integer units of time called time quanta or
TQ. By definition, the nominal bit time has a minimum
of 8 TQ and a maximum of 25 TQ. Also, by definition,
the minimum nominal bit time is 1 μsec, corresponding
to a maximum bit rate of 1 MHz.
CAN BIT TIMING
Input Signal
Sync
Prop
Segment
Phase
Segment 1
Phase
Segment 2
Sync
Sample Point
TQ
DS70135E-page 128
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
19.6.2
PRESCALER SETTING
There is a programmable prescaler with integral values
ranging from 1 to 64 in addition to a fixed divide-by-2 for
clock generation. The Time Quantum (TQ) is a fixed
unit of time derived from the oscillator period, shown in
Equation 19-1, where FCAN is FCY (if the CANCKS bit
is set) or 4 FCY (if CANCKS is cleared).
Note:
FCAN must not exceed 30 MHz. If
CANCKS = 0, then FCY must not exceed
7.5 MHz.
EQUATION 19-1:
TIME QUANTUM FOR
CLOCK GENERATION
TQ = 2 (BRP<5:0> + 1)/FCAN
19.6.3
PROPAGATION SEGMENT
This part of the bit time is used to compensate physical
delay times within the network. These delay times consist of the signal propagation time on the bus line and
the internal delay time of the nodes. The propagation
segment can be programmed from 1 TQ to 8 TQ by
setting the PRSEG<2:0> bits (C1CFG2<2:0>).
19.6.4
PHASE SEGMENTS
The phase segments are used to optimally locate the
sampling of the received bit within the transmitted bit
time. The sampling point is between Phase1 Seg and
Phase2 Seg. These segments are lengthened or shortened by resynchronization. The end of the Phase1 Seg
determines the sampling point within a bit period. The
segment is programmable from 1 TQ to 8 TQ. Phase2
Seg provides delay to the next transmitted data transition. The segment is programmable from 1 TQ to 8 TQ,
or it may be defined to be equal to the greater of
Phase1 Seg or the information processing time (2 TQ).
The Phase1 Seg is initialized by setting bits
SEG1PH<2:0> (C1CFG2<5:3>), and Phase2 Seg is
initialized by setting SEG2PH<2:0> (C1CFG2<10:8>).
The following requirement must be fulfilled while setting
the lengths of the phase segments:
Propagation Segment + Phase1 Seg > = Phase2 Seg
19.6.5
SAMPLE POINT
The sample point is the point of time at which the bus
level is read and interpreted as the value of that respective bit. The location is at the end of Phase1 Seg. If the bit
timing is slow and contains many TQ, it is possible to
specify multiple sampling of the bus line at the sample
point. The level determined by the CAN bus then corresponds to the result from the majority decision of three
values. The majority samples are taken at the sample
point and twice before with a distance of TQ/2. The CAN
module allows the user to choose between sampling
three times at the same point, or once at the same point,
by setting or clearing the SAM bit (C1CFG2<6>).
Typically, the sampling of the bit should take place at
about 60-70% through the bit time depending on the
system parameters.
19.6.6
SYNCHRONIZATION
To compensate for phase shifts between the oscillator
frequencies of the different bus stations, each CAN
controller must be able to synchronize to the relevant
signal edge of the incoming signal. When an edge in
the transmitted data is detected, the logic will compare
the location of the edge to the expected time
(synchronous segment). The circuit will then adjust the
values of Phase1 Seg and Phase2 Seg. There are
2 mechanisms used to synchronize.
19.6.6.1
Hard Synchronization
Hard synchronization is only done whenever there is a
‘recessive’ to ‘dominant’ edge during bus Idle, indicating
the start of a message. After hard synchronization, the
bit time counters are restarted with the synchronous
segment. Hard synchronization forces the edge which
has caused the hard synchronization to lie within the
synchronization segment of the restarted bit time. If a
hard synchronization is done, there will not be a
resynchronization within that bit time.
19.6.6.2
Resynchronization
As a result of resynchronization, Phase1 Seg may be
lengthened or Phase2 Seg may be shortened. The
amount of lengthening or shortening of the phase buffer
segment has an upper bound known as the
synchronization jump width, and is specified by the
SJW<1:0> bits (C1CFG1<7:6>). The value of the
synchronization jump width will be added to Phase1 Seg
or subtracted from Phase2 Seg. The resynchronization
jump width is programmable between 1 TQ and 4 TQ.
The following requirement must be fulfilled while setting
the SJW<1:0> bits:
Phase2 Seg > Synchronization Jump Width
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 129
CAN1 REGISTER MAP
SFR Name
Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
C1RXF0SID
0300
—
—
—
C1RXF0EIDH
0302
—
—
—
C1RXF0EIDL
0304
Bit 11
Bit 10
0308
—
—
—
C1RXF1EIDH
030A
—
—
—
C1RXF1EIDL
030C
—
0310
—
—
—
C1RXF2EIDH
0312
—
—
—
C1RXF2EIDL
0314
0318
—
—
—
C1RXF3EIDH
031A
—
—
—
C1RXF3EIDL
031C
0320
—
—
—
C1RXF4EIDH
0322
—
—
—
C1RXF4EIDL
0324
0328
—
—
—
C1RXF5EIDH
032A
—
—
—
C1RXF5EIDL
032C
C1RXM0SID
0330
—
—
—
C1RXM0EIDH 0332
—
—
—
C1RXM0EIDL
0334
0338
—
—
—
C1RXM1EIDH 033A
—
—
—
—
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Bit 0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
—
—
—
—
—
EXIDE 000u uuuu uuuu uu0u
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
Receive Acceptance Filter 4 Standard Identifier<10:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
Receive Acceptance Filter 5 Standard Identifier<10:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
Receive Acceptance Mask 0 Standard Identifier<10:0>
—
—
—
—
MIDE
Receive Acceptance Mask 0 Extended Identifier<17:6>
Receive Acceptance Mask 0 Extended Identifier<5:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
MIDE
Receive Acceptance Mask 1 Extended Identifier<17:6>
Receive Acceptance Mask 1 Extended Identifier<5:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
000u uuuu uuuu uu0u
uuuu uu00 0000 0000
000u uuuu uuuu uu0u
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
—
—
uuuu uu00 0000 0000
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
C1TX2SID
0340
C1TX2EID
0342 Transmit Buffer 2 Extended Identifier<17:14>
C1TX2DLC
0344
Transmit Buffer 2 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1TX2B1
0346
Transmit Buffer 2 Byte 1
Transmit Buffer 2 Byte 0
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1TX2B2
0348
Transmit Buffer 2 Byte 3
Transmit Buffer 2 Byte 2
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1TX2B3
034A
Transmit Buffer 2 Byte 5
Transmit Buffer 2 Byte 4
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1TX2B4
034C
Transmit Buffer 2 Byte 7
Transmit Buffer 2 Byte 6
C1TX2CON
034E
C1TX1SID
0350
C1TX1EID
0352 Transmit Buffer 1 Extended Identifier<17:14>
C1TX1DLC
0354
Legend:
Note:
Transmit Buffer 2 Standard Identifier<10:6>
uuuu uu00 0000 0000
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
Receive Acceptance Mask 1 Standard Identifier<10:0>
—
uuuu uu00 0000 0000
EXIDE 000u uuuu uuuu uu0u
Receive Acceptance Filter 5 Extended Identifier<17:6>
—
uuuu uu00 0000 0000
EXIDE 000u uuuu uuuu uu0u
Receive Acceptance Filter 4 Extended Identifier<17:6>
—
uuuu uu00 0000 0000
EXIDE 000u uuuu uuuu uu0u
Receive Acceptance Filter 3 Extended Identifier<17:6>
—
uuuu uu00 0000 0000
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
Receive Acceptance Filter 3 Standard Identifier<10:0>
—
uuuu uu00 0000 0000
EXIDE 000u uuuu uuuu uu0u
Receive Acceptance Filter 2 Extended Identifier<17:6>
—
Reset State
EXIDE 000u uuuu uuuu uu0u
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
Receive Acceptance Filter 2 Standard Identifier<10:0>
—
Receive Acceptance Filter 5 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1RXM1SID
Bit 6
Receive Acceptance Filter 1 Extended Identifier<17:6>
Receive Acceptance Filter 4 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1RXF5SID
Bit 7
Receive Acceptance Filter 1 Standard Identifier<10:0>
Receive Acceptance Filter 3 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1RXF4SID
—
—
Receive Acceptance Filter 2 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1RXF3SID
Bit 8
Receive Acceptance Filter 0 Extended Identifier<17:6>
Receive Acceptance Filter 1 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1RXF2SID
Bit 9
Receive Acceptance Filter 0 Standard Identifier<10:0>
Receive Acceptance Filter 0 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1RXF1SID
C1RXM1EIDL 033C
Bit 12
—
—
—
—
—
—
Transmit Buffer 1 Standard Identifier<10:6>
—
Transmit Buffer 1 Extended Identifier<5:0>
—
—
TXRTR TXRB1
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TXRTR TXRB1
Transmit Buffer 2 Standard Identifier<5:0>
SRR
TXIDE uuuu u000 uuuu uuuu
Transmit Buffer 2 Extended Identifier<13:6>
TXRB0
—
DLC<3:0>
TXABT TXLARB TXERR
—
TXREQ
uuuu 0000 uuuu uuuu
—
—
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
Transmit Buffer 1 Standard Identifier<5:0>
TXPRI<1:0>
SRR
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
DLC<3:0>
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
TXIDE uuuu u000 uuuu uuuu
Transmit Buffer 1 Extended Identifier<13:6>
TXRB0
uuuu uuuu uuuu u000
uuuu 0000 uuuu uuuu
—
—
uuuu uuuu uuuu u000
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 130
TABLE 19-1:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 19-1:
SFR Name
Addr.
CAN1 REGISTER MAP (CONTINUED)
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
C1TX1B1
0356
Transmit Buffer 1 Byte 1
Transmit Buffer 1 Byte 0
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1TX1B2
0358
Transmit Buffer 1 Byte 3
Transmit Buffer 1 Byte 2
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1TX1B3
035A
Transmit Buffer 1 Byte 5
Transmit Buffer 1 Byte 4
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1TX1B4
035C
Transmit Buffer 1 Byte 7
Transmit Buffer 1 Byte 6
C1TX1CON
035E
C1TX0SID
0360
C1TX0EID
0362 Transmit Buffer 0 Extended Identifier<17:14>
C1TX0DLC
0364
Transmit Buffer 0 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1TX0B1
0366
Transmit Buffer 0 Byte 1
Transmit Buffer 0 Byte 0
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1TX0B2
0368
Transmit Buffer 0 Byte 3
Transmit Buffer 0 Byte 2
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1TX0B3
036A
Transmit Buffer 0 Byte 5
Transmit Buffer 0 Byte 4
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1TX0B4
036C
Transmit Buffer 0 Byte 7
Transmit Buffer 0 Byte 6
C1TX0CON
036E
—
—
—
C1RX1SID
0370
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Transmit Buffer 0 Standard Identifier<10:6>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
TXREQ
—
TXPRI<1:0>
Transmit Buffer 0 Standard Identifier<5:0>
SRR
TXRB0
—
—
DLC<3:0>
TXABT TXLARB TXERR
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
TXIDE uuuu u000 uuuu uuuu
Transmit Buffer 0 Extended Identifier<13:6>
TXRTR TXRB1
—
TXABT TXLARB TXERR
uuuu 0000 uuuu uuuu
—
—
uuuu uuuu uuuu u000
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
TXREQ
—
TXPRI<1:0>
Receive Buffer 1 Standard Identifier<10:0>
SRR
0000 0000 0000 0000
RXIDE 000u uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1RX1EID
0372
C1RX1DLC
0374
Receive Buffer 1 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1RX1B1
0376
Receive Buffer 1 Byte 1
Receive Buffer 1 Byte 0
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
Receive Buffer 1 Extended Identifier<17:6>
RXRTR RXRB1
—
—
—
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
RXRB0
DLC<3:0>
uuuu uuuu 000u uuuu
C1RX1B2
0378
Receive Buffer 1 Byte 3
Receive Buffer 1 Byte 2
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1RX1B3
037A
Receive Buffer 1 Byte 5
Receive Buffer 1 Byte 4
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1RX1B4
037C
Receive Buffer 1 Byte 7
Receive Buffer 1 Byte 6
C1RX1CON
037E
—
—
—
C1RX0SID
0380
—
—
—
C1RX0EID
0382
—
—
—
C1RX0DLC
0384
Receive Buffer 0 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1RX0B1
0386
Receive Buffer 0 Byte 1
Receive Buffer 0 Byte 0
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
—
—
—
RXFUL
—
—
—
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
RXRTRRO
FILHIT<2:0>
Receive Buffer 0 Standard Identifier<10:0>
—
SRR
0000 0000 0000 0000
RXIDE 000u uuuu uuuu uuuu
Receive Buffer 0 Extended Identifier<17:6>
RXRTR RXRB1
—
—
—
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
RXRB0
DLC<3:0>
uuuu uuuu 000u uuuu
C1RX0B2
0388
Receive Buffer 0 Byte 3
Receive Buffer 0 Byte 2
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1RX0B3
038A
Receive Buffer 0 Byte 5
Receive Buffer 0 Byte 4
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1RX0B4
038C
Receive Buffer 0 Byte 7
Receive Buffer 0 Byte 6
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1RX0CON
038E
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RXFUL
—
—
DS70135E-page 131
C1CTRL
0390 CANCAP
—
CSIDL
ABAT
CANCKS
C1CFG1
0392
—
—
—
—
—
C1CFG2
0394
—
WAKFIL
—
—
—
SEG2PH<2:0>
SEG2PHTS
SAM
C1INTF
0396 RX0OVR RX1OVR
TXBO
TXEP
RXEP
TXWAR RXWAR EWARN
IVRIF
WAKIF
ERRIF
—
—
IVRIE
WAKIE
ERRIE
C1INTE
0398
C1EC
039A
Legend:
Note:
—
—
—
REQOP<2:0>
—
—
—
—
OPMODE<2:0>
—
—
RXRTRRO DBEN JTOFF FILHIT0 0000 0000 0000 0000
—
ICODE<2:0>
SJW<1:0>
—
TERRCNT<7:0>
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
—
BRP<5:0>
SEG1PH<2:0>
0000 0100 1000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
PRSEG<2:0>
0u00 0uuu uuuu uuuu
TX2IF
TX1IF
TX0IF RX1IF
RX0IF 0000 0000 0000 0000
TX2IE
TX1IE
TX0IE RX1IE
RX0IE 0000 0000 0000 0000
RERRCNT<7:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F4011/4012
—
dsPIC30F4011/4012
NOTES:
DS70135E-page 132
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
20.0
10-BIT, HIGH-SPEED
ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL
CONVERTER (ADC) MODULE
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
The 10-bit, high-speed Analog-to-Digital Converter
(ADC) allows conversion of an analog input signal to a
10-bit digital number. This module is based on a
Successive Approximation Register (SAR) architecture
and provides a maximum sampling rate of 1 Msps. The
ADC module has 16 analog inputs which are multiplexed into four sample and hold amplifiers. The output
of the sample and hold is the input into the converter
which generates the result. The analog reference
voltages are software selectable to either the device
supply voltage (AVDD/AVSS) or the voltage level on the
(VREF+/VREF-) pins. The ADC module has a unique
feature of being able to operate while the device is in
Sleep mode.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
The ADC module has six, 16-bit registers:
•
•
•
•
•
•
A/D Control Register 1 (ADCON1)
A/D Control Register 2 (ADCON2)
A/D Control Register 3 (ADCON3)
A/D Input Select Register (ADCHS)
A/D Port Configuration Register (ADPCFG)
A/D Input Scan Selection Register (ADCSSL)
The ADCON1, ADCON2 and ADCON3 registers
control the operation of the ADC module. The ADCHS
register selects the input channels to be converted. The
ADPCFG register configures the port pins as analog
inputs or as digital I/O. The ADCSSL register selects
inputs for scanning.
Note:
The SSRC<2:0>, ASAM, SIMSAM,
SMPI<3:0>, BUFM and ALTS bits, as well
as the ADCON3 and ADCSSL registers,
must not be written to while ADON = 1.
This would lead to indeterminate results.
The block diagram of the ADC module is shown in
Figure 20-1.
DS70135E-page 133
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 20-1:
10-BIT, HIGH-SPEED ADC FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAM
AVDD AVSS
VREF+
VREF-
AN2
+
AN6
-
AN1
AN4
+
AN7
-
S/H
CH1
ADC
10-bit Result
S/H
Conversion Logic
CH2
16-word, 10-bit
Dual Port
Buffer
AN2
AN5
+
AN8
-
S/H
CH3
CH1,CH2,
CH3,CH0
Sample
AN3
AN0
AN1
AN2
AN3
AN4
AN4
AN5
AN5
*AN6
AN6
*AN7
AN7
*AN8
AN8
+
AN1
-
Input
Switches
S/H
Sample/Sequence
Control
Bus Interface
AN1
AN0
AN3
Data
Format
AN0
Input MUX
Control
CH0
* Not available on dsPIC30F4012.
DS70135E-page 134
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
20.1
A/D Result Buffer
The module contains a 16-word, dual port, read-only
buffer, called ADCBUF0...ADCBUFF, to buffer the A/D
results. The RAM is 10 bits wide, but is read into different
format 16-bit words. The contents of the sixteen A/D
Conversion Result Buffer registers, ADCBUF0 through
ADCBUFF, cannot be written by user software.
20.2
Conversion Operation
After the ADC module has been configured, the sample
acquisition is started by setting the SAMP bit. Various
sources, such as a programmable bit, timer time-outs
and external events, terminate acquisition and start a
conversion. When the A/D conversion is complete, the
result is loaded into ADCBUF0...ADCBUFF, and the A/D
Interrupt Flag, ADIF, and the DONE bit are set after the
number of samples specified by the SMPI<3:0> bits.
The following steps should be followed for doing an
A/D conversion:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Configure the ADC module:
- Configure analog pins, voltage reference
and digital I/O
- Select A/D input channels
- Select A/D conversion clock
- Select A/D conversion trigger
- Turn on ADC module
Configure the A/D interrupt (if required):
- Clear ADIF bit
- Select A/D interrupt priority
Start sampling.
Wait the required acquisition time.
Trigger acquisition end, start conversion.
Wait for A/D conversion to complete by either:
- Waiting for the A/D interrupt
- Waiting for the DONE bit to get set
Read A/D result buffer, clear ADIF if required.
20.3
Selecting the Conversion
Sequence
Several groups of control bits select the sequence in
which the A/D connects inputs to the sample/hold
channels, converts channels, writes the buffer memory
and generates interrupts. The sequence is controlled
by the sampling clocks.
The SIMSAM bit controls the acquire/convert
sequence for multiple channels. If the SIMSAM bit is
‘0’, the two or four selected channels are acquired and
converted sequentially with two or four sample clocks.
If the SIMSAM bit is ‘1’, two or four selected channels
are acquired simultaneously with one sample clock.
The channels are then converted sequentially.
Obviously, if there is only 1 channel selected, the
SIMSAM bit is not applicable.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
The CHPS<1:0> bits select how many channels are
sampled. This selection can vary from 1, 2 or 4 channels.
If the CHPS bits select 1 channel, the CH0 channel is
sampled at the sample clock and converted. The result is
stored in the buffer. If the CHPS bits select 2 channels,
the CH0 and CH1 channels are sampled and converted.
If the CHPS bits select 4 channels, the CH0, CH1, CH2
and CH3 channels are sampled and converted.
The SMPI<3:0> bits select the number of acquisition/
conversion sequences that would be performed before
an interrupt occurs. This can vary from 1 sample per
interrupt to 16 samples per interrupt.
The user cannot program a combination of CHPS and
SMPI bits that specifies more than 16 conversions per
interrupt, or 8 conversions per interrupt, depending
on the BUFM bit. The BUFM bit, when set, splits the
16-word results buffer (ADCBUF0...ADCBUFF) into
two, 8-word groups. Writing to the 8-word buffers is
alternated on each interrupt event. Use of the BUFM bit
depends on how much time is available for moving data
out of the buffers after the interrupt, as determined by
the application.
If the processor can quickly unload a full buffer within
the time it takes to acquire and convert one channel,
the BUFM bit can be ‘0’ and up to 16 conversions
may be done per interrupt. The processor has one
sample-and-conversion time to move the sixteen
conversions.
If the processor cannot unload the buffer within the
acquisition and conversion time, the BUFM bit should be
‘1’. For example, if SMPI<3:0> (ADCON2<5:2>) = 0111,
then eight conversions are loaded into half of the buffer,
following which an interrupt occurs. The next eight
conversions are loaded into the other half of the buffer.
The processor has the entire time between interrupts to
move the eight conversions.
The ALTS bit can be used to alternate the inputs
selected during the sampling sequence. The input
multiplexer has two sets of sample inputs: MUX A and
MUX B. If the ALTS bit is ‘0’, only the MUX A inputs are
selected for sampling. If the ALTS bit is ‘1’ and
SMPI<3:0> = 0000, on the first sample/convert
sequence, the MUX A inputs are selected, and on the
next acquire/convert sequence, the MUX B inputs are
selected.
The CSCNA bit (ADCON2<10>) allows the CH0
channel inputs to be alternately scanned across a
selected number of analog inputs for the MUX A group.
The inputs are selected by the ADCSSL register. If a
particular bit in the ADCSSL register is ‘1’, the corresponding input is selected. The inputs are always
scanned from lower to higher numbered inputs, starting
after each interrupt. If the number of inputs selected is
greater than the number of samples taken per interrupt,
the higher numbered inputs are unused.
DS70135E-page 135
dsPIC30F4011/4012
20.4
Programming the Start of the
Conversion Trigger
The conversion trigger terminates acquisition and starts
the requested conversions.
The SSRC<2:0> bits select the source of the
conversion trigger.
The SSRC bits provide for up to 5 alternate sources of
conversion trigger.
When SSRC<2:0> = 000, the conversion trigger is
under software control. Clearing the SAMP bit causes
the conversion trigger.
When SSRC<2:0> = 111 (Auto-Start mode), the conversion trigger is under A/D clock control. The SAMC
bits select the number of A/D clocks between the start
of acquisition and the start of conversion. This provides
the fastest conversion rates on multiple channels.
SAMC must always be at least 1 clock cycle.
Other trigger sources can come from timer modules,
motor control PWM module or external interrupts.
Note:
To operate the ADC at the maximum
specified conversion speed, the autoconvert trigger option should be selected
(SSRC = 111) and the auto-sample
time bits should be set to ‘1’ TAD
(SAMC = 00001). This configuration gives
a total conversion period (sample + convert)
of 13 TAD.
The use of any other conversion trigger
results in additional TAD cycles to
synchronize the external event to the
ADC.
20.5
Aborting a Conversion
Clearing the ADON bit during a conversion aborts the
current conversion and stops the sampling sequencing.
The ADCBUFx is not updated with the partially completed A/D conversion sample. That is, the ADCBUFx
will continue to contain the value of the last completed
conversion (or the last value written to the ADCBUFx
register).
20.6
Selecting the A/D Conversion
Clock
The A/D conversion requires 12 TAD. The source of the
A/D conversion clock is software selected using a 6-bit
counter. There are 64 possible options for TAD.
EQUATION 20-1:
A/D CONVERSION CLOCK
TAD = TCY * (0.5 * (ADCS<5:0> + 1))
TAD
ADCS<5:0> = 2
–1
TCY
The internal RC oscillator is selected by setting the
ADRC bit.
For correct A/D conversions, the A/D conversion clock
(TAD) must be selected to ensure a minimum TAD time
of 83.33 nsec (for VDD = 5V). Refer to Section 24.0
“Electrical Characteristics” for minimum TAD under
other operating conditions.
Example 20-1 shows a sample calculation for the
ADCS<5:0> bits, assuming a device operating speed
of 30 MIPS.
EXAMPLE 20-1:
A/D CONVERSION CLOCK
CALCULATION
TAD = 154 nsec
TCY = 33 nsec (30 MIPS)
TAD
–1
TCY
154 nsec
=2•
–1
33 nsec
= 8.33
ADCS<5:0> = 2
Therefore,
Set ADCS<5:0> = 9
TCY
(ADCS<5:0> + 1)
2
33 nsec
=
(9 + 1)
2
Actual TAD =
= 165 nsec
If the clearing of the ADON bit coincides with an
auto-start, the clearing has a higher priority.
After the A/D conversion is aborted, a 2 TAD wait is
required before the next sampling may be started by
setting the SAMP bit.
If sequential sampling is specified, the A/D continues at
the next sample pulse, which corresponds with the next
channel converted. If simultaneous sampling is specified, the A/D continues with the next multichannel
group conversion sequence.
DS70135E-page 136
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
20.7
A/D Conversion Speeds
The dsPIC30F 10-bit ADC specifications permit
a maximum 1 Msps sampling rate. Table 20-1
summarizes the conversion speeds for the dsPIC30F
10-bit ADC and the required operating conditions.
TABLE 20-1:
10-BIT A/D CONVERSION RATE PARAMETERS
dsPIC30F 10-bit A/D Converter Conversion Rates
A/D Speed
Up to
1 Msps(1)
TAD
Sampling
RS Max.
Minimum Time Min.
83.33 ns
12 TAD
500Ω
VDD
Temperature
4.5V to 5.5V
-40°C to +85°C
A/D Channels Configuration
VREF- VREF+
CH1, CH2 or CH3
ANx
S/H
ADC
CH0
S/H
Up to
750 ksps(1)
95.24 ns
2 TAD
500Ω
4.5V to 5.5V
-40°C to +85°C
VREF- VREF+
CHX
ANx
S/H
Up to
600 ksps(1)
138.89 ns
12 TAD
500Ω
3.0V to 5.5V
ADC
-40°C to +125°C
VREF- VREF+
CH1, CH2 or CH3
ANx
S/H
CH0
ADC
S/H
Up to
500 ksps
153.85 ns
1 TAD
5.0 kΩ
4.5V to 5.5V
-40°C to +125°C
VREF- VREF+
or
or
AVSS AVDD
CHX
ANx
S/H
ADC
ANx or VREF-
Up to
300 ksps
256.41 ns
1 TAD
5.0 kΩ
3.0V to 5.5V
-40°C to +125°C
VREF- VREF+
or
or
AVSS AVDD
CHX
ANx
S/H
ADC
ANx or VREF-
Note 1:
External VREF- and VREF+ pins must be used for correct operation. See Figure 20-2 for recommended circuit.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 137
dsPIC30F4011/4012
The configuration guidelines give the required setup
values for the conversion speeds above 500 ksps, since
they require external VREF pins usage and there are
some differences in the configuration procedure. Configuration details that are not critical to the conversion
speed have been omitted.
FIGURE 20-2:
Figure 20-2 depicts the recommended circuit for the
conversion rates above 500 ksps.
A/D CONVERTER VOLTAGE REFERENCE SCHEMATIC
1
VDD
VSS
VDD
34
VDD
VSS
44
VDD
33
dsPIC30F4011
VSS
VDD
VDD
VREF+
VREF-
23
22
AVSS
AVDD
11
12
VDD
R2
10
VDD
C2
0.1 μF
1 Msps CONFIGURATION
GUIDELINE
Single Analog Input
For conversions at 1 Msps for a single analog input, at
least two sample and hold channels must be enabled.
The analog input multiplexer must be configured so
that the same input pin is connected to both sample
and hold channels. The A/D converts the value held on
one S/H channel while the second S/H channel
acquires a new input sample.
DS70135E-page 138
R1
10
VDD
C7
0.1 μF
VDD
C5
1 μF
C6
0.01 μF
VDD
C4
0.1 μF
C3
0.01 μF
C1
0.01 μF
The configuration for 1 Msps operation is dependent on
whether a single input pin is to be sampled or whether
multiple pins are to be sampled.
20.7.1.1
C8
1 μF
VDD
VDD
20.7.1
VDD
20.7.1.2
Multiple Analog Inputs
The ADC can also be used to sample multiple analog
inputs using multiple sample and hold channels. In this
case, the total 1 Msps conversion rate is divided among
the different input signals. For example, four inputs can
be sampled at a rate of 250 ksps for each signal, or two
inputs could be sampled at a rate of 500 ksps for each
signal. Sequential sampling must be used in this
configuration to allow adequate sampling time on each
input.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
20.7.1.3
1 Msps Configuration Items
The following configuration items are required to
achieve a 1 Msps conversion rate.
• Comply with conditions provided in Table 20-2
• Connect external VREF+ and VREF- pins following
the recommended circuit shown in Figure 20-2
• Set SSRC<2:0> = 111 in the ADCON1 register to
enable the auto-convert option
• Enable automatic sampling by setting the ASAM
control bit in the ADCON1 register
• Enable sequential sampling by clearing the
SIMSAM bit in the ADCON1 register
• Enable at least two sample and hold channels by
writing the CHPS<1:0> control bits in the
ADCON2 register
• Write the SMPI<3:0> control bits in the ADCON2
register for the desired number of conversions
between interrupts. At a minimum, set SMPI<3:0>
= 0001 since at least two sample and hold channels should be enabled
• Configure the A/D clock period to be:
1
= 83.33 ns
12 x 1,000,000
by writing to the ADCS<5:0> control bits in the
ADCON3 register
• Configure the sampling time to be 2 TAD by
writing: SAMC<4:0> = 00010
• Select at least two channels per analog input pin
by writing to the ADCHS register
20.7.2
750 ksps CONFIGURATION
GUIDELINE
The following configuration items are required to
achieve a 750 ksps conversion rate. This configuration
assumes that a single analog input is to be sampled.
• Comply with conditions provided in Table 20-2
• Connect external VREF+ and VREF- pins following
the recommended circuit shown in Figure 20-2
• Set SSRC<2:0> = 111 in the ADCON1 register to
enable the auto-convert option
• Enable automatic sampling by setting the ASAM
control bit in the ADCON1 register
• Enable one sample and hold channel by setting
CHPS<1:0> = 00 in the ADCON2 register
• Write the SMPI<3:0> control bits in the ADCON2
register for the desired number of conversions
between interrupts
• Configure the A/D clock period to be:
1
= 95.24 ns
(12 + 2) x 750,000
by writing to the ADCS<5:0> control bits in the
ADCON3 register
• Configure the sampling time to be 2 TAD by
writing: SAMC<4:0> = 00010
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
20.7.3
600 ksps CONFIGURATION
GUIDELINE
The configuration for 600 ksps operation is dependent
on whether a single input pin is to be sampled or
whether multiple pins are to be sampled.
20.7.3.1
Single Analog Input
When performing conversions at 600 ksps for a single
analog input, at least two sample and hold channels
must be enabled. The analog input multiplexer must be
configured so that the same input pin is connected to
both sample and hold channels. The ADC converts the
value held on one S/H channel, while the second S/H
channel acquires a new input sample.
20.7.3.2
Multiple Analog Input
The ADC can also be used to sample multiple analog
inputs using multiple sample and hold channels. In this
case, the total 600 ksps conversion rate is divided
among the different input signals. For example, four
inputs can be sampled at a rate of 150 ksps for each
signal or two inputs can be sampled at a rate of
300 ksps for each signal. Sequential sampling must be
used in this configuration to allow adequate sampling
time on each input.
20.7.3.3
600 ksps Configuration Items
The following configuration items are required to
achieve a 600 ksps conversion rate.
• Comply with conditions provided in Table 20-2
• Connect external VREF+ and VREF- pins following
the recommended circuit shown in Figure 20-2
• Set SSRC<2:0> = 111 in the ADCON1 register to
enable the auto-convert option
• Enable automatic sampling by setting the ASAM
control bit in the ADCON1 register
• Enable sequential sampling by clearing the
SIMSAM bit in the ADCON1 register
• Enable at least two sample and hold channels by
writing the CHPS<1:0> control bits in the
ADCON2 register
• Write the SMPI<3:0> control bits in the ADCON2
register for the desired number of conversions
between interrupts. At a minimum, set
SMPI<3:0> = 0001 since at least two sample and
hold channels should be enabled
• Configure the A/D clock period to be:
1
= 138.89 ns
12 x 600,000
by writing to the ADCS<5:0> control bits in the
ADCON3 register
• Configure the sampling time to be 2 TAD by
writing: SAMC<4:0> = 00010
Select at least two channels per analog input pin by
writing to the ADCHS register.
DS70135E-page 139
dsPIC30F4011/4012
20.8
A/D Acquisition Requirements
The analog input model of the 10-bit ADC is shown in
Figure 20-3. The total sampling time for the ADC is a
function of the internal amplifier settling time, device
VDD and the holding capacitor charge time.
For the ADC to meet its specified accuracy, the charge
holding capacitor (CHOLD) must be allowed to fully
charge to the voltage level on the analog input pin. The
source impedance (RS), the interconnect impedance
(RIC) and the internal sampling switch (RSS) impedance
combine to directly affect the time required to charge the
capacitor CHOLD. The combined impedance of the analog sources must therefore be small enough to fully
charge the holding capacitor within the chosen sample
time. To minimize the effects of pin leakage currents on
the accuracy of the ADC, the maximum recommended
source impedance, RS, is 5 kΩ. After the analog input
channel is selected (changed), this sampling function
must be completed prior to starting the conversion. The
internal holding capacitor will be in a discharged state
prior to each sample operation.
FIGURE 20-3:
The user must allow at least 1 TAD period of sampling
time, TSAMP, between conversions to allow each sample to be acquired. This sample time may be controlled
manually in software by setting/clearing the SAMP bit,
or it may be automatically controlled by the ADC. In an
automatic configuration, the user must allow enough
time between conversion triggers so that the minimum
sample time can be satisfied. Refer to Section 24.0
“Electrical Characteristics” for TAD and sample time
requirements.
A/D CONVERTER ANALOG INPUT MODEL
VDD
Rs
VA
ANx
CPIN
RIC ≤ 250Ω
VT = 0.6V
Sampling
Switch
RSS ≤ 3 kΩ
RSS
VT = 0.6V
ILEAKAGE
±500 nA
CHOLD
= DAC Capacitance
= 4.4 pF
VSS
Legend: CPIN
= Input Capacitance
= Threshold Voltage
VT
I leakage = Leakage Current at the pin due to
various junctions
= Interconnect Resistance
RIC
RSS
= Sampling Switch Resistance
= Sample/Hold Capacitance (from DAC)
CHOLD
Note: CPIN value depends on device package and is not tested. Effect of CPIN negligible if Rs ≤ 5 kΩ.
DS70135E-page 140
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
20.9
Module Power-Down Modes
If the A/D interrupt is enabled, the device wakes up
from Sleep. If the A/D interrupt is not enabled, the ADC
module is then turned off, although the ADON bit
remains set.
The module has 3 internal power modes. When the
ADON bit is ‘1’, the module is in Active mode; it is fully
powered and functional. When ADON is ‘0’, the module
is in Off mode. The digital and analog portions of the
circuit are disabled for maximum current savings. In
order to return to the Active mode from Off mode, the
user must wait for the ADC circuitry to stabilize.
20.10.2
The ADSIDL bit selects if the module stops on Idle or
continues on Idle. If ADSIDL = 0, the module continues
operation on assertion of Idle mode. If ADSIDL = 1, the
module stops on Idle.
20.10 A/D Operation During CPU Sleep
and Idle Modes
20.10.1
20.11 Effects of a Reset
A/D OPERATION DURING CPU
SLEEP MODE
A device Reset forces all registers to their Reset state.
This forces the ADC module to be turned off, and any
conversion and acquisition sequence is aborted. The
values that are in the ADCBUFx registers are not
modified. The A/D Result register contains unknown
data after a Power-on Reset.
When the device enters Sleep mode, all clock sources
to the module are shut down and stay at logic ‘0’.
If Sleep occurs in the middle of a conversion, the
conversion is aborted. The converter will not continue
with a partially completed conversion on exit from
Sleep mode.
20.12 Output Formats
Register contents are not affected by the device
entering or leaving Sleep mode.
The A/D result is 10 bits wide. The data buffer RAM is
also 10 bits wide. The 10-bit data can be read in one of
four different formats. The FORM<1:0> bits select the
format. Each of the output formats translates to a 16-bit
result on the data bus.
The ADC module can operate during Sleep mode if the
A/D clock source is set to RC (ADRC = 1). When the
RC clock source is selected, the ADC module waits
one instruction cycle before starting the conversion.
This allows the SLEEP instruction to be executed,
which eliminates all digital switching noise from the
conversion. When the conversion is complete, the
DONE bit is set and the result is loaded into the
ADCBUFx register.
FIGURE 20-4:
A/D OPERATION DURING CPU IDLE
MODE
Write data will always be in right justified (integer)
format.
A/D OUTPUT DATA FORMATS
RAM Contents:
d09 d08 d07 d06 d05 d04 d03 d02 d01 d00
Read to Bus:
Signed Fractional (1.15)
d09 d08 d07 d06 d05 d04 d03 d02 d01 d00
0
0
0
0
0
0
Fractional (1.15)
d09 d08 d07 d06 d05 d04 d03 d02 d01 d00
0
0
0
0
0
0
Signed Integer
Integer
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
d09 d09 d09 d09 d09 d09 d09 d08 d07 d06 d05 d04 d03 d02 d01 d00
0
0
0
0
0
0
d09 d08 d07 d06 d05 d04 d03 d02 d01 d00
DS70135E-page 141
dsPIC30F4011/4012
20.13 Configuring Analog Port Pins
20.14 Connection Considerations
The use of the ADPCFG and TRIS registers control the
operation of the ADC port pins. The port pins that are
desired as analog inputs must have their corresponding
TRIS bit set (input). If the TRIS bit is cleared (output), the
digital output level (VOH or VOL) is converted.
The analog inputs have diodes to VDD and VSS as ESD
protection. This requires that the analog input be
between VDD and VSS. If the input voltage exceeds this
range by greater than 0.3V (either direction), one of the
diodes becomes forward biased and it may damage the
device if the input current specification is exceeded.
The A/D operation is independent of the state of the
CH0SA<3:0>/CH0SB<3:0> bits and the TRIS bits.
When reading the PORT register, all pins configured as
analog input channels are read as cleared.
Pins configured as digital inputs will not convert an analog input. Analog levels on any pin that is defined as a
digital input (including the ANx pins), may cause the
input buffer to consume current that exceeds the
device specifications.
DS70135E-page 142
An external RC filter is sometimes added for antialiasing of the input signal. The R component should be
selected to ensure that the sampling time requirements
are satisfied. Any external components connected (via
high-impedance) to an analog input pin (capacitor,
zener diode, etc.) should have very little leakage
current at the pin.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 20-2:
SFR Name Addr.
ADC REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
0280
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 0
0000 00uu uuuu uuuu
0282
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 1
0000 00uu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF2
0284
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 2
0000 00uu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF3
0286
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 3
0000 00uu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF4
0288
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 4
0000 00uu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF5
028A
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 5
0000 00uu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF6
028C
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 6
0000 00uu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF7
028E
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 7
0000 00uu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF8
0290
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 8
0000 00uu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF9
0292
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 9
0000 00uu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUFA
0294
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 10
0000 00uu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUFB
0296
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 11
0000 00uu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUFC
0298
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 12
0000 00uu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUFD
029A
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 13
0000 00uu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUFE
029C
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 14
0000 00uu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUFF
029E
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 15
ADCON1
02A0
ADON
—
ADSIDL
—
—
—
FORM<1:0>
ADCON2
02A2
—
—
CSCNA
CHPS<1:0>
ADCON3
02A4
ADCHS
02A6
VCFG<2:0>
—
—
CH123NB<1:0>
—
SAMC<4:0>
CH123SB
CH0NB
CH0SB<3:0>
SSRC<2:0>
BUFS
—
ADRC
—
CH123NA<1:0>
—
0000 00uu uuuu uuuu
SIMSAM
ASAM
SMPI<3:0>
SAMP
DONE
0000 0000 0000 0000
BUFM
ALTS
0000 0000 0000 0000
ADCS<5:0>
CH123SA
CH0NA
0000 0000 0000 0000
CH0SA<3:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
ADPCFG
02A8
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PCFG8*
PCFG7*
PCFG6*
PCFG5
PCFG4
PCFG3
PCFG2 PCFG1 PCFG0
0000 0000 0000 0000
ADCSSL
02AA
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
CSSL8*
CSSL7*
CSSL6*
CSSL5
CSSL4
CSSL3
CSSL2
0000 0000 0000 0000
Legend:
*
u = uninitialized bit
Not available on dsPIC30F4012.
Note:
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
CSSL1
CSSL0
DS70135E-page 143
dsPIC30F4011/4012
Confidential
ADCBUF0
ADCBUF1
dsPIC30F4011/4012
NOTES:
DS70135E-page 144
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
21.0
SYSTEM INTEGRATION
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
There are several features intended to maximize
system reliability, minimize cost through elimination of
external components, provide power-saving operating
modes and offer code protection:
• Oscillator Selection
• Reset
- Power-on Reset (POR)
- Power-up Timer (PWRT)
- Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)
- Programmable Brown-out Reset (BOR)
• Watchdog Timer (WDT)
• Power-Saving Modes (Sleep and Idle)
• Code Protection
• Unit ID Locations
• In-Circuit Serial Programming (ICSP)
21.1
Oscillator System Overview
The dsPIC30F oscillator system has the following
modules and features:
• Various external and internal oscillator options as
clock sources
• An on-chip PLL to boost internal operating
frequency
• A clock switching mechanism between various
clock sources
• Programmable clock postscaler for system power
savings
• A Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) that detects
clock failure and takes fail-safe measures
• Clock Control register (OSCCON)
• Configuration bits for main oscillator selection
Table 21-1 provides a summary of the dsPIC30F
oscillator operating modes. A simplified diagram of the
oscillator system is shown in Figure 21-1.
Configuration bits determine the clock source upon
Power-on Reset (POR) and Brown-out Reset (BOR).
Thereafter, the clock source can be changed between
permissible clock sources. The OSCCON register
controls the clock switching and reflects system clock
related status bits.
dsPIC30F devices have a Watchdog Timer which is
permanently enabled via the Configuration bits, or can
be software controlled. It runs off its own RC oscillator for
added reliability. There are two timers that offer necessary delays on power-up. One is the Oscillator Start-up
Timer (OST), intended to keep the chip in Reset until the
crystal oscillator is stable. The other is the Power-up
Timer (PWRT), which provides a delay on power-up
only, designed to keep the part in Reset while the power
supply stabilizes. With these two timers on-chip, most
applications need no external Reset circuitry.
Sleep mode is designed to offer a very low-current
Power-Down mode. The user can wake-up from Sleep
through external Reset, Watchdog Timer wake-up or
through an interrupt. Several oscillator options are also
made available to allow the part to fit a wide variety of
applications. In the Idle mode, the clock sources are
still active, but the CPU is shut off. The RC oscillator
option saves system cost, while the LP crystal option
saves power.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 145
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 21-1:
OSCILLATOR OPERATING MODES
Oscillator Mode
Description
XTL
200 kHz-4 MHz crystal on OSC1:OSC2
XT
4 MHz-10 MHz crystal on OSC1:OSC2
XT w/PLL 4x
4 MHz-10 MHz crystal on OSC1:OSC2, 4x PLL enabled
XT w/PLL 8x
4 MHz-10 MHz crystal on OSC1:OSC2, 8x PLL enabled
XT w/PLL 16x
4 MHz-10 MHz crystal on OSC1:OSC2, 16x PLL enabled(1)
LP
32 kHz crystal on SOSCO:SOSCI(2)
HS
10 MHz-25 MHz crystal
EC
External clock input (0-40 MHz)
ECIO
External clock input (0-40 MHz), OSC2 pin is I/O
EC w/PLL 4x
External clock input (0-40 MHz), OSC2 pin is I/O, 4x PLL enabled(1)
EC w/PLL 8x
External clock input (0-40 MHz), OSC2 pin is I/O, 8x PLL enabled(1)
EC w/PLL 16x
External clock input (0-40 MHz), OSC2 pin is I/O, 16x PLL enabled(1)
ERC
External RC oscillator, OSC2 pin is FOSC/4 output(3)
ERCIO
External RC oscillator, OSC2 pin is I/O(3)
FRC
8 MHz internal RC oscillator
FRC w/PLL 4x
7.37 MHz Internal RC oscillator, 4x PLL enabled
FRC w/PLL 8x
7.37 MHz Internal RC oscillator, 8x PLL enabled
FRC w/PLL 16x
7.37 MHz Internal RC oscillator, 16x PLL enabled
LPRC
512 kHz internal RC oscillator
Note 1:
2:
3:
The dsPIC30F maximum operating frequency of 120 MHz must be met.
LP oscillator can be conveniently shared as a system clock, as well as a Real-Time Clock for Timer1.
Requires external R and C. Frequency operation up to 4 MHz.
DS70135E-page 146
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 21-1:
OSCILLATOR SYSTEM BLOCK DIAGRAM
Oscillator Configuration bits
PWRSAV Instruction
Wake-up Request
FPLL
OSC1
OSC2
Primary
Oscillator
PLL
x4, x8, x16
PLL
Lock
COSC<1:0>
Primary Osc
NOSC<1:0>
Primary
Oscillator
Stability Detector
POR Done
OSWEN
Oscillator
Start-up
Timer
Clock
Secondary Osc
Switching
and Control
Block
SOSCO
SOSCI
32 kHz LP
Oscillator
Secondary
Oscillator
Stability Detector
Programmable
Clock Divider System
Clock
2
POST<1:0>
FRC
Internal Fast RC
Oscillator (FRC)
Internal
Low-Power RC
Oscillator (LPRC)
FCKSM<1:0>
2
LPRC
Fail-Safe Clock
Monitor (FSCM)
CF
Oscillator Trap
to Timer1
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 147
dsPIC30F4011/4012
21.2
21.2.2
Oscillator Configurations
21.2.1
INITIAL CLOCK SOURCE
SELECTION
In order to ensure that a crystal oscillator (or ceramic
resonator) has started and stabilized, an Oscillator
Start-up Timer (OST) is included. It is a simple, 10-bit
counter that counts 1024 TOSC cycles before releasing
the oscillator clock to the rest of the system. The timeout period is designated as TOST. The TOST time is
involved every time the oscillator has to restart (i.e., on
POR, BOR and wake-up from Sleep). The Oscillator
Start-up Timer is applied to the LP, XT, XTL and HS
modes (upon wake-up from Sleep, POR and BOR) for
the primary oscillator.
While coming out of Power-on Reset or Brown-out
Reset, the device selects its clock source based on:
a)
The FOS<1:0> Configuration bits that select one
of four oscillator groups.
The FPR<3:0> Configuration bits that select one
of 13 oscillator choices within the primary group.
b)
The selection is as shown in Table 21-2.
TABLE 21-2:
OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER
(OST)
CONFIGURATION BIT VALUES FOR CLOCK SELECTION
Oscillator Mode
Oscillator
Source
FOS1
FOS0
FPR3
FPR2
FPR1
FPR0
OSC2
Function
EC
Primary
1
1
1
0
1
1
CLKO
ECIO
Primary
1
1
1
1
0
0
I/O
EC w/PLL 4x
Primary
1
1
1
1
0
1
I/O
EC w/PLL 8x
Primary
1
1
1
1
1
0
I/O
EC w/PLL 16x
Primary
1
1
1
1
1
1
I/O
ERC
Primary
1
1
1
0
0
1
CLKO
ERCIO
Primary
1
1
1
0
0
0
I/O
XT
Primary
1
1
0
1
0
0
OSC2
XT w/PLL 4x
Primary
1
1
0
1
0
1
OSC2
XT w/PLL 8x
Primary
1
1
0
1
1
0
OSC2
XT w/PLL 16x
Primary
1
1
0
1
1
1
OSC2
XTL
Primary
1
1
0
0
0
0
OSC2
HS
Primary
1
1
0
0
1
0
OSC2
FRC w/PLL 4x
Primary
1
1
0
0
0
1
I/O
FRC w/PLL 8x
Primary
1
1
1
0
1
0
I/O
FRC w/PLL 16x
Primary
1
1
0
0
1
1
I/O
LP
Secondary
0
0
—
—
—
—
(Notes 1, 2)
FRC
Internal FRC
0
1
—
—
—
—
(Notes 1, 2)
Internal LPRC
1
0
—
—
—
—
(Notes 1, 2)
LPRC
Note 1:
2:
OSC2 pin function is determined by the Primary Oscillator mode selection (FPR<3:0>).
Note that the OSC1 pin cannot be used as an I/O pin, even if the secondary oscillator or an internal clock
source is selected at all times.
DS70135E-page 148
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
21.2.3
LP OSCILLATOR CONTROL
Enabling the LP oscillator is controlled with two
elements:
1.
2.
The current oscillator group bits, COSC<1:0>.
The LPOSCEN bit (OSCCON register).
The LP oscillator is on (even during Sleep mode) if
LPOSCEN = 1. The LP oscillator is the device clock if:
• COSC<1:0> = 00 (LP selected as main oscillator)
and
• LPOSCEN = 1
Keeping the LP oscillator on at all times allows for a
fast switch to the 32 kHz system clock for lower power
operation. Returning to the faster main oscillator still
requires a start-up time.
21.2.4
PHASE LOCKED LOOP (PLL)
The PLL multiplies the clock which is generated by the
primary oscillator. The PLL is selectable to have either
gains of x4, x8 or x16. Input and output frequency
ranges are summarized in Table 21-3.
TABLE 21-3:
FIN
PLL FREQUENCY RANGE
PLL
Multiplier
FOUT
4 MHz-10 MHz
x4
16 MHz-40 MHz
4 MHz-10 MHz
x8
32 MHz-80 MHz
4 MHz-7.5 MHz
x16
64 MHz-120 MHz
The PLL features a lock output which is asserted when
the PLL enters a phase locked state. Should the loop
fall out of lock (e.g., due to noise), the lock signal is
rescinded. The state of this signal is reflected in the
read-only LOCK bit in the OSCCON register.
21.2.5
FAST RC OSCILLATOR (FRC)
TABLE 21-4:
TUN<3:0>
Bits
0111
0110
0101
0100
0011
0010
0001
0000
1111
1110
1101
1100
1011
1010
1001
1000
21.2.6
FRC TUNING
FRC Frequency
+10.5%
+9.0%
+7.5%
+6.0%
+4.5%
+3.0%
+1.5%
Center Frequency (oscillator is
running at calibrated frequency)
-1.5%
-3.0%
-4.5%
-6.0%
-7.5%
-9.0%
-10.5%
-12.0%
LOW-POWER RC OSCILLATOR
(LPRC)
The LPRC oscillator is a component of the Watchdog
Timer (WDT) and oscillates at a nominal frequency of
512 kHz. The LPRC oscillator is the clock source for
the Power-up Timer (PWRT) circuit, WDT and clock
monitor circuits. It may also be used to provide a lowfrequency clock source option for applications where
power consumption is critical and timing accuracy is
not required.
The LPRC oscillator is always enabled at a Power-on
Reset because it is the clock source for the PWRT.
After the PWRT expires, the LPRC oscillator remains
on if one of the following is true:
The FRC oscillator is a fast (7.37 MHz, +/-2% nominal),
internal RC oscillator. This oscillator is intended to
provide reasonable device operating speeds without
the use of an external crystal, ceramic resonator or RC
network. Using the x4, x8 and x16 PLL options, higher
operational frequencies can be generated.
• The Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is enabled
• The WDT is enabled
• The LPRC oscillator is selected as the system
clock via the COSC<1:0> control bits in the
OSCCON register
The dsPIC30F operates from the FRC oscillator whenever the Current Oscillator Selection (COSC<1:0>)
control
bits
in
the
OSCCON
register
(OSCCON<13:12>) are set to ‘01’.
If one of the above conditions is not true, the LPRC
shuts off after the PWRT expires.
There are four tuning bits (TUN<3:0>) for the FRC
oscillator in the OSCCON register. These tuning bits
allow the FRC oscillator frequency to be adjusted as
close to 7.37 MHz as possible, depending on the
device operating conditions. The FRC oscillator
frequency has been calibrated during factory testing.
Table 21-4 describes the adjustment range of the
TUN<3:0> bits.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Note 1: OSC2 pin function is determined by the
Primary Oscillator mode selection
(FPR<3:0>).
2: Note that OSC1 pin cannot be used as an
I/O pin, even if the secondary oscillator or
an internal clock source is selected at all
times.
DS70135E-page 149
dsPIC30F4011/4012
21.2.7
FAIL-SAFE CLOCK MONITOR
The Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) allows the device
to continue to operate even in the event of an oscillator
failure. The FSCM function is enabled by appropriately
programming the FCKSM<1:0> Configuration bits
(Clock Switch and Monitor Selection bits) in the FOSC
device Configuration register. If the FSCM function is
enabled, the LPRC internal oscillator runs at all times
(except during Sleep mode) and is not subject to
control by the SWDTEN bit.
In the event of an oscillator failure, the FSCM
generates a clock failure trap event and switches the
system clock over to the FRC oscillator. The user then
has the option to either attempt to restart the oscillator
or execute a controlled shutdown. The user may decide
to treat the trap as a warm Reset by simply loading the
Reset address into the oscillator fail trap vector. In this
event, the CF (Clock Fail) status bit (OSCCON<3>) is
also set whenever a clock failure is recognized.
In the event of a clock failure, the WDT is unaffected
and continues to run on the LPRC clock.
If the oscillator has a very slow start-up time coming
out of POR, BOR or Sleep, it is possible that the
PWRT timer will expire before the oscillator has
started. In such cases, the FSCM is activated. The
FSCM initiates a clock failure trap, and the
COSC<1:0> bits are loaded with the Fast RC (FRC)
oscillator selection. This effectively shuts off the
original oscillator that was trying to start.
The OSCCON register holds the control and status bits
related to clock switching.
• COSC<1:0>: Read-only status bits always reflect
the current oscillator group in effect.
• NOSC<1:0>: Control bits which are written to
indicate the new oscillator group of choice.
- On POR and BOR, COSC<1:0> and
NOSC<1:0> are both loaded with the
Configuration bit values, FOS<1:0>.
• LOCK: The LOCK status bit indicates a PLL lock.
• CF: Read-only status bit indicating if a clock fail
detect has occurred.
• OSWEN: Control bit changes from a ‘0’ to a ‘1’
when a clock transition sequence is initiated.
Clearing the OSWEN control bit aborts a clock
transition in progress (used for hang-up
situations).
If Configuration bits, FCKSM<1:0> = 1x, then the clock
switching and Fail-Safe Clock Monitor functions are
disabled. This is the default Configuration bit setting.
If clock switching is disabled, then the FOS<1:0> and
FPR<3:0> bits directly control the oscillator selection,
and the COSC<1:0> bits do not control the clock
selection. However, these bits do reflect the clock
source selection.
Note:
The user may detect this situation and restart the
oscillator in the clock fail trap Interrupt Service Routine
(ISR).
Upon a clock failure detection, the FSCM module
initiates a clock switch to the FRC oscillator as follows:
1.
2.
3.
The COSC<1:0> bits (OSCCON<13:12>) are
loaded with the FRC oscillator selection value.
CF bit is set (OSCCON<3>).
OSWEN control bit (OSCCON<0>) is cleared.
For the purpose of clock switching, the clock sources
are sectioned into four groups:
1.
2.
3.
4.
Primary
Secondary
Internal FRC
Internal LPRC
The user can switch between these functional groups
but cannot switch between options within a group. If the
primary group is selected, then the choice within the
group is always determined by the FPR<3:0>
Configuration bits.
21.2.8
The application should not attempt to
switch to a clock of frequency lower than
100 kHz when the Fail-Safe Clock Monitor
is enabled. If such clock switching is
performed, the device may generate an
oscillator fail trap and switch to the Fast RC
(FRC) oscillator.
PROTECTION AGAINST
ACCIDENTAL WRITES TO OSCCON
A write to the OSCCON register is intentionally made
difficult because it controls clock switching and clock
scaling.
To write to the OSCCON low byte, the following code
sequence must be executed without any other
instructions in between:
• Byte Write “0x46” to OSCCON low
• Byte Write “0x57” to OSCCON low
Byte Write is allowed for one instruction cycle. Write the
desired value or use bit manipulation instruction.
To write to the OSCCON high byte, the following
instructions must be executed without any other
instructions in between:
• Byte Write “0x78” to OSCCON high
• Byte Write “0x9A” to OSCCON high
Byte Write is allowed for one instruction cycle. Write the
desired value or use bit manipulation instruction.
DS70135E-page 150
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
21.3
Reset
The dsPIC30F4011/4012 devices differentiate between
various kinds of Reset:
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
f)
g)
h)
Power-on Reset (POR)
MCLR Reset during normal operation
MCLR Reset during Sleep
Watchdog Timer (WDT) Reset (during normal
operation)
Programmable Brown-out Reset (BOR)
RESET Instruction
Reset caused by trap lock-up (TRAPR)
Reset caused by illegal opcode, or by using an
uninitialized W register as an Address Pointer
(IOPUWR)
FIGURE 21-2:
Different registers are affected in different ways by
various Reset conditions. Most registers are not
affected by a WDT wake-up, since this is viewed as the
resumption of normal operation. Status bits from the
RCON register are set or cleared differently in different
Reset situations, as indicated in Table 21-5. These bits
are used in software to determine the nature of the
Reset.
A block diagram of the on-chip Reset circuit is shown in
Figure 21-2.
A MCLR noise filter is provided in the MCLR Reset
path. The filter detects and ignores small pulses.
Internally generated Resets do not drive MCLR pin low.
RESET SYSTEM BLOCK DIAGRAM
RESET
Instruction
Digital
Glitch Filter
MCLR
Sleep or Idle
WDT
Module
POR
VDD Rise
Detect
S
VDD
Brown-out
Reset
BOR
BOREN
R
Q
SYSRST
Trap Conflict
Illegal Opcode/
Uninitialized W Register
21.3.1
POR: POWER-ON RESET
A power-on event generates an internal POR pulse
when a VDD rise is detected. The Reset pulse occurs at
the POR circuit threshold voltage (VPOR) which is nominally 1.85V. The device supply voltage characteristics
must meet specified starting voltage and rise rate
requirements. The POR pulse resets a POR timer and
places the device in the Reset state. The POR also
selects the device clock source identified by the
oscillator Configuration fuses.
The POR circuit inserts a small delay, TPOR, which is
nominally 10 μs and ensures that the device bias
circuits are stable. Furthermore, a user-selected
power-up time-out (TPWRT) is applied. The TPWRT
parameter is based on device Configuration bits and
can be 0 ms (no delay), 4 ms, 16 ms or 64 ms. The total
delay is at device power-up, TPOR + TPWRT. When
these delays have expired, SYSRST will be negated on
the next leading edge of the Q1 clock and the PC jumps
to the Reset vector.
The timing for the SYSRST signal is shown in
Figure 21-3 through Figure 21-5.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 151
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 21-3:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR TIED TO VDD)
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TOST
OST TIME-OUT
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
INTERNAL RESET
FIGURE 21-4:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR NOT TIED TO VDD): CASE 1
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TOST
OST TIME-OUT
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
INTERNAL RESET
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR NOT TIED TO VDD): CASE 2
FIGURE 21-5:
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TOST
OST TIME-OUT
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
INTERNAL RESET
DS70135E-page 152
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
21.3.1.1
POR with Long Crystal Start-up Time
(with FSCM Enabled)
The oscillator start-up circuitry is not linked to the POR
circuitry. Some crystal circuits (especially lowfrequency crystals) have a relatively long start-up time.
Therefore, one or more of the following conditions is
possible after the POR timer and the PWRT have
expired:
• The oscillator circuit has not begun to oscillate.
• The Oscillator Start-up Timer has not expired (if a
crystal oscillator is used).
• The PLL has not achieved a lock (if PLL is used).
If the FSCM is enabled and one of the above conditions
is true, then a clock failure trap occurs. The device
automatically switches to the FRC oscillator and the
user can switch to the desired crystal oscillator in the
trap ISR.
21.3.1.2
Operating without FSCM and PWRT
A BOR generates a Reset pulse, which resets the
device. The BOR selects the clock source, based on
the device Configuration bit values (FOS<1:0> and
FPR<3:0>). Furthermore, if an oscillator mode is
selected, the BOR activates the Oscillator Start-up
Timer (OST). The system clock is held until OST
expires. If the PLL is used, then the clock is held until
the LOCK bit (OSCCON<5>) is ‘1’.
Concurrently, the POR time-out (TPOR) and the PWRT
time-out (TPWRT) are applied before the internal Reset
is released. If TPWRT = 0 and a crystal oscillator is
being used, then a nominal delay of TFSCM = 100 μs is
applied. The total delay in this case is (TPOR + TFSCM).
The BOR status bit (RCON<1>) is set to indicate that a
BOR has occurred. The BOR circuit, if enabled, continues to operate while in Sleep or Idle modes and resets
the device if VDD falls below the BOR threshold voltage.
FIGURE 21-6:
If the FSCM is disabled and the Power-up Timer
(PWRT) is also disabled, then the device exits rapidly
from Reset on power-up. If the clock source is FRC,
LPRC, ERC or EC, it will be active immediately.
VDD
D
If the FSCM is disabled and the system clock has not
started, the device will be in a frozen state at the Reset
vector until the system clock starts. From the user’s
perspective, the device will appear to be in Reset until
a system clock is available.
21.3.2
BOR: PROGRAMMABLE
BROWN-OUT RESET
• 2.6V-2.71V
• 4.1V-4.4V
• 4.58V-4.73V
Note:
R
R1
MCLR
C
dsPIC30F
Note 1:
External Power-on Reset circuit is required
only if the VDD power-up slope is too slow.
The diode D helps discharge the capacitor
quickly when VDD powers down.
2:
R should be suitably chosen so as to make
sure that the voltage drop across R does not
violate the device’s electrical specification.
3:
R1 should be suitably chosen so as to limit
any current flowing into MCLR from external
capacitor C, in the event of MCLR pin breakdown, due to Electrostatic Discharge (ESD)
or Electrical Overstress (EOS).
The BOR (Brown-out Reset) module is based on an
internal voltage reference circuit. The main purpose of
the BOR module is to generate a device Reset when a
brown-out condition occurs. Brown-out conditions are
generally caused by glitches on the AC mains (i.e.,
missing portions of the AC cycle waveform due to bad
power transmission lines, or voltage sags due to excessive current draw when a large inductive load is turned
on).
The BOR module allows selection of one of the
following voltage trip points (see Table 24-10 ):
EXTERNAL POWER-ON
RESET CIRCUIT (FOR
SLOW VDD POWER-UP)
Note:
Dedicated supervisory devices, such as
the MCP1XX and MCP8XX, may also be
used as an external Power-on Reset
circuit.
The BOR voltage trip points indicated here
are nominal values provided for design
guidance only.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 153
dsPIC30F4011/4012
Table 21-5 shows the Reset conditions for the RCON
Register. Since the control bits within the RCON register are R/W, the information in the table implies that all
the bits are negated prior to the action specified in the
condition column.
TABLE 21-5:
INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR RCON REGISTER, CASE 1
Condition
Power-on Reset
Program
Counter
0x000000
TRAPR IOPUWR EXTR SWR WDTO IDLE SLEEP POR BOR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
Brown-out Reset
0x000000
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
MCLR Reset during normal
operation
0x000000
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
Software Reset during
normal operation
0x000000
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
MCLR Reset during Sleep
0x000000
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
MCLR Reset during Idle
0x000000
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
0
WDT Time-out Reset
0x000000
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
WDT Wake-up
PC + 2
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
PC + 2(1)
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
Clock Failure Trap
0x000004
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Trap Reset
0x000000
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Illegal Operation Trap
0x000000
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Interrupt Wake-up from
Sleep
Note 1:
When the wake-up is due to an enabled interrupt, the PC is loaded with the corresponding interrupt vector.
Table 21-6 shows a second example of the bit
conditions for the RCON register. In this case, it is not
assumed that the user has set/cleared specific bits
prior to action specified in the condition column.
TABLE 21-6:
INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR RCON REGISTER, CASE 2
Condition
Program
Counter
TRAPR IOPUWR EXTR SWR WDTO IDLE SLEEP POR BOR
Power-on Reset
0x000000
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
Brown-out Reset
0x000000
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
0
1
MCLR Reset during normal
operation
0x000000
u
u
1
0
0
0
0
u
u
Software Reset during
normal operation
0x000000
u
u
0
1
0
0
0
u
u
MCLR Reset during Sleep
0x000000
u
u
1
u
0
0
1
u
u
MCLR Reset during Idle
0x000000
u
u
1
u
0
1
0
u
u
WDT Time-out Reset
0x000000
u
u
0
0
1
0
0
u
u
PC + 2
u
u
u
u
1
u
1
u
u
Interrupt Wake-up from
Sleep
(1)
PC + 2
u
u
u
u
u
u
1
u
u
Clock Failure Trap
0x000004
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
Trap Reset
0x000000
1
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
Illegal Operation Reset
0x000000
u
1
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
WDT Wake-up
Legend: u = unchanged
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an enabled interrupt, the PC is loaded with the corresponding interrupt vector.
DS70135E-page 154
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
21.4
21.4.1
Watchdog Timer (WDT)
WATCHDOG TIMER OPERATION
The primary function of the Watchdog Timer (WDT) is
to reset the processor in the event of a software
malfunction. The WDT is a free-running timer that runs
off an on-chip RC oscillator, requiring no external
component. Therefore, the WDT timer continues to
operate even if the main processor clock (e.g., the
crystal oscillator) fails.
21.4.2
ENABLING AND DISABLING
THE WDT
The Watchdog Timer can be “Enabled” or “Disabled”
only through a Configuration bit (FWDTEN) in the
Configuration register, FWDT.
Setting FWDTEN = 1 enables the Watchdog Timer.
The enabling is done when programming the device.
By default, after chip erase, FWDTEN bit = 1. Any
device programmer capable of programming
dsPIC30F devices allows programming of this and
other Configuration bits.
If enabled, the WDT increments until it overflows or
“times out”. A WDT time-out forces a device Reset
(except during Sleep). To prevent a WDT time-out, the
user must clear the Watchdog Timer using a CLRWDT
instruction.
If a WDT times out during Sleep, the device wakes-up.
The WDTO bit in the RCON register is cleared to
indicate a wake-up resulting from a WDT time-out.
Setting FWDTEN = 0 allows user software to enable/
disable the Watchdog Timer via the SWDTEN
(RCON<5>) control bit.
21.5
Power-Saving Modes
There are two power-saving states that can be entered
through the execution of a special instruction, PWRSAV.
These are: Sleep and Idle.
The format of the PWRSAV instruction is as follows:
PWRSAV <parameter>, where ‘parameter’ defines
Idle or Sleep mode.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
21.5.1
SLEEP MODE
In Sleep mode, the clock to the CPU and peripherals is
shut down. If an on-chip oscillator is being used, it is
shut down.
The Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is not functional during
Sleep, since there is no clock to monitor. However, the
LPRC clock remains active if WDT is operational during
Sleep.
The Brown-out Reset protection circuit and the LowVoltage Detect (LVD) circuit, if enabled, remain
functional during Sleep.
The processor wakes up from Sleep if at least one of
the following conditions has occurred:
• any interrupt that is individually enabled and
meets the required priority level
• any Reset (POR, BOR and MCLR)
• WDT time-out
On waking up from Sleep mode, the processor restarts
the same clock that was active prior to entry into Sleep
mode. When clock switching is enabled, bits
COSC<1:0> determine the oscillator source to be
used on wake-up. If clock switch is disabled, then
there is only one system clock.
Note:
If a POR or BOR occurred, the selection of
the oscillator is based on the FOS<1:0>
and FPR<3:0> Configuration bits.
If the clock source is an oscillator, the clock to the
device is held off until OST times out (indicating a
stable oscillator). If PLL is used, the system clock is
held off until LOCK = 1 (indicating that the PLL is
stable). In either case, TPOR, TLOCK and TPWRT delays
are applied.
If EC, FRC, LPRC or ERC oscillators are used, then a
delay of TPOR (~10 μs) is applied. This is the smallest
delay possible on wake-up from Sleep.
Moreover, if the LP oscillator was active during Sleep,
and LP is the oscillator used on wake-up, then the startup delay is equal to TPOR. PWRT and OST delays are
not applied. In order to have the smallest possible startup delay when waking up from Sleep, one of these
faster wake-up options should be selected before
entering Sleep.
DS70135E-page 155
dsPIC30F4011/4012
Any interrupt that is individually enabled (using the
corresponding IE bit) and meets the prevailing priority
level can wake-up the processor. The processor
processes the interrupt and branches to the ISR. The
SLEEP status bit in the RCON register is set upon
wake-up.
Note:
In spite of various delays applied (TPOR,
TLOCK and TPWRT), the crystal oscillator
(and PLL) may not be active at the end of
the time-out (e.g., for low-frequency crystals). In such cases, if FSCM is enabled,
the device detects this condition as a clock
failure and processes the clock failure
trap. The FRC oscillator is enabled, and
the user must re-enable the crystal oscillator. If FSCM is not enabled, then the
device simply suspends execution of code
until the clock is stable and remains in
Sleep until the oscillator clock has started.
All Resets wake-up the processor from Sleep mode.
Any Reset, other than POR, sets the SLEEP status bit.
In a POR, the SLEEP bit is cleared.
If Watchdog Timer is enabled, the processor wakes-up
from Sleep mode upon WDT time-out. The SLEEP and
WDTO status bits are both set.
21.5.2
IDLE MODE
In Idle mode, the clock to the CPU is shut down while
peripherals keep running. Unlike Sleep mode, the clock
source remains active.
Several peripherals have a control bit in each module,
that allows them to operate during Idle.
LPRC Fail-Safe Clock Monitor remains active if clock
failure detect is enabled.
The processor wakes up from Idle if at least one of the
following conditions is true:
• on any interrupt that is individually enabled (IE bit
is ‘1’) and meets the required priority level
• on any Reset (POR, BOR, MCLR)
• on WDT time-out
Upon wake-up from Idle mode, the clock is re-applied
to the CPU and instruction execution begins immediately, starting with the instruction following the PWRSAV
instruction.
DS70135E-page 156
Any interrupt that is individually enabled (using IE bit)
and meets the prevailing priority level can wake-up the
processor. The processor processes the interrupt and
branches to the ISR. The IDLE status bit in RCON
register is set upon wake-up.
Any Reset, other than POR, sets the IDLE status bit.
On a POR, the IDLE bit is cleared.
If Watchdog Timer is enabled, then the processor
wakes-up from Idle mode upon WDT time-out. The
IDLE and WDTO status bits are both set.
Unlike wake-up from Sleep, there are no time delays
involved in wake-up from Idle.
21.6
Device Configuration Registers
The Configuration bits in each device Configuration
register specify some of the device modes and are
programmed by a device programmer, or by using the
In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™) feature of the
device. Each device Configuration register is a 24-bit
register, but only the lower 16 bits of each register are
used to hold configuration data. There are four device
Configuration registers available to the user:
1.
2.
3.
4.
FOSC (0xF80000): Oscillator Configuration
Register
FWDT (0xF80002): Watchdog Timer
Configuration Register
FBORPOR (0xF80004): BOR and POR
Configuration Register
FGS (0xF8000A): General Code Segment
Configuration Register
The placement of the Configuration bits is automatically
handled when you select the device in your device
programmer. The desired state of the Configuration bits
may be specified in the source code (dependent on the
language tool used), or through the programming
interface. After the device has been programmed, the
application software may read the Configuration bit
values through the table read instructions. For additional
information, please refer to the programming
specifications of the device.
Note:
If the code protection Configuration fuse
bits (FGS<GCP> and FGS<GWRP>)
have been programmed, an erase of the
entire code-protected device is only
possible at voltages VDD ≥ 4.5V.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
21.7
In-Circuit Debugger
When MPLAB® ICD 2 is selected as a debugger, the
in-circuit debugging functionality is enabled. This function allows simple debugging functions when used with
MPLAB IDE. When the device has this feature enabled,
some of the resources are not available for general
use. These resources include the first 80 bytes of data
RAM and two I/O pins.
one of four pairs of debug I/O pins may be selected by
the user using configuration options in MPLAB IDE.
These pin pairs are named EMUD/EMUC, EMUD1/
EMUC1, EMUD2/EMUC2 and EMUD3/EMUC3.
In each case, the selected EMUD pin is the emulation/
debug data line and the EMUC pin is the emulation/
debug clock line. These pins interface to the MPLAB
ICD 2 module available from Microchip. The selected
pair of debug I/O pins is used by MPLAB ICD 2 to send
commands and receive responses, as well as to send
and receive data. To use the in-circuit debugger function of the device, the design must implement ICSP
connections to MCLR, VDD, VSS, PGC, PGD and the
selected EMUDx/EMUCx pin pair.
This gives rise to two possibilities:
1.
2.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
If EMUD/EMUC is selected as the debug I/O pin
pair, then only a 5-pin interface is required as the
EMUD and EMUC pin functions are multiplexed
with the PGD and PGC pin functions in all
dsPIC30F devices.
If EMUD1/EMUC1, EMUD2/EMUC2 or EMUD3/
EMUC3 is selected as the debug I/O pin pair,
then a 7-pin interface is required as the EMUDx/
EMUCx pin functions (x = 1, 2 or 3) are not
multiplexed with the PGD and PGC pin
functions.
DS70135E-page 157
SFR
Name
Addr.
SYSTEM INTEGRATION REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
RCON
0740 TRAPR IOPUWR BGST
OSCCON
0742
Note:
TUN3
TUN2
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
TUN1
TUN0
NOSC<1:0>
—
COSC<1:0>
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
EXTR
SWR
SWDTEN
WDTO
SLEEP
IDLE
LOCK
—
CF
—
POST<1:0>
Bit 1
Bit 0
BOR
POR
Reset State
Depends on type of Reset.
LPOSCEN OSWEN Depends on Configuration bits.
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
TABLE 21-8:
File Name
DEVICE CONFIGURATION REGISTER MAP
Addr.
Bits 23-16
FOSC
F80000
—
FWDT
F80002
—
FWDTEN
—
FBORPOR
F80004
—
MCLREN
FGS
F8000A
—
—
Note:
Bit 8
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PWMPIN
—
—
—
—
—
FCKSM<1:0>
Refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
—
—
FOS<1:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
FWPSA<1:0>
HPOL
LPOL
BOREN
—
BORV<1:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
FPR<3:0>
FWPSB<3:0>
FPWRT<1:0>
GCP
GWRP
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 158
TABLE 21-7:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
22.0
INSTRUCTION SET SUMMARY
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
The dsPIC30F instruction set adds many
enhancements to the previous PIC® MCU instruction
sets, while maintaining an easy migration from PIC
MCU instruction sets.
Most instructions are a single program memory word
(24 bits). Only three instructions require two program
memory locations.
Each single-word instruction is a 24-bit word divided
into an 8-bit opcode, which specifies the instruction
type, and one or more operands which further specify
the operation of the instruction.
The instruction set is highly orthogonal and is grouped
into five basic categories:
•
•
•
•
•
Word or byte-oriented operations
Bit-oriented operations
Literal operations
DSP operations
Control operations
Table 22-1 shows the general symbols used in
describing the instructions.
The dsPIC30F instruction set summary in Table 22-2
lists all the instructions along with the status flags
affected by each instruction.
Most word or byte-oriented W register instructions
(including barrel shift instructions) have three
operands:
• The first source operand, which is typically a
register ‘Wb’ without any address modifier
• The second source operand, which is typically a
register ‘Ws’ with or without an address modifier
• The destination of the result, which is typically a
register ‘Wd’ with or without an address modifier
However, word or byte-oriented file register instructions
have two operands:
• The file register specified by the value ‘f’
• The destination, which could either be the file
register ‘f’ or the W0 register, which is denoted as
‘WREG’
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Most bit-oriented instructions (including simple rotate/
shift instructions) have two operands:
• The W register (with or without an address modifier) or file register (specified by the value of ‘Ws’
or ‘f’)
• The bit in the W register or file register
(specified by a literal value or indirectly by the
contents of register ‘Wb’)
The literal instructions that involve data movement may
use some of the following operands:
• A literal value to be loaded into a W register or file
register (specified by the value of ‘k’)
• The W register or file register where the literal
value is to be loaded (specified by ‘Wb’ or ‘f’)
However, literal instructions that involve arithmetic or
logical operations use some of the following operands:
• The first source operand which is a register ‘Wb’
without any address modifier
• The second source operand which is a literal
value
• The destination of the result (only if not the same
as the first source operand) which is typically a
register ‘Wd’ with or without an address modifier
The MAC class of DSP instructions may use some of the
following operands:
• The accumulator (A or B) to be used (required
operand)
• The W registers to be used as the two operands
• The X and Y address space prefetch operations
• The X and Y address space prefetch destinations
• The accumulator write-back destination
The other DSP instructions do not involve any
multiplication and may include:
• The accumulator to be used (required)
• The source or destination operand (designated as
Wso or Wdo, respectively) with or without an
address modifier
• The amount of shift, specified by a W register
‘Wn’ or a literal value
The control instructions may use some of the following
operands:
• A program memory address
• The mode of the table read and table write
instructions
All instructions are a single word, except for certain
double-word instructions, which were made doubleword instructions so that all the required information is
available in these 48 bits. In the second word, the
8 MSbs are ‘0’s. If this second word is executed as an
instruction (by itself), it will execute as a NOP.
DS70135E-page 159
dsPIC30F4011/4012
Most single-word instructions are executed in a single
instruction cycle, unless a conditional test is true or the
program counter is changed as a result of the instruction. In these cases, the execution takes two instruction
cycles with the additional instruction cycle(s) executed
as a NOP. Notable exceptions are the BRA (unconditional/computed branch), indirect CALL/GOTO, all table
reads and writes and RETURN/RETFIE instructions,
which are single-word instructions but take two or three
cycles. Certain instructions that involve skipping over
the subsequent instruction, require either two or three
TABLE 22-1:
cycles if the skip is performed, depending on whether
the instruction being skipped is a single-word or twoword instruction. Moreover, double-word moves
require two cycles. The double-word instructions
execute in two instruction cycles.
Note:
For more details on the instruction set,
refer to the “dsPIC30F/33F Programmer’s
Reference Manual” (DS70157).
SYMBOLS USED IN OPCODE DESCRIPTIONS
Field
Description
#text
Means literal defined by “text“
(text)
Means “content of text“
[text]
Means “the location addressed by text”
{
Optional field or operation
}
<n:m>
Register bit field
.b
Byte mode selection
.d
Double-Word mode selection
.S
Shadow register select
.w
Word mode selection (default)
Acc
One of two accumulators {A, B}
AWB
Accumulator Write-Back Destination Address register ∈ {W13, [W13]+=2}
bit4
4-bit bit selection field (used in word addressed instructions) ∈ {0...15}
C, DC, N, OV, Z
MCU Status bits: Carry, Digit Carry, Negative, Overflow, Zero
Expr
Absolute address, label or expression (resolved by the linker)
f
File register address ∈ {0x0000...0x1FFF}
lit1
1-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0,1}
lit4
4-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...15}
lit5
5-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...31}
lit8
8-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...255}
lit10
10-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...255} for Byte mode, {0:1023} for Word mode
lit14
14-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...16384}
lit16
16-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...65535}
lit23
23-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...8388608}; LSB must be 0
None
Field does not require an entry, may be blank
OA, OB, SA, SB
DSP Status bits: ACCA Overflow, ACCB Overflow, ACCA Saturate, ACCB Saturate
PC
Program Counter
Slit10
10-bit signed literal ∈ {-512...511}
Slit16
16-bit signed literal ∈ {-32768...32767}
Slit6
6-bit signed literal ∈ {-16...16}
DS70135E-page 160
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 22-1:
SYMBOLS USED IN OPCODE DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Field
Description
Wb
Base W register ∈ {W0..W15}
Wd
Destination W register ∈ { Wd, [Wd], [Wd++], [Wd--], [++Wd], [--Wd] }
Wdo
Destination W register ∈
{ Wnd, [Wnd], [Wnd++], [Wnd--], [++Wnd], [--Wnd], [Wnd+Wb] }
Wm,Wn
Dividend, Divisor working register pair (Direct Addressing)
Wm*Wm
Multiplicand and Multiplier working register pair for Square instructions ∈
{W4*W4, W5*W5, W6*W6, W7*W7}
Wm*Wn
Multiplicand and Multiplier working register pair for DSP instructions ∈
{W4*W5, W4*W6, W4*W7, W5*W6, W5*W7, W6*W7}
Wn
One of 16 working registers ∈ {W0..W15}
Wnd
One of 16 destination working registers ∈ {W0..W15}
Wns
One of 16 source working registers ∈ {W0..W15}
WREG
W0 (working register used in file register instructions)
Ws
Source W register ∈ { Ws, [Ws], [Ws++], [Ws--], [++Ws], [--Ws] }
Wso
Source W register ∈
{ Wns, [Wns], [Wns++], [Wns--], [++Wns], [--Wns], [Wns+Wb] }
Wx
X Data Space Prefetch Address register for DSP instructions
∈ {[W8]+=6, [W8]+=4, [W8]+=2, [W8], [W8]-=6, [W8]-=4, [W8]-=2,
[W9]+=6, [W9]+=4, [W9]+=2, [W9], [W9]-=6, [W9]-=4, [W9]-=2,
[W9+W12],none}
Wxd
X Data Space Prefetch Destination register for DSP instructions ∈ {W4..W7}
Wy
Y Data Space Prefetch Address register for DSP instructions
∈ {[W10]+=6, [W10]+=4, [W10]+=2, [W10], [W10]-=6, [W10]-=4, [W10]-=2,
[W11]+=6, [W11]+=4, [W11]+=2, [W11], [W11]-=6, [W11]-=4, [W11]-=2,
[W11+W12], none}
Wyd
Y Data Space Prefetch Destination register for DSP instructions ∈ {W4..W7}
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 161
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 22-2:
INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW
Base
Assembly
Instr
Mnemonic
#
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
ADD
ADDC
AND
ASR
BCLR
BRA
BSET
Assembly Syntax
Description
# of
words
# of
cycles
Status Flags
Affected
ADD
Acc
Add Accumulators
1
1
OA, OB, SA, SB
ADD
f
f = f + WREG
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
ADD
f,WREG
WREG = f + WREG
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
ADD
#lit10,Wn
Wd = lit10 + Wd
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
ADD
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wd = Wb + Ws
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
ADD
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wd = Wb + lit5
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
ADD
Wso,#Slit4,Acc
16-bit Signed Add to Accumulator
1
1
OA, OB, SA, SB
ADDC
f
f = f + WREG + (C)
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
ADDC
f,WREG
WREG = f + WREG + (C)
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
ADDC
#lit10,Wn
Wd = lit10 + Wd + (C)
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
ADDC
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wd = Wb + Ws + (C)
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
ADDC
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wd = Wb + lit5 + (C)
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
AND
f
f = f .AND. WREG
1
1
N, Z
AND
f,WREG
WREG = f .AND. WREG
1
1
N, Z
AND
#lit10,Wn
Wd = lit10 .AND. Wd
1
1
N, Z
AND
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wd = Wb .AND. Ws
1
1
N, Z
AND
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wd = Wb .AND. lit5
1
1
N, Z
ASR
f
f = Arithmetic Right Shift f
1
1
C, N, OV, Z
ASR
f,WREG
WREG = Arithmetic Right Shift f
1
1
C, N, OV, Z
ASR
Ws,Wd
Wd = Arithmetic Right Shift Ws
1
1
C, N, OV, Z
ASR
Wb,Wns,Wnd
Wnd = Arithmetic Right Shift Wb by Wns
1
1
N, Z
ASR
Wb,#lit5,Wnd
Wnd = Arithmetic Right Shift Wb by lit5
1
1
N, Z
BCLR
f,#bit4
Bit Clear f
1
1
None
BCLR
Ws,#bit4
Bit Clear Ws
1
1
None
BRA
C,Expr
Branch if Carry
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
GE,Expr
Branch if greater than or equal
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
GEU,Expr
Branch if unsigned greater than or equal
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
GT,Expr
Branch if greater than
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
GTU,Expr
Branch if unsigned greater than
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
LE,Expr
Branch if less than or equal
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
LEU,Expr
Branch if unsigned less than or equal
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
LT,Expr
Branch if less than
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
LTU,Expr
Branch if unsigned less than
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
N,Expr
Branch if Negative
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
NC,Expr
Branch if Not Carry
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
NN,Expr
Branch if Not Negative
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
NOV,Expr
Branch if Not Overflow
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
NZ,Expr
Branch if Not Zero
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
OA,Expr
Branch if Accumulator A overflow
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
OB,Expr
Branch if Accumulator B overflow
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
OV,Expr
Branch if Overflow
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
SA,Expr
Branch if Accumulator A saturated
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
SB,Expr
Branch if Accumulator B saturated
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
Expr
Branch Unconditionally
1
2
None
BRA
Z,Expr
Branch if Zero
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
Wn
Computed Branch
1
2
None
BSET
f,#bit4
Bit Set f
1
1
None
BSET
Ws,#bit4
Bit Set Ws
1
1
None
Ws,Wb
Write C bit to Ws<Wb>
1
1
None
None
8
BSW
BSW.C
BSW.Z
Ws,Wb
Write Z bit to Ws<Wb>
1
1
9
BTG
BTG
f,#bit4
Bit Toggle f
1
1
None
BTG
Ws,#bit4
Bit Toggle Ws
1
1
None
BTSC
f,#bit4
Bit Test f, Skip if Clear
1
1
(2 or 3)
None
BTSC
Ws,#bit4
Bit Test Ws, Skip if Clear
1
1
(2 or 3)
None
10
BTSC
DS70135E-page 162
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 22-2:
INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW (CONTINUED)
Base
Assembly
Instr
Mnemonic
#
11
12
13
14
15
BTSS
BTST
BTSTS
CALL
CLR
Assembly Syntax
# of
cycles
Status Flags
Affected
f,#bit4
Bit Test f, Skip if Set
1
1
(2 or 3)
None
BTSS
Ws,#bit4
Bit Test Ws, Skip if Set
1
1
(2 or 3)
None
BTST
f,#bit4
Bit Test f
1
1
Z
BTST.C
Ws,#bit4
Bit Test Ws to C
1
1
C
BTST.Z
Ws,#bit4
Bit Test Ws to Z
1
1
Z
BTST.C
Ws,Wb
Bit Test Ws<Wb> to C
1
1
C
Z
BTST.Z
Ws,Wb
Bit Test Ws<Wb> to Z
1
1
BTSTS
f,#bit4
Bit Test then Set f
1
1
Z
BTSTS.C
Ws,#bit4
Bit Test Ws to C, then Set
1
1
C
Z
BTSTS.Z
Ws,#bit4
Bit Test Ws to Z, then Set
1
1
CALL
lit23
Call subroutine
2
2
None
CALL
Wn
Call indirect subroutine
1
2
None
CLR
f
f = 0x0000
1
1
None
CLR
WREG
WREG = 0x0000
1
1
None
CLR
Ws
Ws = 0x0000
1
1
None
CLR
Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd,AWB
Clear Accumulator
1
1
OA, OB, SA, SB
Clear Watchdog Timer
1
1
WDTO, Sleep
f
f=f
1
1
N, Z
COM
f,WREG
WREG = f
1
1
N, Z
COM
Ws,Wd
Wd = Ws
1
1
N, Z
CP
f
Compare f with WREG
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
CP
Wb,#lit5
Compare Wb with lit5
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
CP
Wb,Ws
Compare Wb with Ws (Wb – Ws)
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
f
Compare f with 0x0000
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
CLRWDT
CLRWDT
17
COM
COM
CP
# of
words
BTSS
16
18
Description
19
CP0
CP0
CP0
Ws
Compare Ws with 0x0000
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
20
CPB
CPB
f
Compare f with WREG, with Borrow
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
CPB
Wb,#lit5
Compare Wb with lit5, with Borrow
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
CPB
Wb,Ws
Compare Wb with Ws, with Borrow
(Wb – Ws – C)
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
21
CPSEQ
CPSEQ
Wb, Wn
Compare Wb with Wn, skip if =
1
1
(2 or 3)
None
22
CPSGT
CPSGT
Wb, Wn
Compare Wb with Wn, skip if >
1
1
(2 or 3)
None
23
CPSLT
CPSLT
Wb, Wn
Compare Wb with Wn, skip if <
1
1
(2 or 3)
None
24
CPSNE
CPSNE
Wb, Wn
Compare Wb with Wn, skip if ≠
1
1
(2 or 3)
None
25
DAW
DAW
Wn
Wn = decimal adjust Wn
1
1
C
26
DEC
DEC
f
f = f –1
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
DEC
f,WREG
WREG = f –1
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
DEC
Ws,Wd
Wd = Ws – 1
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
DEC2
f
f=f–2
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
DEC2
f,WREG
WREG = f – 2
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
27
DEC2
DEC2
Ws,Wd
Wd = Ws – 2
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
28
DISI
DISI
#lit14
Disable Interrupts for k instruction cycles
1
1
None
29
DIV
DIV.S
Wm,Wn
Signed 16/16-bit Integer Divide
1
18
N, Z, C, OV
DIV.SD
Wm,Wn
Signed 32/16-bit Integer Divide
1
18
N, Z, C, OV
DIV.U
Wm,Wn
Unsigned 16/16-bit Integer Divide
1
18
N, Z, C, OV
DIV.UD
Wm,Wn
Unsigned 32/16-bit Integer Divide
1
18
N, Z, C, OV
DIVF
Wm,Wn
Signed 16/16-bit Fractional Divide
1
18
N, Z, C, OV
None
30
DIVF
31
DO
32
ED
DO
#lit14,Expr
Do code to PC + Expr, lit14 + 1 time
2
2
DO
Wn,Expr
Do code to PC + Expr, (Wn) +1 time
2
2
None
ED
Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wy,Wxd
Euclidean Distance ( no accumulate)
1
1
OA, OB, OAB,
SA, SB, SAB
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 163
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 22-2:
INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW (CONTINUED)
Base
Assembly
Instr
Mnemonic
#
Assembly Syntax
Description
# of
words
# of
cycles
Status Flags
Affected
33
EDAC
EDAC
Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wy,Wxd
Euclidean Distance
1
1
OA, OB, OAB,
SA, SB, SAB
34
EXCH
EXCH
Wns,Wnd
Swap Wns with Wnd
1
1
None
35
FBCL
FBCL
Ws,Wnd
Find Bit Change from Left (MSb) Side
1
1
C
36
FF1L
FF1L
Ws,Wnd
Find First One from Left (MSb) Side
1
1
C
37
FF1R
FF1R
Ws,Wnd
Find First One from Right (LSb) Side
1
1
C
38
GOTO
GOTO
Expr
Go to address
2
2
None
GOTO
Wn
Go to indirect
1
2
None
39
INC
INC
f
f=f+1
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
INC
f,WREG
WREG = f + 1
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
C, DC, N, OV, Z
40
41
INC2
IOR
INC
Ws,Wd
Wd = Ws + 1
1
1
INC2
f
f=f+2
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
INC2
f,WREG
WREG = f + 2
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
C, DC, N, OV, Z
INC2
Ws,Wd
Wd = Ws + 2
1
1
IOR
f
f = f .IOR. WREG
1
1
N, Z
IOR
f,WREG
WREG = f .IOR. WREG
1
1
N, Z
IOR
#lit10,Wn
Wd = lit10 .IOR. Wd
1
1
N, Z
IOR
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wd = Wb .IOR. Ws
1
1
N, Z
IOR
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wd = Wb .IOR. lit5
1
1
N, Z
1
1
OA, OB, OAB,
SA, SB, SAB
42
LAC
LAC
Wso,#Slit4,Acc
Load Accumulator
43
LNK
LNK
#lit14
Link Frame Pointer
1
1
None
44
LSR
LSR
f
f = Logical Right Shift f
1
1
C, N, OV, Z
LSR
f,WREG
WREG = Logical Right Shift f
1
1
C, N, OV, Z
LSR
Ws,Wd
Wd = Logical Right Shift Ws
1
1
C, N, OV, Z
LSR
Wb,Wns,Wnd
Wnd = Logical Right Shift Wb by Wns
1
1
N, Z
LSR
Wb,#lit5,Wnd
Wnd = Logical Right Shift Wb by lit5
1
1
N, Z
MAC
Wm*Wn,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd, Multiply and Accumulate
AWB
1
1
OA, OB, OAB,
SA, SB, SAB
MAC
Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd
Square and Accumulate
1
1
OA, OB, OAB,
SA, SB, SAB
MOV
f,Wn
Move f to Wn
1
1
None
MOV
f
Move f to f
1
1
N, Z
MOV
f,WREG
Move f to WREG
1
1
N, Z
MOV
#lit16,Wn
Move 16-bit literal to Wn
1
1
None
MOV.b
#lit8,Wn
Move 8-bit literal to Wn
1
1
None
MOV
Wn,f
Move Wn to f
1
1
None
MOV
Wso,Wdo
Move Ws to Wd
1
1
None
MOV
WREG,f
45
46
MAC
MOV
Move WREG to f
1
1
N, Z
MOV.D
Wns,Wd
Move Double from W(ns):W(ns + 1) to Wd
1
2
None
MOV.D
Ws,Wnd
Move Double from Ws to W(nd + 1):W(nd)
1
2
None
47
MOVSAC
MOVSAC
Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd,AWB
Prefetch and store accumulator
1
1
None
48
MPY
MPY
Wm*Wn,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd
Multiply Wm by Wn to Accumulator
1
1
OA, OB, OAB,
SA, SB, SAB
MPY
Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd
Square Wm to Accumulator
1
1
OA, OB, OAB,
SA, SB, SAB
-(Multiply Wm by Wn) to Accumulator
1
1
None
1
1
OA, OB, OAB,
SA, SB, SAB
49
MPY.N
MPY.N
Wm*Wn,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd
50
MSC
MSC
Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd, Multiply and Subtract from Accumulator
AWB
51
MUL
MUL.SS
Wb,Ws,Wnd
{Wnd+1, Wnd} = signed(Wb) * signed(Ws)
1
1
None
MUL.SU
Wb,Ws,Wnd
{Wnd+1, Wnd} = signed(Wb) * unsigned(Ws)
1
1
None
MUL.US
Wb,Ws,Wnd
{Wnd+1, Wnd} = unsigned(Wb) * signed(Ws)
1
1
None
MUL.UU
Wb,Ws,Wnd
{Wnd+1, Wnd} = unsigned(Wb) * unsigned(Ws)
1
1
None
MUL.SU
Wb,#lit5,Wnd
{Wnd+1, Wnd} = signed(Wb) * unsigned(lit5)
1
1
None
MUL.UU
Wb,#lit5,Wnd
{Wnd+1, Wnd} = unsigned(Wb) * unsigned(lit5)
1
1
None
MUL
f
W3:W2 = f * WREG
1
1
None
DS70135E-page 164
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 22-2:
INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW (CONTINUED)
Base
Assembly
Instr
Mnemonic
#
52
53
54
NEG
NOP
POP
Assembly Syntax
PUSH
# of
words
# of
cycles
Status Flags
Affected
NEG
Acc
Negate Accumulator
1
1
OA, OB, OAB,
SA, SB, SAB
NEG
f
f=f+1
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
NEG
f,WREG
WREG = f + 1
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
NEG
Ws,Wd
Wd = Ws + 1
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
NOP
No Operation
1
1
None
NOPR
No Operation
1
1
None
POP
f
Pop f from Top-of-Stack (TOS)
1
1
None
POP
Wdo
Pop from Top-of-Stack (TOS) to Wdo
1
1
None
POP.D
Wnd
Pop from Top-of-Stack (TOS) to W(nd):W(nd +1 )
1
2
None
Pop Shadow Registers
1
1
All
POP.S
55
Description
PUSH
f
Push f to Top-of-Stack (TOS)
1
1
None
PUSH
Wso
Push Wso to Top-of-Stack (TOS)
1
1
None
PUSH.D
Wns
Push W(ns):W(ns + 1) to Top-of-Stack (TOS)
1
2
None
Push Shadow Registers
1
1
None
PUSH.S
56
PWRSAV
PWRSAV
#lit1
Go into Sleep or Idle mode
1
1
WDTO, Sleep
57
RCALL
RCALL
Expr
Relative Call
1
2
None
RCALL
Wn
Computed Call
1
2
None
58
REPEAT
REPEAT
#lit14
Repeat Next Instruction lit14 + 1 time
1
1
None
REPEAT
Wn
Repeat Next Instruction (Wn) + 1 time
1
1
None
59
RESET
RESET
Software device Reset
1
1
None
60
RETFIE
RETFIE
Return from interrupt
1
3 (2)
None
61
RETLW
RETLW
Return with literal in Wn
1
3 (2)
None
62
RETURN
RETURN
Return from Subroutine
1
3 (2)
None
63
RLC
RLC
f
f = Rotate Left through Carry f
1
1
C, N, Z
RLC
f,WREG
WREG = Rotate Left through Carry f
1
1
C, N, Z
RLC
Ws,Wd
Wd = Rotate Left through Carry Ws
1
1
C, N, Z
RLNC
f
f = Rotate Left (No Carry) f
1
1
N, Z
RLNC
f,WREG
WREG = Rotate Left (No Carry) f
1
1
N, Z
RLNC
Ws,Wd
Wd = Rotate Left (No Carry) Ws
1
1
N, Z
RRC
f
f = Rotate Right through Carry f
1
1
C, N, Z
RRC
f,WREG
WREG = Rotate Right through Carry f
1
1
C, N, Z
RRC
Ws,Wd
Wd = Rotate Right through Carry Ws
1
1
C, N, Z
RRNC
f
f = Rotate Right (No Carry) f
1
1
N, Z
RRNC
f,WREG
WREG = Rotate Right (No Carry) f
1
1
N, Z
RRNC
Ws,Wd
Wd = Rotate Right (No Carry) Ws
1
1
N, Z
SAC
Acc,#Slit4,Wdo
Store Accumulator
1
1
None
SAC.R
Acc,#Slit4,Wdo
Store Rounded Accumulator
1
1
None
64
65
66
67
RLNC
RRC
RRNC
SAC
#lit10,Wn
68
SE
SE
Ws,Wnd
Wnd = sign-extended Ws
1
1
C, N, Z
69
SETM
SETM
f
f = 0xFFFF
1
1
None
SETM
WREG
WREG = 0xFFFF
1
1
None
SETM
Ws
Ws = 0xFFFF
1
1
None
SFTAC
Acc,Wn
Arithmetic Shift Accumulator by (Wn)
1
1
OA, OB, OAB,
SA, SB, SAB
SFTAC
Acc,#Slit6
Arithmetic Shift Accumulator by Slit6
1
1
OA, OB, OAB,
SA, SB, SAB
70
71
SFTAC
SL
SL
f
f = Left Shift f
1
1
C,N,OV,Z
SL
f,WREG
WREG = Left Shift f
1
1
C,N,OV,Z
SL
Ws,Wd
Wd = Left Shift Ws
1
1
C,N,OV,Z
SL
Wb,Wns,Wnd
Wnd = Left Shift Wb by Wns
1
1
N, Z
SL
Wb,#lit5,Wnd
Wnd = Left Shift Wb by lit5
1
1
N, Z
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 165
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 22-2:
INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW (CONTINUED)
Base
Assembly
Instr
Mnemonic
#
72
73
74
75
76
SUB
SUBB
SUBR
SUBBR
SWAP
Assembly Syntax
Description
# of
words
# of
cycles
1
1
Status Flags
Affected
Acc
Subtract Accumulators
SUB
f
f = f – WREG
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
SUB
f,WREG
WREG = f – WREG
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
SUB
#lit10,Wn
Wn = Wn – lit10
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
SUB
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wd = Wb – Ws
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
C, DC, N, OV, Z
SUB
OA, OB, OAB,
SA, SB, SAB
SUB
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wd = Wb – lit5
1
1
SUBB
f
f = f – WREG – (C)
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
SUBB
f,WREG
WREG = f – WREG – (C)
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
SUBB
#lit10,Wn
Wn = Wn – lit10 – (C)
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
SUBB
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wd = Wb – Ws – (C)
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
C, DC, N, OV, Z
SUBB
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wd = Wb – lit5 – (C)
1
1
SUBR
f
f = WREG – f
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
SUBR
f,WREG
WREG = WREG – f
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
SUBR
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wd = Ws – Wb
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
SUBR
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wd = lit5 – Wb
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
SUBBR
f
f = WREG – f – (C)
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
SUBBR
f,WREG
WREG = WREG – f – (C)
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
SUBBR
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wd = Ws – Wb – (C)
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
SUBBR
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wd = lit5 – Wb – (C)
1
1
C, DC, N, OV, Z
SWAP.b
Wn
Wn = nibble swap Wn
1
1
None
SWAP
Wn
Wn = byte swap Wn
1
1
None
1
2
None
77
TBLRDH
TBLRDH
Ws,Wd
Read Prog<23:16> to Wd<7:0>
78
TBLRDL
TBLRDL
Ws,Wd
Read Prog<15:0> to Wd
1
2
None
79
TBLWTH
TBLWTH
Ws,Wd
Write Ws<7:0> to Prog<23:16>
1
2
None
80
TBLWTL
TBLWTL
Ws,Wd
Write Ws to Prog<15:0>
1
2
None
81
ULNK
ULNK
Unlink Frame Pointer
1
1
None
82
XOR
XOR
f
f = f .XOR. WREG
1
1
N, Z
XOR
f,WREG
WREG = f .XOR. WREG
1
1
N, Z
XOR
#lit10,Wn
Wd = lit10 .XOR. Wd
1
1
N, Z
XOR
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wd = Wb .XOR. Ws
1
1
N, Z
XOR
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wd = Wb .XOR. lit5
1
1
N, Z
ZE
Ws,Wnd
Wnd = Zero-Extend Ws
1
1
C, N, Z
83
ZE
DS70135E-page 166
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
23.0
DEVELOPMENT SUPPORT
The PIC® microcontrollers are supported with a full
range of hardware and software development tools:
• Integrated Development Environment
- MPLAB® IDE Software
• Assemblers/Compilers/Linkers
- MPASMTM Assembler
- MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30 C Compilers
- MPLINKTM Object Linker/
MPLIBTM Object Librarian
- MPLAB ASM30 Assembler/Linker/Library
• Simulators
- MPLAB SIM Software Simulator
• Emulators
- MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator
- MPLAB ICE 4000 In-Circuit Emulator
• In-Circuit Debugger
- MPLAB ICD 2
• Device Programmers
- PICSTART® Plus Development Programmer
- MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer
- PICkit™ 2 Development Programmer
• Low-Cost Demonstration and Development
Boards and Evaluation Kits
23.1
MPLAB Integrated Development
Environment Software
The MPLAB IDE software brings an ease of software
development previously unseen in the 8/16-bit microcontroller market. The MPLAB IDE is a Windows®
operating system-based application that contains:
• A single graphical interface to all debugging tools
- Simulator
- Programmer (sold separately)
- Emulator (sold separately)
- In-Circuit Debugger (sold separately)
• A full-featured editor with color-coded context
• A multiple project manager
• Customizable data windows with direct edit of
contents
• High-level source code debugging
• Visual device initializer for easy register
initialization
• Mouse over variable inspection
• Drag and drop variables from source to watch
windows
• Extensive on-line help
• Integration of select third party tools, such as
HI-TECH Software C Compilers and IAR
C Compilers
The MPLAB IDE allows you to:
• Edit your source files (either assembly or C)
• One touch assemble (or compile) and download
to PIC MCU emulator and simulator tools
(automatically updates all project information)
• Debug using:
- Source files (assembly or C)
- Mixed assembly and C
- Machine code
MPLAB IDE supports multiple debugging tools in a
single development paradigm, from the cost-effective
simulators, through low-cost in-circuit debuggers, to
full-featured emulators. This eliminates the learning
curve when upgrading to tools with increased flexibility
and power.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 167
dsPIC30F4011/4012
23.2
MPASM Assembler
The MPASM Assembler is a full-featured, universal
macro assembler for all PIC MCUs.
The MPASM Assembler generates relocatable object
files for the MPLINK Object Linker, Intel® standard HEX
files, MAP files to detail memory usage and symbol
reference, absolute LST files that contain source lines
and generated machine code and COFF files for
debugging.
The MPASM Assembler features include:
• Integration into MPLAB IDE projects
• User-defined macros to streamline
assembly code
• Conditional assembly for multi-purpose
source files
• Directives that allow complete control over the
assembly process
23.5
MPLAB ASM30 Assembler produces relocatable
machine code from symbolic assembly language for
dsPIC30F devices. MPLAB C30 C Compiler uses the
assembler to produce its object file. The assembler
generates relocatable object files that can then be
archived or linked with other relocatable object files and
archives to create an executable file. Notable features
of the assembler include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Support for the entire dsPIC30F instruction set
Support for fixed-point and floating-point data
Command line interface
Rich directive set
Flexible macro language
MPLAB IDE compatibility
23.6
23.3
MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30
C Compilers
The MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30 Code Development
Systems are complete ANSI C compilers for
Microchip’s PIC18 family of microcontrollers and the
dsPIC30, dsPIC33 and PIC24 family of digital signal
controllers. These compilers provide powerful integration capabilities, superior code optimization and ease
of use not found with other compilers.
For easy source level debugging, the compilers provide
symbol information that is optimized to the MPLAB IDE
debugger.
23.4
MPLINK Object Linker/
MPLIB Object Librarian
The MPLINK Object Linker combines relocatable
objects created by the MPASM Assembler and the
MPLAB C18 C Compiler. It can link relocatable objects
from precompiled libraries, using directives from a
linker script.
MPLAB ASM30 Assembler, Linker
and Librarian
MPLAB SIM Software Simulator
The MPLAB SIM Software Simulator allows code
development in a PC-hosted environment by simulating the PIC MCUs and dsPIC® DSCs on an instruction
level. On any given instruction, the data areas can be
examined or modified and stimuli can be applied from
a comprehensive stimulus controller. Registers can be
logged to files for further run-time analysis. The trace
buffer and logic analyzer display extend the power of
the simulator to record and track program execution,
actions on I/O, most peripherals and internal registers.
The MPLAB SIM Software Simulator fully supports
symbolic debugging using the MPLAB C18 and
MPLAB C30 C Compilers, and the MPASM and
MPLAB ASM30 Assemblers. The software simulator
offers the flexibility to develop and debug code outside
of the hardware laboratory environment, making it an
excellent, economical software development tool.
The MPLIB Object Librarian manages the creation and
modification of library files of precompiled code. When
a routine from a library is called from a source file, only
the modules that contain that routine will be linked in
with the application. This allows large libraries to be
used efficiently in many different applications.
The object linker/library features include:
• Efficient linking of single libraries instead of many
smaller files
• Enhanced code maintainability by grouping
related modules together
• Flexible creation of libraries with easy module
listing, replacement, deletion and extraction
DS70135E-page 168
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
23.7
MPLAB ICE 2000
High-Performance
In-Circuit Emulator
The MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator is intended
to provide the product development engineer with a
complete microcontroller design tool set for PIC microcontrollers. Software control of the MPLAB ICE 2000
In-Circuit Emulator is advanced by the MPLAB Integrated Development Environment, which allows editing, building, downloading and source debugging from
a single environment.
The MPLAB ICE 2000 is a full-featured emulator
system with enhanced trace, trigger and data monitoring features. Interchangeable processor modules allow
the system to be easily reconfigured for emulation of
different processors. The architecture of the MPLAB
ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator allows expansion to
support new PIC microcontrollers.
The MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator system has
been designed as a real-time emulation system with
advanced features that are typically found on more
expensive development tools. The PC platform and
Microsoft® Windows® 32-bit operating system were
chosen to best make these features available in a
simple, unified application.
23.8
MPLAB ICE 4000
High-Performance
In-Circuit Emulator
The MPLAB ICE 4000 In-Circuit Emulator is intended to
provide the product development engineer with a
complete microcontroller design tool set for high-end
PIC MCUs and dsPIC DSCs. Software control of the
MPLAB ICE 4000 In-Circuit Emulator is provided by the
MPLAB Integrated Development Environment, which
allows editing, building, downloading and source
debugging from a single environment.
23.9
MPLAB ICD 2 In-Circuit Debugger
Microchip’s In-Circuit Debugger, MPLAB ICD 2, is a
powerful, low-cost, run-time development tool,
connecting to the host PC via an RS-232 or high-speed
USB interface. This tool is based on the Flash PIC
MCUs and can be used to develop for these and other
PIC MCUs and dsPIC DSCs. The MPLAB ICD 2 utilizes
the in-circuit debugging capability built into the Flash
devices. This feature, along with Microchip’s In-Circuit
Serial ProgrammingTM (ICSPTM) protocol, offers costeffective, in-circuit Flash debugging from the graphical
user interface of the MPLAB Integrated Development
Environment. This enables a designer to develop and
debug source code by setting breakpoints, single stepping and watching variables, and CPU status and
peripheral registers. Running at full speed enables
testing hardware and applications in real time. MPLAB
ICD 2 also serves as a development programmer for
selected PIC devices.
23.10 MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer
The MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer is a universal,
CE compliant device programmer with programmable
voltage verification at VDDMIN and VDDMAX for
maximum reliability. It features a large LCD display
(128 x 64) for menus and error messages and a modular, detachable socket assembly to support various
package types. The ICSP™ cable assembly is included
as a standard item. In Stand-Alone mode, the MPLAB
PM3 Device Programmer can read, verify and program
PIC devices without a PC connection. It can also set
code protection in this mode. The MPLAB PM3
connects to the host PC via an RS-232 or USB cable.
The MPLAB PM3 has high-speed communications and
optimized algorithms for quick programming of large
memory devices and incorporates an SD/MMC card for
file storage and secure data applications.
The MPLAB ICE 4000 is a premium emulator system,
providing the features of MPLAB ICE 2000, but with
increased emulation memory and high-speed performance for dsPIC30F and PIC18XXXX devices. Its
advanced emulator features include complex triggering
and timing, and up to 2 Mb of emulation memory.
The MPLAB ICE 4000 In-Circuit Emulator system has
been designed as a real-time emulation system with
advanced features that are typically found on more
expensive development tools. The PC platform and
Microsoft Windows 32-bit operating system were
chosen to best make these features available in a
simple, unified application.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 169
dsPIC30F4011/4012
23.11 PICSTART Plus Development
Programmer
23.13 Demonstration, Development and
Evaluation Boards
The PICSTART Plus Development Programmer is an
easy-to-use, low-cost, prototype programmer. It
connects to the PC via a COM (RS-232) port. MPLAB
Integrated Development Environment software makes
using the programmer simple and efficient. The
PICSTART Plus Development Programmer supports
most PIC devices in DIP packages up to 40 pins.
Larger pin count devices, such as the PIC16C92X and
PIC17C76X, may be supported with an adapter socket.
The PICSTART Plus Development Programmer is CE
compliant.
A wide variety of demonstration, development and
evaluation boards for various PIC MCUs and dsPIC
DSCs allows quick application development on fully functional systems. Most boards include prototyping areas for
adding custom circuitry and provide application firmware
and source code for examination and modification.
23.12 PICkit 2 Development Programmer
The PICkit™ 2 Development Programmer is a low-cost
programmer with an easy-to-use interface for programming many of Microchip’s baseline, mid-range
and PIC18F families of Flash memory microcontrollers.
The PICkit 2 Starter Kit includes a prototyping development board, twelve sequential lessons, software and
HI-TECH’s PICC™ Lite C compiler, and is designed to
help get up to speed quickly using PIC® microcontrollers. The kit provides everything needed to
program, evaluate and develop applications using
Microchip’s powerful, mid-range Flash memory family
of microcontrollers.
DS70135E-page 170
The boards support a variety of features, including LEDs,
temperature sensors, switches, speakers, RS-232
interfaces, LCD displays, potentiometers and additional
EEPROM memory.
The demonstration and development boards can be
used in teaching environments, for prototyping custom
circuits and for learning about various microcontroller
applications.
In addition to the PICDEM™ and dsPICDEM™ demonstration/development board series of circuits, Microchip
has a line of evaluation kits and demonstration software
for analog filter design, KEELOQ® security ICs, CAN,
IrDA®, PowerSmart® battery management, SEEVAL®
evaluation system, Sigma-Delta ADC, flow rate
sensing, plus many more.
Check the Microchip web page (www.microchip.com)
and the latest “Product Selector Guide” (DS00148) for
the complete list of demonstration, development and
evaluation kits.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
24.0
ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
This section provides an overview of dsPIC30F electrical characteristics. Additional information will be provided in future
revisions of this document as it becomes available.
For detailed information about the dsPIC30F architecture and core, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual”
(DS70046).
Absolute maximum ratings for the dsPIC30F family are listed below. Exposure to these maximum rating conditions for
extended periods may affect device reliability. Functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions above
the parameters indicated in the operation listings of this specification is not implied.
Absolute Maximum Ratings(†)
Ambient temperature under bias.............................................................................................................-40°C to +125°C
Storage temperature .............................................................................................................................. -65°C to +150°C
Voltage on any pin with respect to VSS (except VDD and MCLR) (Note 1) ..................................... -0.3V to (VDD + 0.3V)
Voltage on VDD with respect to VSS ......................................................................................................... -0.3V to +5.5V
Voltage on MCLR with respect to VSS ....................................................................................................... 0V to +13.25V
Maximum current out of VSS pin ...........................................................................................................................300 mA
Maximum current into VDD pin (Note 2)................................................................................................................250 mA
Input clamp current, IIK (VI < 0 or VI > VDD) .......................................................................................................... ±20 mA
Output clamp current, IOK (VO < 0 or VO > VDD) ...................................................................................................±20 mA
Maximum output current sunk by any I/O pin..........................................................................................................25 mA
Maximum output current sourced by any I/O pin ....................................................................................................25 mA
Maximum current sunk by all ports .......................................................................................................................200 mA
Maximum current sourced by all ports (Note 2)....................................................................................................200 mA
Note 1: Voltage spikes below VSS at the MCLR pin, inducing currents greater than 80 mA, may cause latch-up.
Thus, a series resistor of 50-100Ω should be used when applying a “low” level to the MCLR/ pin, rather than
pulling this pin directly to VSS.
2: Maximum allowable current is a function of device maximum power dissipation (see Table 24-2).
†NOTICE:
Stresses above those listed under “Absolute Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent damage to the
device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at those or any other conditions above those
indicated in the operation listings of this specification is not implied. Exposure to maximum rating conditions for
extended periods may affect device reliability.
24.1
DC Characteristics
TABLE 24-1:
OPERATING MIPS VS. VOLTAGE
Max MIPS
VDD Range
Temp Range
dsPIC30F401X-30I
dsPIC30F401X-20E
4.5-5.5V
-40°C to +85°C
30
—
4.5-5.5V
-40°C to +125°C
—
20
3.0-3.6V
-40°C to +85°C
20
—
3.0-3.6V
-40°C to +125°C
—
15
2.5-3.0V
-40°C to +85°C
10
—
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 171
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-2:
THERMAL OPERATING CONDITIONS
Rating
Symbol
Min
Operating Junction Temperature Range
TJ
Operating Ambient Temperature Range
TA
Operating Junction Temperature Range
Operating Ambient Temperature Range
Typ
Max
Unit
-40
+125
°C
-40
+85
°C
TJ
-40
+150
°C
TA
-40
+125
°C
dsPIC30F401X-30I
dsPIC30F401X-20E
Power Dissipation:
Internal Chip Power Dissipation:
PINT = VDD X (IDD – ∑ IOH)
PD
PINT + PI/O
W
PDMAX
(TJ – TA)/θJA
W
I/O Pin power dissipation:
PI/O = ∑ ({VDD – VOH} X IOH) + ∑ (VOL X IOL)
Maximum Allowed Power Dissipation
TABLE 24-3:
THERMAL PACKAGING CHARACTERISTICS
Characteristic
Symbol
Typ
Package Thermal Resistance, 28-pin SPDIP (SP)
θJA
Package Thermal Resistance, 28-pin SOIC (SO)
Package Thermal Resistance, 40-pin PDIP (P)
Unit
Notes
41
°C/W
1
θJA
45
°C/W
1
θJA
37
°C/W
1
Package Thermal Resistance, 44-pin TQFP, 10x10x1 mm (PT)
θJA
40
°C/W
1
Package Thermal Resistance, 44-pin QFN (ML)
θJA
28
°C/W
1
Note 1:
Max
Junction to ambient thermal resistance, Theta-ja (θJA) numbers are achieved by package simulations.
TABLE 24-4:
DC TEMPERATURE AND VOLTAGE SPECIFICATIONS
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Min
Typ(1)
Max
Units
Conditions
Operating Voltage(2)
DC10
VDD
Supply Voltage
2.5
—
5.5
V
Industrial temperature
DC11
VDD
Supply Voltage
3.0
—
5.5
V
Extended temperature
DC12
VDR
RAM Data Retention
Voltage(3)
—
1.5
—
V
DC16
VPOR
VDD Start Voltage
to ensure internal
Power-on Reset signal
—
VSS
—
V
DC17
SVDD
VDD Rise Rate
to ensure internal
Power-on Reset signal
0.05
—
—
Note 1:
2:
3:
V/ms 0-5V in 0.1 sec,
0-3V in 60 ms
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
This is the limit to which VDD can be lowered without losing RAM data.
DS70135E-page 172
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-5:
DC CHARACTERISTICS: OPERATING CURRENT (IDD)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Parameter
No.
Typical(1)
Max
Units
Conditions
Operating Current (IDD)(2)
DC31a
2
4
mA
+25°C
DC31b
2
4
mA
+85°C
DC31c
2
4
mA
+125°C
DC31e
3
5
mA
+25°C
DC31f
3
5
mA
+85°C
DC31g
3
5
mA
+125°C
DC30a
4
6
mA
+25°C
DC30b
4
6
mA
+85°C
DC30c
4
6
mA
+125°C
DC30e
7
10
mA
+25°C
DC30f
7
10
mA
+85°C
DC30g
7
10
mA
+125°C
DC23a
12
19
mA
+25°C
DC23b
12
19
mA
+85°C
DC23c
13
19
mA
+125°C
DC23e
19
31
mA
+25°C
DC23f
20
31
mA
+85°C
DC23g
20
31
mA
+125°C
DC24a
28
39
mA
+25°C
DC24b
28
39
mA
+85°C
DC24c
29
39
mA
+125°C
DC24e
46
64
mA
+25°C
DC24f
46
64
mA
+85°C
DC24g
47
64
mA
+125°C
DC27a
53
72
mA
+25°C
DC27b
53
72
mA
+85°C
DC27d
87
120
mA
+25°C
DC27e
87
120
mA
+85°C
DC27f
87
120
mA
+125°C
DC29a
124
170
mA
+25°C
DC29b
125
170
mA
+85°C
Note 1:
2:
3.3V
0.128 MIPS
LPRC (512 kHz)
5V
3.3V
(1.8 MIPS)
FRC (7.37 MHz)
5V
3.3V
4 MIPS
5V
3.3V
10 MIPS
5V
3.3V
20 MIPS
5V
5V
30 MIPS
Data in “Typical” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only
and are not tested.
The supply current is mainly a function of the operating voltage and frequency. Other factors, such as I/O
pin loading and switching rate, oscillator type, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have
an impact on the current consumption. The test conditions for all IDD measurements are as follows: OSC1
driven with external square wave from rail to rail. All I/O pins are configured as inputs and pulled to VDD.
MCLR = VDD, WDT, FSCM, LVD and BOR are disabled. CPU, SRAM, program memory and data memory
are operational. No peripheral modules are operating.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 173
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-6:
DC CHARACTERISTICS: IDLE CURRENT (IIDLE)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Parameter
No.
Typical(1,2)
Max
Units
Conditions
Operating Current (IDD)(3)
DC51a
1.3
3
mA
+25°C
DC51b
1.3
3
mA
+85°C
DC51c
1.3
3
mA
+125°C
DC51e
2.7
5
mA
+25°C
DC51f
2.7
5
mA
+85°C
DC51g
2.7
5
mA
+125°C
DC50a
4
6
mA
+25°C
DC50b
4
6
mA
+85°C
DC50c
4
6
mA
+125°C
DC50e
7
11
mA
+25°C
DC50f
7
11
mA
+85°C
DC50g
7
11
mA
+125°C
DC43a
7
11
mA
+25°C
DC43b
7
11
mA
+85°C
DC43c
7
11
mA
+125°C
DC43e
12
17
mA
+25°C
DC43f
12
17
mA
+85°C
DC43g
12
17
mA
+125°C
DC44a
15
22
mA
+25°C
DC44b
15
22
mA
+85°C
DC44c
16
22
mA
+125°C
DC44e
26
36
mA
+25°C
DC44f
27
36
mA
+85°C
DC44g
27
36
mA
+125°C
DC47a
30
40
mA
+25°C
DC47b
30
40
mA
+85°C
DC47d
50
65
mA
+25°C
DC47e
50
65
mA
+85°C
DC47f
51
65
mA
+125°C
DC49a
72
95
mA
+25°C
DC49b
73
95
mA
+85°C
Note 1:
2:
3.3V
0.128 MIPS
LPRC (512 kHz)
5V
3.3V
(1.8 MIPS)
FRC (7.37 MHz)
5V
3.3V
4 MIPS
5V
3.3V
10 MIPS
5V
3.3V
20 MIPS
5V
5V
30 MIPS
Data in “Typical” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only
and are not tested.
Base IIDLE current is measured with core off, clock on and all modules turned off.
DS70135E-page 174
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-7:
DC CHARACTERISTICS: POWER-DOWN CURRENT (IPD)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Parameter
No.
Typical(1)
Max
Units
—
μA
Conditions
Power-Down Current (IPD)(2)
DC60a
0.3
25°C
DC60b
1
30
μA
85°C
DC60c
12
60
μA
125°C
DC60e
0.5
—
μA
25°C
DC60f
2
45
μA
85°C
DC60g
17
90
μA
125°C
DC61a
5
8
μA
25°C
DC61b
5
8
μA
85°C
DC61c
6
9
μA
125°C
DC61e
10
15
μA
25°C
DC61f
10
15
μA
85°C
DC61g
11
17
μA
125°C
DC62a
4
10
μA
25°C
DC62b
5
10
μA
85°C
DC62c
4
10
μA
125°C
DC62e
4
15
μA
25°C
DC62f
6
15
μA
85°C
DC62g
5
15
μA
125°C
DC63a
32
48
μA
25°C
DC63b
35
53
μA
85°C
DC63c
37
56
μA
125°C
DC63e
37
56
μA
25°C
DC63f
41
62
μA
85°C
57
86
μA
125°C
DC63g
Note 1:
2:
3.3V
Base power-down current(3)
5V
3.3V
Watchdog Timer current: ΔIWDT(3)
5V
3.3V
Timer1 w/32 kHz crystal: ΔITI32(3)
5V
3.3V
BOR on: ΔIBOR(3)
5V
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 175
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-8:
DC CHARACTERISTICS: I/O PIN INPUT SPECIFICATIONS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Min
Typ(1)
Max
Units
I/O pins:
with Schmitt Trigger buffer
VSS
—
0.2 VDD
V
DI15
MCLR
VSS
—
0.2 VDD
V
DI16
OSC1 (in XT, HS and LP modes)
VSS
—
0.2 VDD
V
DI17
OSC1 (in RC mode)(3)
VSS
—
0.3 VDD
V
DI18
SDA, SCL
VSS
—
0.3 VDD
V
SMBus disabled
DI19
SDA, SCL
VSS
—
0.2 VDD
V
SMBus enabled
I/O pins:
with Schmitt Trigger buffer
0.8 VDD
—
VDD
V
DI25
MCLR
0.8 VDD
—
VDD
V
DI26
OSC1 (in XT, HS and LP modes) 0.7 VDD
—
VDD
V
DI27
OSC1 (in RC mode)
(3)
0.9 VDD
—
VDD
V
DI28
SDA, SCL
0.7 VDD
—
VDD
V
SDA, SCL
0.8 VDD
—
VDD
V
SMBus enabled
50
250
400
μA
VDD = 5V, VPIN = VSS
VIL
DI10
VIH
DI20
DI29
DI30
Characteristic
Conditions
Input Low Voltage(2)
(2)
Input High Voltage
ICNPU
CNXX Pull-up Current(2)
IIL
Input Leakage Current(2,4,5)
SMBus disabled
DI50
I/O ports
—
0.01
±1
μA
VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD,
Pin at high-impedance
DI51
Analog input pins
—
0.50
—
μA
VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD,
Pin at high-impedance
DI55
MCLR
—
0.05
±5
μA
VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD
DI56
OSC1
—
0.05
±5
μA
VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD,
XT, HS and LP Osc mode
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
In RC oscillator configuration, the OSC1/CLKl pin is a Schmitt Trigger input. It is not recommended that the
dsPIC30F device be driven with an external clock while in RC mode.
The leakage current on the MCLR pin is strongly dependent on the applied voltage level. The specified levels represent normal operating conditions. Higher leakage current may be measured at different input voltages.
Negative current is defined as current sourced by the pin.
DS70135E-page 176
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-9:
DC CHARACTERISTICS: I/O PIN OUTPUT SPECIFICATIONS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
VOL
DO10
Characteristic
VOH
Typ(1)
Max
Units
Conditions
Output Low Voltage(2)
I/O ports
DO16
Min
—
—
0.6
V
IOL = 8.5 mA, VDD = 5V
—
—
TBD
V
IOL = 2.0 mA, VDD = 3V
OSC2/CLKO
—
—
0.6
V
IOL = 1.6 mA, VDD = 5V
(RC or EC Osc mode)
—
—
TBD
V
IOL = 2.0 mA, VDD = 3V
(2)
Output High Voltage
DO20
I/O ports
VDD – 0.7
—
—
V
IOH = -3.0 mA, VDD = 5V
TBD
—
—
V
IOH = -2.0 mA, VDD = 3V
DO26
OSC2/CLKO
VDD – 0.7
—
—
V
IOH = -1.3 mA, VDD = 5V
TBD
—
—
V
IOH = -2.0 mA, VDD = 3V
15
pF
In XTL, XT, HS and LP modes
when external clock is used to
drive OSC1
(RC or EC Osc mode)
Capacitive Loading Specs
on Output Pins(2)
DO50
COSC2
OSC2/SOSC2 pin
—
—
DO56
CIO
All I/O pins and OSC2
—
—
50
pF
RC or EC Osc mode
DO58
CB
SCL, SDA
—
—
400
pF
In I2C™ mode
Note 1:
2:
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
FIGURE 24-1:
BROWN-OUT RESET CHARACTERISTICS
VDD
BO10
(Device in Brown-out Reset)
BO15
(Device not in Brown-out Reset)
Reset (due to BOR)
Power-up Time-out
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 177
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-10: ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS: BOR
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
BO10
VBOR
BO15
Min
Typ(1)
Max
Units
Conditions
BORV = 11(3)
—
—
—
V
Not in operating range
BORV = 10
2.6
—
2.71
V
BORV = 01
4.1
—
4.4
V
BORV = 00
4.58
—
4.73
V
—
5
—
mV
Characteristic
BOR Voltage on
VDD Transition
High-to-Low(2)
VBHYS
Note 1:
2:
3:
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
‘11’ values not in usable operating range.
TABLE 24-11: DC CHARACTERISTICS: PROGRAM AND EEPROM
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Min
Typ(1)
Max
Units
Conditions
Data EEPROM Memory(2)
E/W -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
D120
ED
Byte Endurance
100K
1M
—
D121
VDRW
VDD for Read/Write
VMIN
—
5.5
V
D122
TDEW
Erase/Write Cycle Time
—
2
—
ms
D123
TRETD
Characteristic Retention
40
100
—
Year Provided no other specifications are
violated
D124
IDEW
IDD During Programming
—
10
30
mA
E/W -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
Program Flash
Using EECON to read/write,
VMIN = Minimum operating voltage
Row Erase
Memory(2)
D130
EP
Cell Endurance
10K
100K
—
D131
VPR
VDD for Read
VMIN
—
5.5
V
D132
VEB
VDD for Bulk Erase
4.5
—
5.5
V
D133
VPEW
VDD for Erase/Write
3.0
—
5.5
V
D134
TPEW
Erase/Write Cycle Time
—
2
—
ms
D135
TRETD
Characteristic Retention
40
100
—
D136
TEB
ICSP™ Block Erase Time
—
4
—
ms
D137
IPEW
IDD During Programming
—
10
30
mA
Row Erase
D138
IEB
IDD During Programming
—
10
30
mA
Bulk Erase
Note 1:
2:
VMIN = Minimum operating voltage
Year Provided no other specifications are
violated
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated.
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
DS70135E-page 178
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
24.2
AC Characteristics and Timing Parameters
The information contained in this section defines dsPIC30F AC characteristics and timing parameters.
TABLE 24-12: TEMPERATURE AND VOLTAGE SPECIFICATIONS – AC
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Operating voltage VDD range as described in Section 24.0 “Electrical
Characteristics”.
AC CHARACTERISTICS
FIGURE 24-2:
LOAD CONDITIONS FOR DEVICE TIMING SPECIFICATIONS
Load Condition 1 – for all pins except OSC2
Load Condition 2 – for OSC2
VDD/2
CL
Pin
RL
VSS
CL
Pin
RL = 464Ω
CL = 50 pF for all pins except OSC2
5 pF for OSC2 output
VSS
FIGURE 24-3:
EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
OSC1
OS20
OS30
OS25
OS30
OS31
OS31
CLKO
OS40
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
OS41
DS70135E-page 179
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-13: EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
OS10
FOSC
Characteristic
Min
Typ(1)
Max
Units
External CLKI Frequency
(external clocks allowed only
in EC mode)(2)
DC
4
4
4
—
—
—
—
40
10
10
7.5
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
EC
EC with 4x PLL
EC with 8x PLL
EC with 16x PLL
Oscillator Frequency(2)
DC
0.4
4
4
4
4
10
31
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
7.37
512
4
4
10
10
10
7.5
25
33
—
—
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
kHz
MHz
kHz
RC
XTL
XT
XT with 4x PLL
XT with 8x PLL
XT with 16x PLL
HS
LP
FRC internal
LPRC internal
Conditions
OS20
TOSC
TOSC = 1/FOSC
—
—
—
—
See parameter OS10
for FOSC value
OS25
TCY
Instruction Cycle Time(2,3)
33
—
DC
ns
See Table 24-16
OS30
TosL,
TosH
External Clock in (OSC1)
High or Low Time(2)
.45 x TOSC
—
—
ns
EC
OS31
TosR,
TosF
External Clock in (OSC1)
Rise or Fall Time(2)
—
—
20
ns
EC
OS40
TckR
CLKO Rise Time(2,4)
—
—
—
ns
See parameter D031
—
—
—
ns
See parameter D032
OS41
TckF
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
(2,4)
CLKO Fall Time
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Instruction cycle period (TCY) equals four times the input oscillator time base period. All specified values
are based on characterization data for that particular oscillator type under standard operating conditions
with the device executing code. Exceeding these specified limits may result in an unstable oscillator
operation and/or higher than expected current consumption. All devices are tested to operate at “min.”
values with an external clock applied to the OSC1/CLKI pin. When an external clock input is used, the
“Max.” cycle time limit is “DC” (no clock) for all devices.
Measurements are taken in EC or ERC modes. The CLKO signal is measured on the OSC2 pin. CLKO is
low for the Q1-Q2 period (1/2 TCY) and high for the Q3-Q4 period (1/2 TCY).
DS70135E-page 180
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-14: PLL CLOCK TIMING SPECIFICATIONS (VDD = 2.5 TO 5.5V)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
—
—
—
—
—
—
10
10
7.5(3)
10
10
7.5(3)
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
EC with 4x PLL
EC with 8x PLL
EC with 16x PLL
XT with 4x PLL
XT with 8x PLL
XT with 16x PLL
EC, XT with PLL
OS50
FPLLI
PLL Input Frequency Range(2)
4
4
4
4
4
4
OS51
FSYS
On-Chip PLL Output(2)
16
—
120
MHz
OS52
TLOC
PLL Start-up Time (Lock Time)
—
20
50
μs
Note 1:
2:
3:
Conditions
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
Limited by device operating frequency range.
TABLE 24-15: PLL JITTER
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
OS61
Characteristic
x4 PLL
x8 PLL
x16 PLL
Note 1:
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Min
Typ(1)
Max
Units
Conditions
—
0.251
0.413
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 3.0 to 3.6V
—
0.251
0.413
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 3.0 to 3.6V
—
0.256
0.47
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
—
0.256
0.47
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
—
0.355
0.584
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 3.0 to 3.6V
—
0.355
0.584
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 3.0 to 3.6V
—
0.362
0.664
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
—
0.362
0.664
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
—
0.67
0.92
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 3.0 to 3.6V
—
0.632
0.956
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
—
0.632
0.956
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 181
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-16: INTERNAL CLOCK TIMING EXAMPLES
Clock
Oscillator
Mode
FOSC
(MHz)(1)
TCY (μsec)(2)
MIPS
w/o PLL(3)
MIPS
w/PLL x4(3)
MIPS
w/PLL x8(3)
MIPS
w/PLL x16(3)
EC
0.200
20.0
0.05
—
—
—
XT
Note 1:
2:
3:
4
1.0
1.0
4.0
8.0
16.0
10
0.4
2.5
10.0
20.0
—
25
0.16
6.25
—
—
—
4
1.0
1.0
4.0
8.0
16.0
10
0.4
2.5
10.0
20.0
—
Assumption: Oscillator postscaler is divide by 1.
Instruction Execution Cycle Time: TCY = 1/MIPS.
Instruction Execution Frequency: MIPS = (FOSC * PLLx)/4, since there are 4 Q clocks per instruction cycle.
DS70135E-page 182
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-17: AC CHARACTERISTICS: INTERNAL RC JITTER
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Characteristic
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
Internal FRC Jitter @ FRC Freq. = 7.37 MHz(1)
OS62
FRC
—
+0.04
+0.16
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 3.0-3.6V
—
+0.07
+0.23
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
+1.50
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 3.0-5.5V
Internal FRC Accuracy @ FRC Freq. = 7.37 MHz(1)
OS63
FRC
—
Internal FRC Drift @ FRC Freq. = 7.37
OS64
Note 1:
2:
—
MHz(1)
-0.7
—
0.5
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 3.0-3.6V
-0.7
—
0.7
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 3.0-3.6V
-0.7
—
0.5
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
-0.7
—
0.7
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
Frequency calibrated at 7.372 MHz ±2%, 25°C and 5V. TUN<3:0> bits can be used to compensate for
temperature drift.
Overall FRC variation can be calculated by adding the absolute values of jitter, accuracy and drift
percentages.
TABLE 24-18: INTERNAL RC ACCURACY
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Characteristic
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Min
Typ
Max
Units
-35
—
+35
%
Conditions
LPRC @ Freq. = 512 kHz(1)
OS65
Note 1:
Change of LPRC frequency as VDD changes.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 183
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-4:
CLKO AND I/O TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
I/O Pin
(Input)
DI35
DI40
I/O Pin
(Output)
New Value
Old Value
DO31
DO32
Note: Refer to Figure 24-2 for load conditions.
TABLE 24-19: CLKO AND I/O TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic(1,2,3)
Min
Typ(4)
Max
Units
—
7
20
ns
DO31
TIOR
DO32
TIOF
Port Output Fall Time
—
7
20
ns
DI35
TINP
INTx Pin High or Low Time (output)
20
—
—
ns
DI40
TRBP
CNx High or Low Time (input)
2 TCY
—
—
ns
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
Port Output Rise Time
Conditions
These parameters are asynchronous events not related to any internal clock edges
Measurements are taken in RC mode and EC mode where CLKO output is 4 x TOSC.
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated.
DS70135E-page 184
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-5:
VDD
RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER AND POWER-UP
TIMER TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
SY12
MCLR
SY10
Internal
POR
SY11
PWRT
Time-out
Oscillator
Time-out
SY30
Internal
Reset
Watchdog
Timer
Reset
SY13
SY20
SY13
I/O Pins
SY35
FSCM
Delay
Note: Refer to Figure 24-2 for load conditions.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 185
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-20: RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER, POWER-UP TIMER
AND BROWN-OUT RESET TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
SY10
TmcL
MCLR Pulse Width (low)
2
—
—
μs
-40°C to +85°C
SY11
TPWRT
Power-up Timer Period
3
12
50
4
16
64
6
22
90
ms
-40°C to +85°C
User-programmable
SY12
TPOR
Power-on Reset Delay
3
10
30
μs
-40°C to +85°C
SY13
TIOZ
I/O High-Impedance from MCLR
Low or Watchdog Timer Reset
—
0.8
1.0
μs
SY20
TWDT1
Watchdog Timer Time-out
Period (no prescaler)
1.4
2.1
2.8
ms
VDD = 5V, -40°C to +85°C
1.4
2.1
2.8
ms
VDD = 3V, -40°C to +85°C
TWDT2
Width(3)
SY25
TBOR
Brown-out Reset Pulse
100
—
—
μs
VDD ≤ VBOR (D034)
SY30
TOST
Oscillation Start-up Timer Period
—
1024 TOSC
—
—
TOSC = OSC1 period
SY35
TFSCM
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor Delay
—
500
900
μs
-40°C to +85°C
Note 1:
2:
3:
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated.
Refer to Figure 24-1 and Table 24-10 for BOR.
FIGURE 24-6:
BAND GAP START-UP TIME CHARACTERISTICS
VBGAP
0V
Enable
Band Gap(1)
Band Gap
Stable
SY40
Note 1:
Note: Band gap is enabled when FBORPOR<7> is set.
TABLE 24-21: BAND GAP START-UP TIME REQUIREMENTS
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Param
No.
Symbol
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
SY40
TBGAP
—
40
65
μs
Note 1:
2:
Characteristic(1)
Band Gap
Start-up Time
Conditions
Defined as the time between the instant
that the band gap is enabled and the
moment that the band gap reference
voltage is stable (RCON<13> status bit)
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated.
DS70135E-page 186
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-7:
TIMERx EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
TxCK
Tx11
Tx10
Tx15
Tx20
OS60
TMRx
Note: Refer to Figure 24-2 for load conditions.
TABLE 24-22: TIMER1 EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
TA10
TA11
TA15
Symbol
TTXH
TTXL
TTXP
Characteristic
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Synchronous,
no prescaler
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
ns
Synchronous,
with prescaler
10
—
—
ns
Asynchronous
10
—
—
ns
Synchronous,
no prescaler
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
ns
Synchronous,
with prescaler
10
—
—
ns
Asynchronous
10
—
—
ns
Synchronous,
no prescaler
TCY + 10
—
—
ns
Synchronous,
with prescaler
Greater of:
20 ns or
(TCY + 40)/N
—
—
—
Asynchronous
20
—
—
ns
SOSCO/T1CK Oscillator
Input frequency Range
(oscillator enabled by setting
bit, TCS (T1CON<1>)
DC
—
50
kHz
0.5 TCY
—
1.5 TCY
—
T1CK High
Time
T1CK Low
Time
T1CK Input
Period
OS60
Ft1
TA20
TCKEXTMRL Delay from External T1CK
Clock Edge to Timer
Increment
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
Conditions
Must also meet
parameter TA15
Must also meet
parameter TA15
N = prescale value
(1, 8, 64, 256)
DS70135E-page 187
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-23: TIMER2 AND TIMER4 EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
TB10
TB11
TB15
TB20
Symbol
TTXH
TTXL
TTXP
Characteristic
TxCK High Time
TxCK Low Time
TxCK Input
Period
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
Synchronous,
no prescaler
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
ns
Must also meet
parameter TB15
Synchronous,
with prescaler
10
—
—
ns
Synchronous,
no prescaler
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
ns
Synchronous,
with prescaler
10
—
—
ns
Synchronous,
no prescaler
TCY + 10
—
—
ns
Synchronous,
with prescaler
Greater of:
20 ns or
(TCY + 40)/N
1.5 TCY
—
TCKEXTMRL Delay from External TxCK Clock
Edge to Timer Increment
0.5 TCY
Must also meet
parameter TB15
N = prescale
value
(1, 8, 64, 256)
TABLE 24-24: TIMER3 AND TIMER5 EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
TC10
TtxH
TxCK High Time
Synchronous
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
ns
Must also meet
parameter TC15
TC11
TtxL
TxCK Low Time
Synchronous
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
ns
Must also meet
parameter TC15
TC15
TtxP
TxCK Input Period Synchronous,
no prescaler
TCY + 10
—
—
ns
N = prescale
value
(1, 8, 64, 256)
—
1.5 TCY
—
Synchronous,
with prescaler
TC20
TCKEXTMRL Delay from External TxCK Clock
Edge to Timer Increment
DS70135E-page 188
Greater of:
20 ns or
(TCY + 40)/N
0.5 TCY
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-8:
QEI MODULE EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
QEB
TQ11
TQ10
TQ15
TQ20
POSCNT
TABLE 24-25: QEI MODULE EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
TQ10
TtQH
TxCK High Time
Synchronous,
with prescaler
TCY + 20
—
—
ns
Must also meet
parameter TQ15
TQ11
TtQL
TxCK Low Time
Synchronous,
with prescaler
TCY + 20
—
—
ns
Must also meet
parameter TQ15
TQ15
TtQP
TxCK Input Period Synchronous, 2 * TCY + 40
with prescaler
—
—
ns
TQ20
TCKEXTMRL Delay from External TxCK Clock
Edge to Timer Increment
—
1.5 TCY
ns
Note 1:
0.5 TCY
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 189
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-9:
INPUT CAPTURE TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
ICX
IC10
IC11
IC15
Note: Refer to Figure 24-2 for load conditions.
TABLE 24-26: INPUT CAPTURE TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
IC10
TccL
ICx Input Low Time
IC11
TccH
ICx Input High Time
IC15
TccP
ICx Input Period
Characteristic(1)
No prescaler
Min
Max
Units
0.5 TCY + 20
—
ns
With prescaler
No prescaler
10
—
ns
0.5 TCY + 20
—
ns
10
—
ns
(2 TCY + 40)/N
—
ns
With prescaler
Note 1:
Conditions
N = prescale
value (1, 4, 16)
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
DS70135E-page 190
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-10:
OUTPUT COMPARE MODULE TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
OCx
(Output Compare
or PWM Mode)
OC10
OC11
Note: Refer to Figure 24-2 for load conditions.
TABLE 24-27: OUTPUT COMPARE MODULE TIMING REQUIREMENTS
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic(1)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
OC10
TccF
OCx Output Fall Time
—
—
—
ns
See parameter DO32
OC11
TccR
OCx Output Rise Time
—
—
—
ns
See parameter DO31
Note 1:
2:
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 191
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-11:
OUTPUT COMPARE/PWM MODULE TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
OC20
OCFA
OC15
OCx
TABLE 24-28: SIMPLE OUTPUT COMPARE/PWM MODE TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
OC15
TFD
Fault Input to PWM I/O
Change
—
—
50
ns
OC20
TFLT
Fault Input Pulse Width
50
—
—
ns
Note 1:
2:
Conditions
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
DS70135E-page 192
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-12:
MOTOR CONTROL PWM MODULE FAULT TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
MP30
FLTA
MP20
PWMx
FIGURE 24-13:
MOTOR CONTROL PWM MODULE TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
MP11 MP10
PWMx
Note: Refer to Figure 24-2 for load conditions.
TABLE 24-29: MOTOR CONTROL PWM MODULE TIMING REQUIREMENTS
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
MP10
TFPWM
PWM Output Fall Time
—
—
—
ns
See parameter DO32
MP11
TRPWM
PWM Output Rise
Time
—
—
—
ns
See parameter DO31
MP20
TFD
Fault Input ↓ to PWM
I/O Change
—
—
50
ns
MP30
TFH
Minimum Pulse Width
50
—
—
ns
Note 1:
2:
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 193
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-14:
QEA/QEB INPUT CHARACTERISTICS
TQ36
QEA
(input)
TQ30
TQ31
TQ35
QEB
(input)
TQ41
TQ40
TQ30
TQ31
TQ35
QEB
Internal
TABLE 24-30: QUADRATURE DECODER TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic(1)
Typ(2)
Max
Units
6 TCY
—
ns
Conditions
TQ30
TQUL
Quadrature Input Low Time
TQ31
TQUH
Quadrature Input High Time
6 TCY
—
ns
TQ35
TQUIN
Quadrature Input Period
12 TCY
—
ns
TQ36
TQUP
Quadrature Phase Period
3 TCY
—
ns
TQ40
TQUFL
Filter Time to Recognize Low,
with Digital Filter
3 * N * TCY
—
ns
N = 1, 2, 4, 16, 32, 64, 128
and 256 (Note 2)
TQ41
TQUFH
Filter Time to Recognize High,
with Digital Filter
3 * N * TCY
—
ns
N = 1, 2, 4, 16, 32, 64, 128
and 256 (Note 2)
Note 1:
2:
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
N = Index Channel Digital Filter Clock Divide Select bits. Refer to Section 16. “Quadrature Encoder
Interface (QEI)” in the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046).
DS70135E-page 194
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-15:
QEI MODULE INDEX PULSE TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
QEA
(input)
QEB
(input)
Ungated
Index
TQ50
TQ51
Index Internal
TQ55
Position Counter
Reset
TABLE 24-31: QEI INDEX PULSE TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic(1)
Min
Max
Units
Conditions
TQ50
TqIL
Filter Time to Recognize Low,
with Digital Filter
3 * N * TCY
—
ns
N = 1, 2, 4, 16, 32, 64,
128 and 256 (Note 2)
TQ51
TqiH
Filter Time to Recognize High,
with Digital Filter
3 * N * TCY
—
ns
N = 1, 2, 4, 16, 32, 64,
128 and 256 (Note 2)
TQ55
Tqidxr
Index Pulse Recognized to Position
Counter Reset (ungated index)
3 TCY
—
ns
Note 1:
2:
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Alignment of index pulses to QEA and QEB is shown for position counter Reset timing only. Shown for
forward direction only (QEA leads QEB). Same timing applies for reverse direction (QEA lags QEB) but
index pulse recognition occurs on falling edge.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 195
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-16:
SPI MODULE MASTER MODE (CKE = 0) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
SCK1
(CKP = 0)
SP11
SP10
SP21
SP20
SP20
SP21
SCK1
(CKP = 1)
SP35
SP31
SDI1
LSb
Bit 14 - - - - - -1
MSb
SDO1
SP30
MSb In
LSb In
Bit 14 - - - -1
SP40 SP41
Note: Refer to Figure 24-2 for load conditions.
TABLE 24-32: SPI MASTER MODE (CKE = 0) TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
—
—
ns
Conditions
TscL
SCK1 Output Low Time(3)
TCY/2
SP11
TscH
SCK1 Output High
Time(3)
TCY/2
—
—
ns
SP20
TscF
SCK1 Output Fall Time(4
—
—
—
ns
See parameter DO32
SP10
Time(4)
SP21
TscR
SCK1 Output Rise
—
—
—
ns
See parameter DO31
SP30
TdoF
SDO1 Data Output Fall Time(4)
—
—
—
ns
See parameter DO32
SP31
TdoR
SDO1 Data Output Rise
Time(4)
—
—
—
ns
See parameter DO31
SP35
TscH2doV,
TscL2doV
SDO1 Data Output Valid after
SCK1 Edge
—
—
30
ns
SP40
TdiV2scH,
TdiV2scL
Setup Time of SDI1 Data Input
to SCK1 Edge
20
—
—
ns
SP41
TscH2diL,
TscL2diL
Hold Time of SDI1 Data Input
to SCK1 Edge
20
—
—
ns
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
The minimum clock period for SCK1 is 100 ns. Therefore, the clock generated in Master mode must not
violate this specification.
Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI pins.
DS70135E-page 196
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-17:
SPI MODULE MASTER MODE (CKE =1) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
SP36
SCK1
(CKP = 0)
SP11
SP10
SP21
SP20
SP20
SP21
SCK1
(CKP = 1)
SP35
SP40
SDI1
LSb
Bit 14 - - - - - -1
MSb
SDO1
SP30,SP31
Bit 14 - - - -1
MSb In
LSb In
SP41
Note: Refer to Figure 24-2 for load conditions.
TABLE 24-33: SPI MODULE MASTER MODE (CKE = 1) TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
—
—
ns
Conditions
TscL
SCK1 Output Low Time(3)
TCY/2
SP11
TscH
SCK1 Output High Time
(3)
TCY/2
—
—
ns
SP20
TscF
SCK1 Output Fall Time(4)
—
—
—
ns
See parameter DO32
SP10
Time(4)
SP21
TscR
SCK1 Output Rise
—
—
—
ns
See parameter DO31
SP30
TdoF
SDO1 Data Output Fall
Time(4)
—
—
—
ns
See parameter DO32
SP31
TdoR
SDO1 Data Output Rise
Time(4)
—
—
—
ns
See parameter DO31
SP35
TscH2doV, SDO1 Data Output Valid after
TscL2doV SCK1 Edge
—
—
30
ns
SP36
TdoV2sc, SDO1 Data Output Setup to
TdoV2scL First SCK1 Edge
30
—
—
ns
SP40
TdiV2scH, Setup Time of SDI1 Data
TdiV2scL Input to SCK1 Edge
20
—
—
ns
SP41
TscH2diL,
TscL2diL
20
—
—
ns
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
Hold Time of SDI1 Data Input
to SCK1 Edge
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
The minimum clock period for SCK1 is 100 ns. Therefore, the clock generated in Master mode must not
violate this specification.
Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI pins.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 197
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-18:
SPI MODULE SLAVE MODE (CKE = 0) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
SS1
SP52
SP50
SCK1
(CKP = 0)
SP71
SP70
SP73
SP72
SP72
SP73
SCK1
(CKP = 1)
SP35
SDO1
MSb
Bit 14 - - - - - -1
LSb
SP51
SP30,SP31
SDI1
SDI
MSb In
Bit 14 - - - -1
LSb In
SP41
SP40
Note: Refer to Figure 24-2 for load conditions.
DS70135E-page 198
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-34: SPI MODULE SLAVE MODE (CKE = 0) TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
SP70
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
SCK1 Input Low Time
30
—
—
ns
Symbol
TscL
Conditions
SP71
TscH
SCK1 Input High Time
30
—
—
ns
SP72
TscF
SCK1 Input Fall Time(3)
—
10
25
ns
SP73
TscR
SCK1 Input Rise Time(3)
—
10
25
ns
SP30
TdoF
SDO1 Data Output Fall Time(3)
—
—
—
ns
See DO32
See DO31
(3)
SP31
TdoR
SDO1 Data Output Rise Time
—
—
—
ns
SP35
TscH2doV, SDO1 Data Output Valid after
TscL2doV SCK1 Edge
—
—
30
ns
SP40
TdiV2scH, Setup Time of SDI1 Data Input
TdiV2scL to SCK1 Edge
20
—
—
ns
SP41
TscH2diL,
TscL2diL
20
—
—
ns
SP50
TssL2scH, SS1↓ to SCK1↑ or SCK1↓ Input
TssL2scL
120
—
—
ns
SP51
TssH2doZ SS1↑ to SDO1 Output
High-Impedance(3)
10
—
50
ns
SP52
TscH2ssH SS1 after SCK1 Edge
TscL2ssH
1.5 TCY + 40
—
—
ns
Note 1:
2:
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI pins.
3:
Hold Time of SDI1 Data Input
to SCK1 Edge
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 199
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-19:
SPI MODULE SLAVE MODE (CKE = 1) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
SP60
SS1
SP52
SP50
SCK1
(CKP = 0)
SP71
SP70
SP73
SP72
SP72
SP73
SCK1
(CKP = 1)
SP35
SP52
MSb
SDO1
Bit 14 - - - - - -1
LSb
SP30,SP31
SDI1
SDI
MSb In
SP51
Bit 14 - - - -1
LSb In
SP41
SP40
Note: Refer to Figure 24-2 for load conditions.
DS70135E-page 200
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-35: SPI MODULE SLAVE MODE (CKE = 1) TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
SP70
Symbol
TscL
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
SCK1 Input Low Time
30
—
—
ns
Conditions
SP71
TscH
SCK1 Input High Time
30
—
—
ns
SP72
TscF
SCK1 Input Fall Time(3)
—
10
25
ns
SP73
TscR
SCK1 Input Rise Time(3)
—
10
25
ns
SP30
TdoF
SDO1 Data Output Fall Time(3)
—
—
—
ns
See parameter DO32
See parameter DO31
(3)
SP31
TdoR
—
—
—
ns
SP35
TscH2doV, SDO1 Data Output Valid after
TscL2doV SCK1 Edge
—
—
30
ns
SP40
TdiV2scH, Setup Time of SDI1 Data Input
TdiV2scL to SCK1 Edge
20
—
—
ns
SP41
TscH2diL, Hold Time of SDI1 Data Input
TscL2diL to SCK1 Edge
20
—
—
ns
SP50
TssL2scH, SS1↓ to SCK1↓ or SCK1↑ Input
TssL2scL
120
—
—
ns
SP51
TssH2doZ SS1↑ to SDO1 Output
High-Impedance(4)
10
—
50
ns
SP52
TscH2ssH SS1↑ after SCK1 Edge
TscL2ssH
1.5 TCY + 40
—
—
ns
SP60
TssL2doV SDO1 Data Output Valid after
SS1 Edge
—
—
50
ns
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
SDO1 Data Output Rise Time
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
The minimum clock period for SCK1 is 100 ns. Therefore, the clock generated in Master mode must not
violate this specification.
Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI pins.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 201
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-20:
I2C™ BUS START/STOP BITS TIMING CHARACTERISTICS (MASTER MODE)
SCL
IM31
IM34
IM30
IM33
SDA
Stop
Condition
Start
Condition
Note: Refer to Figure 24-2 for load conditions.
FIGURE 24-21:
I2C™ BUS DATA TIMING CHARACTERISTICS (MASTER MODE)
IM20
IM21
IM11
IM10
SCL
IM11
IM26
IM10
IM25
IM33
SDA
In
IM40
IM40
IM45
SDA
Out
Note: Refer to Figure 24-2 for load conditions.
DS70135E-page 202
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-36: I2C™ BUS DATA TIMING REQUIREMENTS (MASTER MODE)
I
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
IM10
IM11
Min(1)
Max
Units
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
400 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
1 MHz mode(2)
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
Clock High Time 100 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
400 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
mode(2)
Characteristic
TLO:SCL Clock Low Time 100 kHz mode
THI:SCL
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
100 kHz mode
—
300
ns
400 kHz mode
20 + 0.1 CB
300
ns
1 MHz mode(2)
—
100
ns
100 kHz mode
—
1000
ns
400 kHz mode
20 + 0.1 CB
300
ns
1 MHz mode(2)
—
300
ns
100 kHz mode
250
—
ns
1 MHz
IM20
IM21
IM25
IM26
IM30
IM31
IM33
IM34
TF:SCL
TR:SCL
SDA and SCL
Fall Time
SDA and SCL
Rise Time
TSU:DAT Data Input
Setup Time
THD:DAT Data Input
Hold Time
TSU:STA
Start Condition
Setup Time
THD:STA Start Condition
Hold Time
TSU:STO Stop Condition
Setup Time
THD:STO Stop Condition
Hold Time
400 kHz mode
100
—
ns
1 MHz mode(2)
TBD
—
ns
100 kHz mode
0
—
ns
400 kHz mode
0
0.9
μs
1 MHz mode(2)
TBD
—
ns
100 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
400 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
1 MHz mode(2)
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
100 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
400 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
1 MHz mode(2)
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
100 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
400 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
1 MHz mode(2)
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
100 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
ns
400 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
ns
mode(2)
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
ns
100 kHz mode
—
3500
ns
400 kHz mode
—
1000
ns
1 MHz mode(2)
—
—
ns
1 MHz
IM40
IM45
IM50
TAA:SCL
Output Valid
From Clock
TBF:SDA Bus Free Time
CB
100 kHz mode
4.7
—
μs
400 kHz mode
1.3
—
μs
1 MHz mode(2)
TBD
—
μs
—
400
pF
Bus Capacitive Loading
Conditions
CB is specified to be
from 10 to 400 pF
CB is specified to be
from 10 to 400 pF
Only relevant for
Repeated Start
condition
After this period, the
first clock pulse is
generated
Time the bus must be
free before a new
transmission can start
Legend: TBD = To Be Determined
Note 1: BRG is the value of the I2C Baud Rate Generator. Refer to Section 21. “Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C™)”
in the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046).
2: Maximum pin capacitance = 10 pF for all I2C pins (for 1 MHz mode only).
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 203
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-22:
I2C™ BUS START/STOP BITS TIMING CHARACTERISTICS (SLAVE MODE)
SCL
IS34
IS31
IS30
IS33
SDA
Stop
Condition
Start
Condition
FIGURE 24-23:
I2C™ BUS DATA TIMING CHARACTERISTICS (SLAVE MODE)
IS20
IS21
IS11
IS10
SCL
IS30
IS26
IS31
IS25
IS33
SDA
In
IS40
IS40
IS45
SDA
Out
DS70135E-page 204
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-37: I2C™ BUS DATA TIMING REQUIREMENTS (SLAVE MODE)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
IS10
IS11
IS20
IS21
IS25
Symbol
TLO:SCL
THI:SCL
TF:SCL
TR:SCL
TSU:DAT
Characteristic
Clock Low Time
Clock High Time
SDA and SCL
Fall Time
SDA and SCL
Rise Time
Data Input
Setup Time
Min
Max
Units
100 kHz mode
4.7
—
μs
Device must operate at a
minimum of 1.5 MHz
400 kHz mode
1.3
—
μs
Device must operate at a
minimum of 10 MHz.
1 MHz mode(1)
0.5
—
μs
100 kHz mode
4.0
—
μs
Device must operate at a
minimum of 1.5 MHz
400 kHz mode
0.6
—
μs
Device must operate at a
minimum of 10 MHz
1 MHz mode(1)
0.5
—
μs
100 kHz mode
—
300
ns
400 kHz mode
20 + 0.1 CB
300
ns
1 MHz mode(1)
—
100
ns
100 kHz mode
—
1000
ns
400 kHz mode
20 + 0.1 CB
300
ns
1 MHz mode(1)
—
300
ns
100 kHz mode
250
—
ns
400 kHz mode
100
—
ns
mode(1)
1 MHz
IS26
IS30
IS31
IS33
IS34
IS40
THD:DAT
TSU:STA
THD:STA
TSU:STO
THD:STO
TAA:SCL
Data Input
Hold Time
Start Condition
Setup Time
Start Condition
Hold Time
Stop Condition
Setup Time
100
—
ns
100 kHz mode
0
—
ns
400 kHz mode
0
0.9
μs
1 MHz mode(1)
0
0.3
μs
100 kHz mode
4.7
—
μs
400 kHz mode
0.6
—
μs
1 MHz mode(1)
0.25
—
μs
100 kHz mode
4.0
—
μs
400 kHz mode
0.6
—
μs
1 MHz mode(1)
0.25
—
μs
100 kHz mode
4.7
—
μs
400 kHz mode
0.6
—
μs
1 MHz mode(1)
0.6
—
μs
Stop Condition
100 kHz mode
4000
—
ns
Hold Time
400 kHz mode
600
—
ns
1 MHz mode(1)
250
100 kHz mode
0
3500
ns
400 kHz mode
0
1000
ns
Output Valid
From Clock
IS50
Note 1:
TBF:SDA
CB
Bus Free Time
0
350
ns
4.7
—
μs
400 kHz mode
1.3
—
μs
1 MHz mode(1)
0.5
—
μs
—
400
pF
Bus Capacitive Loading
CB is specified to be from
10 to 400 pF
CB is specified to be from
10 to 400 pF
Only relevant for Repeated
Start condition
After this period, the first
clock pulse is generated
ns
100 kHz mode
1 MHz mode
IS45
(1)
Conditions
Time the bus must be free
before a new transmission
can start
Maximum pin capacitance = 10 pF for all I2C pins (for 1 MHz mode only).
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 205
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-24:
C1TX Pin
(output)
CAN MODULE I/O TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
New Value
Old Value
CA10 CA11
C1RX Pin
(input)
CA20
TABLE 24-38: CAN MODULE I/O TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
CA10
TioF
Port Output Fall Time
—
—
—
ns
See parameter DO32
CA11
TioR
Port Output Rise Time
—
—
—
ns
See parameter DO31
CA20
Tcwf
Pulse Width to Trigger
CAN Wake-up Filter
500
Note 1:
2:
ns
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
DS70135E-page 206
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-39: 10-BIT HIGH-SPEED A/D MODULE SPECIFICATIONS
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Min.
Typ
Max.
Units
Conditions
Device Supply
AD01
AVDD
Module VDD Supply
Greater of
VDD – 0.3
or 2.7
—
Lesser of
VDD + 0.3
or 5.5
V
AD02
AVSS
Module VSS Supply
VSS – 0.3
—
VSS + 0.3
V
VREFH
Reference Voltage High
AVSS + 2.7
—
AVDD
V
AVSS
—
AVDD – 2.7
V
—
AVDD + 0.3
V
—
200
.001
300
3
μA
μA
VREFL
—
VREFH
V
Reference Inputs
AD05
AD06
VREFL
Reference Voltage Low
AD07
VREF
Absolute Reference Voltage AVSS – 0.3
AD08
IREF
Current Drain
A/D operating
A/D off
Analog Input
AD10
VINH-VINL Full-Scale Input Span
AD11
VIN
Absolute Input Voltage
AVSS – 0.3
—
AVDD + 0.3
V
AD12
—
Leakage Current
—
±0.001
±0.244
μA
VINL = AVSS = VREFL = 0V,
AVDD = VREFH = 5V,
Source Impedance = 5 kΩ
AD13
—
Leakage Current
—
±0.001
±0.244
μA
VINL = AVSS = VREFL = 0V,
AVDD = VREFH = 3V,
Source Impedance = 5 kΩ
AD17
RIN
Recommended Impedance
of Analog Voltage Source
—
—
5K
Ω
DC Accuracy
AD20
Nr
Resolution
AD21
INL
Integral Nonlinearity(3)
—
±1
±1
LSb VINL = AVSS = VREFL = 0V,
AVDD = VREFH = 5V
AD21A INL
Integral Nonlinearity(3)
—
±1
±1
LSb VINL = AVSS = VREFL = 0V,
AVDD = VREFH = 3V
AD22
DNL
Differential Nonlinearity(3)
—
±1
±1
LSb VINL = AVSS = VREFL = 0V,
AVDD = VREFH = 5V
AD22A DNL
Differential Nonlinearity(3)
—
±1
±1
LSb VINL = AVSS = VREFL = 0V,
AVDD = VREFH = 3V
AD23
GERR
Gain Error(3)
±1
±5
±6
LSb VINL = AVSS = VREFL = 0V,
AVDD = VREFH = 5V
AD23A GERR
Gain Error(3)
±1
±5
±6
LSb VINL = AVSS = VREFL = 0V,
AVDD = VREFH = 3V
AD24
EOFF
Offset Error
±1
±2
±3
LSb VINL = AVSS = VREFL = 0V,
AVDD = VREFH = 5V
AD24A EOFF
Offset Error
±1
±2
±3
LSb VINL = AVSS = VREFL = 0V,
AVDD = VREFH = 3V
AD25
Monotonicity(2)
—
—
—
—
Note 1:
2:
3:
10 data bits
bits
—
Guaranteed
Because the sample caps will eventually lose charge, clock rates below 10 kHz can affect linearity
performance, especially at elevated temperatures.
The A/D conversion result never decreases with an increase in the input voltage and has no missing codes.
Measurements taken with external VREF+ and VREF- used as the ADC voltage references.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 207
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-39: 10-BIT HIGH-SPEED A/D MODULE SPECIFICATIONS (CONTINUED)
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Min.
Typ
Max.
Units
Conditions
Dynamic Performance
AD30
THD
Total Harmonic Distortion
—
-64
-67
dB
AD31
SINAD
Signal to Noise and
Distortion
—
57
58
dB
AD32
SFDR
Spurious Free Dynamic
Range
—
67
71
dB
AD33
FNYQ
Input Signal Bandwidth
—
—
500
kHz
AD34
ENOB
Effective Number of Bits
9.29
9.41
—
bits
Note 1:
2:
3:
Because the sample caps will eventually lose charge, clock rates below 10 kHz can affect linearity
performance, especially at elevated temperatures.
The A/D conversion result never decreases with an increase in the input voltage and has no missing codes.
Measurements taken with external VREF+ and VREF- used as the ADC voltage references.
DS70135E-page 208
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-25:
10-BIT HIGH-SPEED A/D CONVERSION TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
(CHPS<1:0> = 01, SIMSAM = 0, ASAM = 0, SSRC<2:0> = 000)
AD50
ADCLK
Instruction
Execution Set SAMP
Clear SAMP
SAMP
ch0_dischrg
ch0_samp
ch1_dischrg
ch1_samp
eoc
AD61
AD60
AD55
TSAMP
AD55
DONE
ADIF
ADRES(0)
ADRES(1)
1
2
3
4
5
6
8
9
5
6
8
9
1 - Software sets ADCONx. SAMP to start sampling.
2 - Sampling starts after discharge period.
TSAMP is described in Section 17. 10-Bit A/D Converter” in the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046).
3 - Software clears ADCONx. SAMP to start conversion.
4 - Sampling ends, conversion sequence starts.
5 - Convert bit 9.
6 - Convert bit 8.
8 - Convert bit 0.
9 - One TAD for end of conversion.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 209
dsPIC30F4011/4012
FIGURE 24-26:
10-BIT HIGH-SPEED A/D CONVERSION TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
(CHPS<1:0> = 01, SIMSAM = 0, ASAM = 1, SSRC<2:0> = 111, SAMC<4:0> = 00001)
AD50
ADCLK
Instruction
Execution Set ADON
SAMP
ch0_dischrg
ch0_samp
ch1_dischrg
ch1_samp
eoc
TSAMP
TSAMP
AD55
TCONV
AD55
DONE
ADIF
ADRES(0)
ADRES(1)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
3
4
5
6
8
3
4
1 - Software sets ADCONx. ADON to start AD operation.
5 - Convert bit 0.
2 - Sampling starts after discharge period.
TSAMP is described in Section 17. 10-Bit A/D Converter”
in the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046).
6 - One TAD for end of conversion.
3 - Convert bit 9.
8 - Sample for time specified by SAMC<4:0>.
7 - Begin conversion of next channel
4 - Convert bit 8.
DS70135E-page 210
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
TABLE 24-40: 10-BIT HIGH-SPEED A/D CONVERSION TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Min.
Typ
Max.
Units
—
84
—
ns
700
900
1100
ns
Conditions
Clock Parameters
AD50
TAD
A/D Clock Period
AD51
tRC
A/D Internal RC Oscillator Period
See Table 20-2(1)
Conversion Rate
AD55
tCONV
Conversion Time
—
12 TAD
—
—
—
AD56
FCNV
Throughput Rate
—
1.0
—
Msps
See Table 20-2(1)
AD57
TSAMP
Sample Time
—
1 TAD
—
—
See Table 20-2(1)
—
1.0 TAD
—
—
Timing Parameters
AD60
tPCS
Conversion Start from Sample
Trigger
AD61
tPSS
Sample Start from Setting
Sample (SAMP) Bit
0.5 TAD
—
1.5 TAD
—
AD62
tCSS
Conversion Completion to
Sample Start (ASAM = 1)
—
0.5 TAD
—
—
AD63
tDPU
Time to Stabilize Analog Stage
from A/D Off to A/D On
—
20
—
μs
Note 1:
Because the sample caps will eventually lose charge, clock rates below 10 kHz can affect linearity
performance, especially at elevated temperatures.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 211
dsPIC30F4011/4012
NOTES:
DS70135E-page 212
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
25.0
PACKAGING INFORMATION
25.1
Package Marking Information
28-Lead PDIP (Skinny DIP)
Example
dsPIC30F401230I/SP e3
0710017
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
YYWWNNN
28-Lead SOIC
Example
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
YYWWNNN
40-Lead PDIP
dsPIC30F401230I/SO e3
0710017
Example
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
YYWWNNN
Legend: XX...X
Y
YY
WW
NNN
e3
*
Note:
dsPIC30F401130I/P e3
0710017
Customer-specific information
Year code (last digit of calendar year)
Year code (last 2 digits of calendar year)
Week code (week of January 1 is week ‘01’)
Alphanumeric traceability code
Pb-free JEDEC designator for Matte Tin (Sn)
This package is Pb-free. The Pb-free JEDEC designator ( e3 )
can be found on the outer packaging for this package.
In the event the full Microchip part number cannot be marked on one line, it will
be carried over to the next line, thus limiting the number of available
characters for customer-specific information.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 213
dsPIC30F4011/4012
Package Marking Information (Continued)
44-Lead QFN
Example
XXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXX
YYWWNNN
dsPIC30F
4012-30I/
ML e3
0710017
44-Lead TQFP
Example
XXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXX
YYWWNNN
DS70135E-page 214
dsPIC30F
4011-30I/
PT e3
0710017
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
25.2
Package Details
28-Lead Skinny Plastic Dual In-Line (SP) – 300 mil Body [SPDIP]
Note:
For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
N
NOTE 1
E1
1
2 3
D
E
A2
A
L
c
b1
A1
b
e
eB
Units
Dimension Limits
Number of Pins
INCHES
MIN
N
NOM
MAX
28
Pitch
e
Top to Seating Plane
A
–
–
.200
Molded Package Thickness
A2
.120
.135
.150
Base to Seating Plane
A1
.015
–
–
Shoulder to Shoulder Width
E
.290
.310
.335
Molded Package Width
E1
.240
.285
.295
Overall Length
D
1.345
1.365
1.400
Tip to Seating Plane
L
.110
.130
.150
Lead Thickness
c
.008
.010
.015
b1
.040
.050
.070
b
.014
.018
.022
eB
–
–
Upper Lead Width
Lower Lead Width
Overall Row Spacing §
.100 BSC
.430
Notes:
1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area.
2. § Significant Characteristic.
3. Dimensions D and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed .010" per side.
4. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M.
BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances.
Microchip Technology Drawing C04-070B
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 215
dsPIC30F4011/4012
28-Lead Plastic Small Outline (SO) – Wide, 7.50 mm Body [SOIC]
Note:
For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
D
N
E
E1
NOTE 1
1 2 3
b
e
h
α
A2
A
h
c
φ
L
A1
Units
Dimension Limits
Number of Pins
β
L1
MILLMETERS
MIN
N
NOM
MAX
28
Pitch
e
Overall Height
A
–
1.27 BSC
–
Molded Package Thickness
A2
2.05
–
–
Standoff §
A1
0.10
–
0.30
Overall Width
E
Molded Package Width
E1
7.50 BSC
Overall Length
D
17.90 BSC
2.65
10.30 BSC
Chamfer (optional)
h
0.25
–
0.75
Foot Length
L
0.40
–
1.27
Footprint
L1
1.40 REF
Foot Angle Top
φ
0°
–
8°
Lead Thickness
c
0.18
–
0.33
Lead Width
b
0.31
–
0.51
Mold Draft Angle Top
α
5°
–
15°
Mold Draft Angle Bottom
β
5°
–
15°
Notes:
1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area.
2. § Significant Characteristic.
3. Dimensions D and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed 0.15 mm per side.
4. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M.
BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances.
REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only.
Microchip Technology Drawing C04-052B
DS70135E-page 216
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
40-Lead Plastic Dual In-Line (P) – 600 mil Body [PDIP]
Note:
For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
N
NOTE 1
E1
1 2 3
D
E
A2
A
L
c
b1
A1
b
e
eB
Units
Dimension Limits
Number of Pins
INCHES
MIN
N
NOM
MAX
40
Pitch
e
Top to Seating Plane
A
–
–
.250
Molded Package Thickness
A2
.125
–
.195
Base to Seating Plane
A1
.015
–
–
Shoulder to Shoulder Width
E
.590
–
.625
Molded Package Width
E1
.485
–
.580
Overall Length
D
1.980
–
2.095
Tip to Seating Plane
L
.115
–
.200
Lead Thickness
c
.008
–
.015
b1
.030
–
.070
b
.014
–
.023
eB
–
–
Upper Lead Width
Lower Lead Width
Overall Row Spacing §
.100 BSC
.700
Notes:
1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area.
2. § Significant Characteristic.
3. Dimensions D and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed .010" per side.
4. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M.
BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances.
Microchip Technology Drawing C04-016B
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 217
dsPIC30F4011/4012
44-Lead Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (ML) – 8x8 mm Body [QFN]
Note:
For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
D
D2
EXPOSED
PAD
e
E
E2
b
2
2
1
N
1
N
NOTE 1
TOP VIEW
K
L
BOTTOM VIEW
A
A3
A1
Units
Dimension Limits
Number of Pins
MILLIMETERS
MIN
N
NOM
MAX
44
Pitch
e
Overall Height
A
0.80
0.65 BSC
0.90
1.00
Standoff
A1
0.00
0.02
0.05
Contact Thickness
A3
0.20 REF
Overall Width
E
Exposed Pad Width
E2
Overall Length
D
Exposed Pad Length
D2
6.30
6.45
6.80
b
0.25
0.30
0.38
Contact Length
L
0.30
0.40
0.50
Contact-to-Exposed Pad
K
0.20
–
–
Contact Width
8.00 BSC
6.30
6.45
6.80
8.00 BSC
Notes:
1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area.
2. Package is saw singulated.
3. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M.
BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances.
REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only.
Microchip Technology Drawing C04-103B
DS70135E-page 218
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
44-Lead Plastic Thin Quad Flatpack (PT) – 10x10x1 mm Body, 2.00 mm Footprint [TQFP]
Note:
For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
D
D1
E
e
E1
N
b
NOTE 1
1 2 3
NOTE 2
α
A
c
φ
β
L
A1
Units
Dimension Limits
Number of Leads
A2
L1
MILLIMETERS
MIN
N
NOM
MAX
44
Lead Pitch
e
Overall Height
A
–
0.80 BSC
–
Molded Package Thickness
A2
0.95
1.00
1.05
Standoff
A1
0.05
–
0.15
Foot Length
L
0.45
0.60
0.75
Footprint
L1
1.20
1.00 REF
Foot Angle
φ
Overall Width
E
12.00 BSC
Overall Length
D
12.00 BSC
Molded Package Width
E1
10.00 BSC
Molded Package Length
D1
10.00 BSC
0°
3.5°
7°
Lead Thickness
c
0.09
–
0.20
Lead Width
b
0.30
0.37
0.45
Mold Draft Angle Top
α
11°
12°
13°
Mold Draft Angle Bottom
β
11°
12°
13°
Notes:
1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area.
2. Chamfers at corners are optional; size may vary.
3. Dimensions D1 and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed 0.25 mm per side.
4. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M.
BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances.
REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only.
Microchip Technology Drawing C04-076B
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Confidential
DS70135E-page 219
dsPIC30F4011/4012
NOTES:
DS70135E-page 220
Confidential
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
APPENDIX A:
REVISION HISTORY
Revision D (August 2006)
Previous versions of this data sheet contained
Advance or Preliminary Information. They were
distributed with incomplete characterization data.
This revision reflects these changes:
• Revised I2C Slave Addresses
(see Table 17-1)
• Updated Section 20.0 “10-bit, High-Speed
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Module” to
more fully describe configuration guidelines
• Base Instruction CP1 removed from instruction
set (see Table 22-2)
• Revised Electrical Characteristics:
- Operating Current (IDD) Specifications
(seeTable 24-5 )
- Idle Current (IIDLE) Specifications
(see Table 24-6)
- Power-Down Current (IPD) Specifications
(see Table 24-7)
- I/O Pin Input Specifications
(see Table 24-8)
- BOR Voltage Limits
(see Table 24-11)
- Watchdog Timer Time-out Limits
(see Table 24-21)
Revision E (January 2007)
- This revision includes updates to the
packaging diagrams.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 221
dsPIC30F4011/4012
NOTES:
DS70135E-page 222
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
INDEX
A
AC Characteristics ............................................................ 179
Load Conditions ........................................................ 179
Temperature and Voltage Specifications .................. 179
ADC
1 Msps Configuration Guideline................................ 138
600 ksps Configuration Guideline ............................. 139
750 ksps Configuration Guideline ............................. 139
Aborting a Conversion .............................................. 136
Acquisition Requirements ......................................... 140
ADCHS ..................................................................... 133
ADCON1 ................................................................... 133
ADCON2 ................................................................... 133
ADCON3 ................................................................... 133
ADCSSL.................................................................... 133
ADPCFG ................................................................... 133
Configuring Analog Port Pins.................................... 142
Connection Considerations....................................... 142
Conversion Operation ............................................... 135
Conversion Rate Parameters.................................... 137
Conversion Speeds................................................... 137
Effects of a Reset...................................................... 141
Operation During CPU Idle Mode ............................. 141
Operation During CPU Sleep Mode.......................... 141
Output Formats ......................................................... 141
Power-Down Modes.................................................. 141
Programming the Start of Conversion Trigger .......... 136
Register Map............................................................. 143
Result Buffer ............................................................. 135
Selecting the Conversion Clock ................................ 136
Selecting the Conversion Sequence......................... 135
Voltage Reference Schematic .................................. 138
Address Generator Units .................................................... 33
Alternate 16-bit Timer/Counter............................................ 87
Alternate Interrupt Vector Table .......................................... 43
Assembler
MPASM Assembler................................................... 168
B
Barrel Shifter ....................................................................... 20
Bit-Reversed Addressing .................................................... 36
Example ...................................................................... 36
Implementation ........................................................... 36
Modifier Values (table) ................................................ 37
Sequence Table (16-Entry)......................................... 37
Block Diagrams
10-Bit, High-Speed ADC ........................................... 134
16-bit Timer1 Module .................................................. 64
16-bit Timer4............................................................... 74
16-bit Timer5............................................................... 75
32-bit Timer4/5............................................................ 73
ADC Analog Input Model .......................................... 140
CAN Buffers and Protocol Engine............................. 124
Dedicated Port Structure............................................. 57
DSP Engine ................................................................ 17
dsPIC30F4011 .............................................................. 7
dsPIC30F4012 .............................................................. 8
External Power-on Reset Circuit............................... 153
I2C............................................................................. 108
Input Capture Mode .................................................... 77
Oscillator System ...................................................... 147
Output Compare Mode ............................................... 81
PWM Module .............................................................. 92
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Quadrature Encoder Interface .................................... 85
Reset System ........................................................... 151
Shared Port Structure................................................. 58
SPI............................................................................ 104
SPI Master/Slave Connection................................... 104
UART Receiver......................................................... 116
UART Transmitter..................................................... 115
BOR. See Brown-out Reset.
Brown-out Reset
Characteristics.......................................................... 177
C
C Compilers
MPLAB C18.............................................................. 168
MPLAB C30.............................................................. 168
CAN Module ..................................................................... 123
Baud Rate Setting .................................................... 128
CAN1 Register Map.................................................. 130
Frame Types ............................................................ 123
Message Reception.................................................. 126
Message Transmission............................................. 127
Modes of Operation .................................................. 125
Overview................................................................... 123
Center-Aligned PWM .......................................................... 95
Code Examples
Data EEPROM Block Erase ....................................... 52
Data EEPROM Block Write ........................................ 54
Data EEPROM Read.................................................. 51
Data EEPROM Word Erase ....................................... 52
Data EEPROM Word Write ........................................ 53
Erasing a Row of Program Memory ........................... 47
Initiating a Programming Sequence ........................... 48
Loading Write Latches ................................................ 48
Port Write/Read .......................................................... 58
Code Protection ................................................................ 145
Complementary PWM Operation........................................ 96
Configuring Analog Port Pins.............................................. 58
Core Overview .................................................................... 13
Core Register Map.............................................................. 30
Customer Change Notification Service............................. 228
Customer Notification Service .......................................... 228
Customer Support............................................................. 228
D
Data Access from Program Memory
Using Program Space Visibility .................................. 24
Data Accumulators and Adder/Subtracter .......................... 18
Data Space Write Saturation ...................................... 20
Overflow and Saturation ............................................. 18
Round Logic ............................................................... 19
Write-Back .................................................................. 19
Data Address Space........................................................... 25
Alignment.................................................................... 28
Alignment (Figure) ...................................................... 28
Data Spaces ............................................................... 28
Effect of Invalid Memory Accesses............................. 28
MCU and DSP (MAC Class)
Instructions Example .......................................... 27
Memory Map............................................................... 26
Near Data Space ........................................................ 29
Software Stack ........................................................... 29
Width .......................................................................... 28
DS70135E-page 223
dsPIC30F4011/4012
Data EEPROM Memory ...................................................... 51
Erasing ........................................................................ 52
Erasing, Block ............................................................. 52
Erasing, Word ............................................................. 52
Protection Against Spurious Write .............................. 55
Reading....................................................................... 51
Write Verify ................................................................. 55
Writing ......................................................................... 53
Writing, Block .............................................................. 54
Writing, Word .............................................................. 53
DC Characteristics ............................................................ 171
BOR .......................................................................... 178
I/O Pin Input Specifications ....................................... 176
I/O Pin Output Specifications .................................... 177
Idle Current (IIDLE) .................................................... 174
Operating Current (IDD)............................................. 173
Power-Down Current (IPD) ........................................ 175
Program and EEPROM............................................. 178
DC Temperature and Voltage Specifications .................... 172
Dead-Time Generators ....................................................... 96
Ranges........................................................................ 97
Development Support ....................................................... 167
Device Configuration
Register Map............................................................. 158
Device Configuration Registers......................................... 156
FBORPOR ................................................................ 156
FGS........................................................................... 156
FOSC ........................................................................ 156
FWDT........................................................................ 156
Divide Support..................................................................... 16
DSP Engine......................................................................... 16
Multiplier...................................................................... 18
dsPIC30F4011 Port Register Map ...................................... 59
dsPIC30F4012 Port Register Map ...................................... 60
Dual Output Compare Match Mode .................................... 82
Continuous Output Pulse Mode .................................. 82
Single Output Pulse Mode .......................................... 82
E
Edge-Aligned PWM............................................................. 95
Electrical Characteristics................................................... 171
Equations
A/D Conversion Clock ............................................... 136
Baud Rate ................................................................. 119
I2CBRG Value .......................................................... 112
PWM Period ................................................................ 94
PWM Period (Center-Aligned Mode) .......................... 94
PWM Resolution ......................................................... 94
Time Quantum for Clock Generation ........................ 129
Errata .................................................................................... 6
External Interrupt Requests ................................................ 43
F
Fast Context Saving............................................................ 43
Flash Program Memory....................................................... 45
In-Circuit Serial Programming (ICSP) ......................... 45
Run-Time Self-Programming (RTSP) ......................... 45
Table Instruction Operation Summary ........................ 45
I
I/O Ports
Parallel I/O (PIO)......................................................... 57
I2C Module
10-bit Slave Mode Operation .................................... 109
Reception.......................................................... 110
Transmission..................................................... 110
DS70135E-page 224
7-bit Slave Mode Operation ...................................... 109
Reception ......................................................... 109
Transmission .................................................... 109
Addresses................................................................. 109
Automatic Clock Stretch ........................................... 110
During 10-bit Addressing (STREN = 1) ............ 110
During 7-bit Addressing (STREN = 1) .............. 110
Reception ......................................................... 110
Transmission .................................................... 110
General Call Address Support .................................. 111
Interrupts .................................................................. 111
IPMI Support............................................................. 111
Master Operation ...................................................... 111
Baud Rate Generator (BRG) ............................ 112
Clock Operation................................................ 112
Multi-Master Communication, Bus
Collision and Arbitration............................ 112
Reception ......................................................... 112
Transmission .................................................... 111
Master Support ......................................................... 111
Operating Function Description ................................ 107
Operation During CPU Sleep and
Idle Modes ........................................................ 112
Pin Configuration ...................................................... 107
Programmer’s Model ................................................ 107
Register Map ............................................................ 113
Registers .................................................................. 107
Slope Control ............................................................ 111
Software Controlled Clock Stretching
(STREN = 1) ..................................................... 110
Various Modes.......................................................... 107
In-Circuit Serial Programming (ICSP)............................... 145
Independent PWM Output .................................................. 98
Initialization Condition for RCON Register, Case 2 .......... 154
Initialization Condition for RCON Register, Case 1 .......... 154
Input Capture Module ......................................................... 77
In CPU Idle Mode ....................................................... 79
In CPU Sleep Mode .................................................... 78
Interrupts .................................................................... 79
Register Map .............................................................. 80
Simple Capture Event Mode....................................... 78
Input Change Notification Module....................................... 61
Register Map (bits 7-0) ............................................... 61
Input Diagrams
QEA/QEB Input ........................................................ 194
Instruction Addressing Modes ............................................ 33
File Register Instructions ............................................ 33
Fundamental Modes Supported ................................. 33
MAC Instructions ........................................................ 34
MCU Instructions ........................................................ 33
Move and Accumulator Instructions............................ 34
Other Instructions ....................................................... 34
Instruction Set Overview................................................... 162
Instruction Set Summary .................................................. 159
Internal Clock Timing Examples ....................................... 182
Internet Address ............................................................... 228
Interrupt Controller
Register Map .............................................................. 44
Interrupt Priority .................................................................. 40
Interrupt Sequence ............................................................. 43
Interrupt Stack Frame ................................................. 43
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
M
Microchip Internet Web Site .............................................. 228
Modulo Addressing ............................................................. 34
Applicability ................................................................. 36
Operation Example ..................................................... 35
Start and End Address................................................ 35
W Address Register Selection .................................... 35
Motor Control PWM Module................................................ 91
Register Map............................................................. 101
MPLAB ASM30 Assembler, Linker, Librarian ................... 168
MPLAB ICD 2 In-Circuit Debugger ................................... 169
MPLAB ICE 2000 High-Performance
Universal In-Circuit Emulator .................................... 169
MPLAB ICE 4000 High-Performance
Universal In-Circuit Emulator .................................... 169
MPLAB Integrated Development
Environment Software............................................... 167
MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer .................................... 169
MPLINK Object Linker/MPLIB Object Librarian ................ 168
O
Operating MIPS vs. Voltage.............................................. 171
Oscillator
Configurations........................................................... 148
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor .................................... 150
Fast RC (FRC) .................................................. 149
Initial Clock Source Selection ........................... 148
Low-Power RC (LPRC)..................................... 149
LP ..................................................................... 149
Phase Locked Loop (PLL) ................................ 149
Start-up Timer (OST) ........................................ 148
Operating Modes (Table) .......................................... 146
Oscillator Selection ........................................................... 145
Output Compare Module..................................................... 81
During CPU Idle Mode ................................................ 83
During CPU Sleep Mode............................................. 83
Interrupts..................................................................... 83
Register Map............................................................... 84
P
Packaging ......................................................................... 213
Details ....................................................................... 215
Marking ..................................................................... 213
PICSTART Plus Development Programmer ..................... 170
Pinout Descriptions
dsPIC30F4011 .............................................................. 9
dsPIC30F4012 ............................................................ 11
POR. See Power-on Reset.
Position Measurement Mode .............................................. 87
Power-Saving Modes ........................................................ 155
Idle ............................................................................ 156
Sleep......................................................................... 155
Power-Saving Modes (Sleep and Idle) ............................. 145
Program Address Space ..................................................... 21
Construction................................................................ 22
Data Access From Program Memory
Using Table Instructions ..................................... 23
Data Access From, Address Generation .................... 22
Memory Map ............................................................... 21
Table Instructions
TBLRDH ............................................................. 23
TBLRDL .............................................................. 23
TBLWTH ............................................................. 23
TBLWTL.............................................................. 23
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Program Counter ................................................................ 14
Program Data Table Access (lsw) ...................................... 23
Program Data Table Access (MSB).................................... 24
Program Space Visibility
Window into Program Space Operation ..................... 25
Programmable Digital Noise Filters .................................... 87
Programmer’s Model .......................................................... 14
Diagram ...................................................................... 15
Programming Operations.................................................... 47
Algorithm for Program Flash....................................... 47
Erasing a Row of Program Memory ........................... 47
Initiating the Programming Sequence ........................ 48
Loading Write Latches ................................................ 48
Protection Against Accidental Writes to OSCCON ........... 150
PWM Duty Cycle Comparison Units ................................... 96
Duty Cycle Register Buffers ....................................... 96
PWM Fault Pin.................................................................... 99
Enable Bits ................................................................. 99
Fault States ................................................................ 99
Input Modes................................................................ 99
Cycle-by-Cycle ................................................... 99
Latched............................................................... 99
PWM Operation During CPU Idle Mode ........................... 100
PWM Operation During CPU Sleep Mode........................ 100
PWM Output and Polarity Control....................................... 99
Output Pin Control ...................................................... 99
PWM Output Override ........................................................ 98
Complementary Output Mode .................................... 98
Synchronization .......................................................... 98
PWM Period........................................................................ 94
PWM Special Event Trigger.............................................. 100
Postscaler................................................................. 100
PWM Time Base................................................................. 93
Continuous Up/Down Count Modes ........................... 93
Double Update Mode.................................................. 94
Free-Running Mode.................................................... 93
Postscaler................................................................... 94
Prescaler .................................................................... 94
Single-Shot Mode ....................................................... 93
PWM Update Lockout....................................................... 100
Q
QEI Module
Operation During CPU Sleep Mode ........................... 87
Timer Operation During CPU Sleep Mode ................. 87
Quadrature Encoder Interface (QEI)................................... 85
Interrupts .................................................................... 88
Logic ........................................................................... 86
Operation During CPU Idle Mode............................... 88
Register Map .............................................................. 89
Timer Operation During CPU Idle Mode..................... 88
R
Reader Response............................................................. 229
Reset ........................................................................ 145, 151
BOR, Programmable ................................................ 153
Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)................................ 145
POR.......................................................................... 151
Long Crystal Start-up Time............................... 153
Operating Without FSCM and PWRT............... 153
Power-on Reset (POR)............................................. 145
Power-up Timer (PWRT) .......................................... 145
Programmable Brown-out Reset (BOR) ................... 145
Reset Sequence ................................................................. 41
Reset Sources ............................................................ 41
DS70135E-page 225
dsPIC30F4011/4012
Revision History ................................................................ 221
RTSP
Control Registers ........................................................ 46
NVMADR ............................................................ 46
NVMADRU.......................................................... 46
NVMCON ............................................................ 46
NVMKEY............................................................. 46
Operation .................................................................... 46
S
Simple Capture Event Mode
Capture Buffer Operation ............................................ 78
Capture Prescaler ....................................................... 78
Hall Sensor Mode ....................................................... 78
Timer2 and Timer3 Selection Mode ............................ 78
Simple Output Compare Match Mode................................. 82
Simple PWM Mode ............................................................. 82
Input Pin Fault Protection............................................ 82
Period.......................................................................... 83
Single Pulse PWM Operation.............................................. 98
Software Simulator (MPLAB SIM)..................................... 168
Software Stack Pointer, Frame Pointer............................... 14
CALL Stack Frame...................................................... 29
SPI Module........................................................................ 103
Framed SPI Support ................................................. 103
Operating Function Description ................................ 103
Operation During CPU Idle Mode ............................. 105
Operation During CPU Sleep Mode .......................... 105
Register Map............................................................. 106
SDO1 Disable ........................................................... 103
Slave Select Synchronization ................................... 105
Word and Byte Communication ................................ 103
STATUS Register................................................................ 14
Symbols Used in Opcode Descriptions............................. 160
System Integration
Overview ................................................................... 145
Register Map............................................................. 158
T
Thermal Operating Conditions .......................................... 172
Thermal Packaging Characteristics .................................. 172
Timer1 Module
16-bit Asynchronous Counter Mode ........................... 63
16-bit Synchronous Counter Mode ............................. 63
16-bit Timer Mode ....................................................... 63
Gate Operation ........................................................... 64
Interrupt....................................................................... 65
Operation During Sleep Mode .................................... 64
Prescaler ..................................................................... 64
Real-Time Clock ......................................................... 65
RTC Interrupts .................................................... 65
RTC Oscillator Operation.................................... 65
Register Map............................................................... 66
Timer2 and Timer3 Selection Mode .................................... 82
Timer2/3 Module
16-bit Timer Mode ....................................................... 67
32-bit Synchronous Counter Mode ............................. 67
32-bit Timer Mode ....................................................... 67
ADC Event Trigger ...................................................... 70
Gate Operation ........................................................... 70
Interrupt....................................................................... 70
Operation During Sleep Mode .................................... 70
Register Map............................................................... 71
Timer Prescaler........................................................... 70
DS70135E-page 226
Timer4/5 Module................................................................. 73
Register Map .............................................................. 76
Timing Diagram
A/D Conversion
10-Bit High-Speed (CHPS = 01, SIMSAM = 0,
ASAM = 1, SSRC = 111,
SAMC = 00001)........................................ 210
I2C Bus Data (Slave Mode) ...................................... 204
Timing Diagrams
A/D Conversion
10-Bit High-Speed (CHPS = 01, SIMSAM = 0,
ASAM = 0, SSRC = 000) .......................... 209
Band Gap Start-up Time........................................... 186
CAN Bit ..................................................................... 128
CAN Module I/O........................................................ 206
Center-Aligned PWM .................................................. 95
CLKO and I/O ........................................................... 184
Dead-Time Timing ...................................................... 97
Edge-Aligned PWM .................................................... 95
External Clock........................................................... 179
I2C Bus Data (Master Mode) .................................... 202
I2C Bus Start/Stop Bits (Master Mode) ..................... 202
I2C Bus Start/Stop Bits (Slave Mode) ....................... 204
Input Capture ............................................................ 190
Motor Control PWM .................................................. 193
Motor Control PWM Module Fault ............................ 193
Output Compare ....................................................... 191
Output Compare/PWM ............................................. 192
PWM Output ............................................................... 83
QEI Module External Clock....................................... 189
QEI Module Index Pulse ........................................... 195
Reset, Watchdog Timer, Oscillator
Start-up Timer and Power-up Timer ................. 185
SPI Master Mode (CKE = 0) ..................................... 196
SPI Master Mode (CKE = 1) ..................................... 197
SPI Slave Mode (CKE = 0) ....................................... 198
SPI Slave Mode (CKE = 1) ....................................... 200
Time-out Sequence on Power-up
(MCLR Not Tied to VDD), Case 1 ..................... 152
Time-out Sequence on Power-up
(MCLR Not Tied to VDD), Case 2 ..................... 152
Time-out Sequence on Power-up
(MCLR Tied to VDD) ......................................... 152
Timerx External Clock............................................... 187
Timing Requirements
A/D Conversion
10-Bit High-Speed ............................................ 211
Band Gap Start-up Time........................................... 186
CAN Module I/O........................................................ 206
CLKO and I/O ........................................................... 184
External Clock........................................................... 180
I2C Bus Data (Master Mode) .................................... 203
I2C Bus Data (Slave Mode) ...................................... 205
Input Capture ............................................................ 190
Motor Control PWM .................................................. 193
Output Compare ....................................................... 191
QEI Module External Clock....................................... 189
QEI Module Index Pulse ........................................... 195
Quadrature Decoder ................................................. 194
Reset, Watchdog Timer, Oscillator
Start-up Timer and Power-up Timer ................. 186
Simple Output Compare/PWM Mode ....................... 192
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
SPI Master Mode (CKE = 0) ..................................... 196
SPI Master Mode (CKE = 1) ..................................... 197
SPI Slave Mode (CKE = 0) ....................................... 199
SPI Slave Mode (CKE = 1) ....................................... 201
Timer1 External Clock............................................... 187
Timer2 and Timer4 External Clock ........................... 188
Timer3 and Timer5 External Clock ........................... 188
Timing Specifications
PLL Clock.................................................................. 181
PLL Jitter................................................................... 181
Trap Vectors ....................................................................... 42
Traps ................................................................................... 41
Hard and Soft.............................................................. 42
Trap Sources .............................................................. 41
U
UART
Address Detect Mode ............................................... 119
Alternate I/O.............................................................. 117
Auto-Baud Support ................................................... 120
Baud Rate Generator................................................ 119
Disabling ................................................................... 117
Enabling and Setting Up ........................................... 117
Loopback Mode ........................................................ 119
Module Overview ...................................................... 115
Operation During CPU Sleep and Idle Modes .......... 120
Receiving Data.......................................................... 118
In 8-bit or 9-bit Data Mode ................................ 118
Interrupt ............................................................ 118
Receive Buffer (UxRCB) ................................... 118
Reception Error Handling.......................................... 118
Framing Error (FERR) ...................................... 119
Idle Status ......................................................... 119
Parity Error (PERR) .......................................... 119
Receive Break .................................................. 119
Receive Buffer Overrun Error (OERR Bit) ........ 118
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Setting Up Data, Parity and Stop Bit
Selections ......................................................... 117
Transmitting Data ..................................................... 117
Break ................................................................ 118
In 8-bit Data Mode ............................................ 117
In 9-bit Data Mode ............................................ 117
Interrupt ............................................................ 118
Transmit Buffer (UxTXB) .................................. 117
UART1 Register Map ............................................... 121
UART2 Register Map ............................................... 121
Unit ID Locations .............................................................. 145
Universal Asynchronous Receiver
Transmitter Module (UART) ..................................... 115
W
Wake-up from Sleep ......................................................... 145
Wake-up from Sleep and Idle ............................................. 43
Watchdog Timer (WDT)............................................ 145, 155
Enabling and Disabling............................................. 155
Operation.................................................................. 155
WWW Address ................................................................. 228
WWW, On-Line Support ....................................................... 6
DS70135E-page 227
dsPIC30F4011/4012
NOTES:
DS70135E-page 228
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
THE MICROCHIP WEB SITE
CUSTOMER SUPPORT
Microchip provides online support via our WWW site at
www.microchip.com. This web site is used as a means
to make files and information easily available to
customers. Accessible by using your favorite Internet
browser, the web site contains the following
information:
Users of Microchip products can receive assistance
through several channels:
• Product Support – Data sheets and errata,
application notes and sample programs, design
resources, user’s guides and hardware support
documents, latest software releases and archived
software
• General Technical Support – Frequently Asked
Questions (FAQ), technical support requests,
online discussion groups, Microchip consultant
program member listing
• Business of Microchip – Product selector and
ordering guides, latest Microchip press releases,
listing of seminars and events, listings of
Microchip sales offices, distributors and factory
representatives
•
•
•
•
•
Distributor or Representative
Local Sales Office
Field Application Engineer (FAE)
Technical Support
Development Systems Information Line
Customers
should
contact
their
distributor,
representative or field application engineer (FAE) for
support. Local sales offices are also available to help
customers. A listing of sales offices and locations is
included in the back of this document.
Technical support is available through the web site
at: http://support.microchip.com
CUSTOMER CHANGE NOTIFICATION
SERVICE
Microchip’s customer notification service helps keep
customers current on Microchip products. Subscribers
will receive e-mail notification whenever there are
changes, updates, revisions or errata related to a
specified product family or development tool of interest.
To register, access the Microchip web site at
www.microchip.com, click on Customer Change
Notification and follow the registration instructions.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 229
dsPIC30F4011/4012
READER RESPONSE
It is our intention to provide you with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip product. If you wish to provide your comments on organization, clarity, subject matter, and ways in which our documentation
can better serve you, please FAX your comments to the Technical Publications Manager at (480) 792-4150.
Please list the following information, and use this outline to provide us with your comments about this document.
To:
Technical Publications Manager
RE:
Reader Response
Total Pages Sent ________
From: Name
Company
Address
City / State / ZIP / Country
Telephone: (_______) _________ - _________
FAX: (______) _________ - _________
Application (optional):
Would you like a reply?
Y
Device: dsPIC30F4011/4012
N
Literature Number: DS70135E
Questions:
1. What are the best features of this document?
2. How does this document meet your hardware and software development needs?
3. Do you find the organization of this document easy to follow? If not, why?
4. What additions to the document do you think would enhance the structure and subject?
5. What deletions from the document could be made without affecting the overall usefulness?
6. Is there any incorrect or misleading information (what and where)?
7. How would you improve this document?
DS70135E-page 230
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
PRODUCT IDENTIFICATION SYSTEM
To order or obtain information, e.g., on pricing or delivery, refer to the factory or the listed sales office.
d s P I C 3 0 F 6 0 1 0 AT - 3 0 I / P F - 0 0 0
Custom ID (3 digits) or
Engineering Sample (ES)
Trademark
Architecture
Package
PF = TQFP 14x14
S = Die (Waffle Pack)
W = Die (Wafers)
Flash
Memory Size in Bytes
0 = ROMless
1 = 1K to 6K
2 = 7K to 12K
3 = 13K to 24K
4 = 25K to 48K
5 = 49K to 96K
6 = 97K to 192K
7 = 193K to 384K
8 = 385K to 768K
9 = 769K and Up
Temperature
I = Industrial -40°C to +85°C
E = Extended High Temp -40°C to +125°C
Device ID
Speed
20 = 20 MIPS
30 = 30 MIPS
T = Tape and Reel
A,B,C… = Revision Level
Example:
dsPIC30F6010AT-30I/PF = 30 MIPS, Industrial temp., TQFP package, Rev. A
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 231
WORLDWIDE SALES AND SERVICE
AMERICAS
ASIA/PACIFIC
ASIA/PACIFIC
EUROPE
Corporate Office
2355 West Chandler Blvd.
Chandler, AZ 85224-6199
Tel: 480-792-7200
Fax: 480-792-7277
Technical Support:
http://support.microchip.com
Web Address:
www.microchip.com
Asia Pacific Office
Suites 3707-14, 37th Floor
Tower 6, The Gateway
Habour City, Kowloon
Hong Kong
Tel: 852-2401-1200
Fax: 852-2401-3431
India - Bangalore
Tel: 91-80-4182-8400
Fax: 91-80-4182-8422
India - New Delhi
Tel: 91-11-4160-8631
Fax: 91-11-4160-8632
Austria - Wels
Tel: 43-7242-2244-39
Fax: 43-7242-2244-393
Denmark - Copenhagen
Tel: 45-4450-2828
Fax: 45-4485-2829
India - Pune
Tel: 91-20-2566-1512
Fax: 91-20-2566-1513
France - Paris
Tel: 33-1-69-53-63-20
Fax: 33-1-69-30-90-79
Japan - Yokohama
Tel: 81-45-471- 6166
Fax: 81-45-471-6122
Germany - Munich
Tel: 49-89-627-144-0
Fax: 49-89-627-144-44
Atlanta
Duluth, GA
Tel: 678-957-9614
Fax: 678-957-1455
Boston
Westborough, MA
Tel: 774-760-0087
Fax: 774-760-0088
Chicago
Itasca, IL
Tel: 630-285-0071
Fax: 630-285-0075
Dallas
Addison, TX
Tel: 972-818-7423
Fax: 972-818-2924
Detroit
Farmington Hills, MI
Tel: 248-538-2250
Fax: 248-538-2260
Kokomo
Kokomo, IN
Tel: 765-864-8360
Fax: 765-864-8387
Los Angeles
Mission Viejo, CA
Tel: 949-462-9523
Fax: 949-462-9608
Santa Clara
Santa Clara, CA
Tel: 408-961-6444
Fax: 408-961-6445
Toronto
Mississauga, Ontario,
Canada
Tel: 905-673-0699
Fax: 905-673-6509
Australia - Sydney
Tel: 61-2-9868-6733
Fax: 61-2-9868-6755
China - Beijing
Tel: 86-10-8528-2100
Fax: 86-10-8528-2104
China - Chengdu
Tel: 86-28-8665-5511
Fax: 86-28-8665-7889
Korea - Gumi
Tel: 82-54-473-4301
Fax: 82-54-473-4302
China - Fuzhou
Tel: 86-591-8750-3506
Fax: 86-591-8750-3521
Korea - Seoul
Tel: 82-2-554-7200
Fax: 82-2-558-5932 or
82-2-558-5934
China - Hong Kong SAR
Tel: 852-2401-1200
Fax: 852-2401-3431
Malaysia - Penang
Tel: 60-4-646-8870
Fax: 60-4-646-5086
China - Qingdao
Tel: 86-532-8502-7355
Fax: 86-532-8502-7205
Philippines - Manila
Tel: 63-2-634-9065
Fax: 63-2-634-9069
China - Shanghai
Tel: 86-21-5407-5533
Fax: 86-21-5407-5066
Singapore
Tel: 65-6334-8870
Fax: 65-6334-8850
China - Shenyang
Tel: 86-24-2334-2829
Fax: 86-24-2334-2393
Taiwan - Hsin Chu
Tel: 886-3-572-9526
Fax: 886-3-572-6459
China - Shenzhen
Tel: 86-755-8203-2660
Fax: 86-755-8203-1760
Taiwan - Kaohsiung
Tel: 886-7-536-4818
Fax: 886-7-536-4803
China - Shunde
Tel: 86-757-2839-5507
Fax: 86-757-2839-5571
Taiwan - Taipei
Tel: 886-2-2500-6610
Fax: 886-2-2508-0102
China - Wuhan
Tel: 86-27-5980-5300
Fax: 86-27-5980-5118
Thailand - Bangkok
Tel: 66-2-694-1351
Fax: 66-2-694-1350
Italy - Milan
Tel: 39-0331-742611
Fax: 39-0331-466781
Netherlands - Drunen
Tel: 31-416-690399
Fax: 31-416-690340
Spain - Madrid
Tel: 34-91-708-08-90
Fax: 34-91-708-08-91
UK - Wokingham
Tel: 44-118-921-5869
Fax: 44-118-921-5820
China - Xian
Tel: 86-29-8833-7250
Fax: 86-29-8833-7256
12/08/06
DS70135E-page 232
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F4011/4012
1.0
2.0
3.0
4.0
5.0
6.0
7.0
8.0
9.0
10.0
11.0
12.0
13.0
14.0
15.0
16.0
17.0
18.0
19.0
20.0
Device Overview .......................................................................................................................................................................... 7
CPU Architecture Overview........................................................................................................................................................ 13
Memory Organization ................................................................................................................................................................. 21
Address Generator Units............................................................................................................................................................ 33
Interrupts .................................................................................................................................................................................... 39
Flash Program Memory.............................................................................................................................................................. 45
Data EEPROM Memory ............................................................................................................................................................. 51
I/O Ports ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 57
Timer1 Module ........................................................................................................................................................................... 63
Timer2/3 Module ........................................................................................................................................................................ 67
Timer4/5 Module ....................................................................................................................................................................... 73
Input Capture Module................................................................................................................................................................. 77
Output Compare Module ............................................................................................................................................................ 81
Quadrature Encoder Interface (QEI) Module ............................................................................................................................. 85
Motor Control PWM Module ....................................................................................................................................................... 91
SPI Module............................................................................................................................................................................... 103
I2C™ Module ........................................................................................................................................................................... 107
Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (UART) Module .............................................................................................. 115
CAN Module ............................................................................................................................................................................. 123
10-bit, High-Speed
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Module133
21.0 System Integration ................................................................................................................................................................... 145
22.0 Instruction Set Summary .......................................................................................................................................................... 159
23.0 Development Support............................................................................................................................................................... 167
24.0 Electrical Characteristics .......................................................................................................................................................... 171
25.0 Packaging Information.............................................................................................................................................................. 213
The Microchip Web Site ..................................................................................................................................................................... 229
Customer Change Notification Service .............................................................................................................................................. 229
Customer Support .............................................................................................................................................................................. 229
Reader Response .............................................................................................................................................................................. 230
Product Identification System ............................................................................................................................................................ 231
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70135E-page 1
dsPIC30F4011/4012
DS70135E-page 2
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Similar pages